Escolar Documentos
Profissional Documentos
Cultura Documentos
I
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
These pages provide an introduction to transformer service and maintenance, and are a
guide to help increase the value of the product, by protecting and prolonging the asset
life for customers and/or owners.
The material was compiled and written by ABB experts from our Transformer Business
Unit, based on their vast knowledge of transformers and many years of global
experience in the field of transformer manufacturing and service.
You are holding in your hands the end result of this challenging work – the Service
Handbook for Transformers.
Leif Carlzon, Group Vice President and Product Group Manager for Transformer
Service, Asim Fazlagic, Vice President for Transformer Service North America, Dr.
George Frimpong, Transformer Service expert in USA, Pierre Boss, Senior Transformer
expert in Switzerland and Pierre Lorin, Technology Manager for Product Group
Transformer Service have led the project by compiling, writing and editing the material
in this handbook.
We also thank the ABB employees and industry partners who supplied valuable input
and information, as well as a number of organizations which generously permitted us to
use their materials and documentation in the creation of this handbook.
We are convinced that readers will find our Transformer Service Handbook a very
useful and comprehensive source of answers to the many questions relating to
transformers and a trouble-free product life.
At ABB, we don’t just build high quality transformers - we take care of them so they stay
that way.
Brice Koch
Group Senior Vice President
Head of Business Unit Transformers
Power Product Division
Zurich, Switzerland
II
FOREWORD
ABB possesses the technology rights of more than 30 brands including ABB, ACEC,
ASEA, Ansaldo, Bonar Long, Breda, BBC, CGE, Challenger, Elektrisk Bureau, Elta, GE
(> 40 MVA), GTE, Gould, IEL, ITC, ITE, Indelve, Industrial Design, Italtrafo, Lepper,
MFO, Marelli, Moloney Electric, National Industri, Nitran, No-Tra-Mo, Ocren, OEL, OTE,
Richard Pfeiffer, Sécheron, Strömberg, TIBB, Thrige, Westinghouse, Zinsco.
At some utilities these transformers can account for up to 70-80 % of the utility’s total
transformer asset base. With this in mind, we undertook the task of providing for the
industry (users of ANSI/IEEE as well as IEC standards) a reference guide with detailed,
yet easy to understand, information for the proper care and maintenance of
transformers. This information should in no way supersede the maintenance guidelines
provided by the transformer manufacturer.
The engineering staffs at ABB keep abreast of new information and techniques
available for analyzing problems in transformers. In many cases, we are the pioneers of
such new ideas. In keeping up with new ideas, we have realized there is a wealth of
information on transformers available in the open literature. However, this information is
at times found in little known journals, brochures, and books. What we have attempted
to do with this handbook is to compile the most useful information into a single
document. The goal is that this will serve as the preferred reference manual for all who
are involved in the operation and maintenance of transformers. We have melded this
information with our many years of experience in designing transformers and providing
maintenance and diagnostic guidance to customers. This book can also be used as
training material in many universities and schools, to help students gain specific
knowledge about transformer service and maintenance.
The material presented in this handbook is not meant to provide theoretical insights into
the methods used for maintaining transformers. Instead, it is written to help the user
gain a better understanding of why certain measurements are recommended, and in
some cases, how to interpret the results of these measurements. There are three ABB
publications that provide theoretical coverage and discussions on transformers as well
as the testing and the short circuit duty of power transformers (Transformer Handbook,
Testing of Power Transformers, and Short Circuit Duty of Power Transformers available
on the ABB website: www.abb.com/transformers).
III
worldwide. The result has been to improve the availability of the fleet as a whole and at
the same time optimize the maintenance spending where it has the best impact. This is
followed by a general discussion of the various methodologies available for diagnosing
potential problems in transformers. The subsequent sections, which constitute the bulk
of the material in the handbook, provide detailed descriptions and discussions on the
test methods and interpretation of results used to maintain and repair transformers,
either in workshops or at site. Finally, we cover the environmental aspects related to
transformers and the important topic of economics of transformer asset management.
We would like to thank all the authors for their valuable contribution to making such a
comprehensive book about using the transformer as a valuable asset for improving
Power and Productivity for a Better World™.
IV
AUTHORS
The first international version of this handbook was written in collaboration with ABB employees from
several countries. We want to thank them all for this impressive team work.
In Brazil
Lars Eklund and Dr. Jose Carlos Mendes
In China
Henry-HongGuang Huang and Fred Samuelsson
In Germany
Sonia Berhane and Dr. Peter Werle
In India
Jivraj Sutaria
In Ireland
Mark Turner
In Italy
Paolo Capuano
In Norway
Knut Herdlevar, Paul Koestinger and Arnt-Sigmar Todenes
In Spain
Miguel-Angel del-Rey, Rafael Santacruz and Nicolas Toribio
In Sweden
Dr. Dierk Bormann, Dr. Kjell Carrander, Dr. Mats Dahlund, Dr. Uno Gäfvert, Bjorn Holmgren, Lars
Jonsson, Peter Labecker, Lena Melzer, Peter Olsson, Dr. Lars Pettersson and Bengt-Olof Stenestam
In Switzerland
Dr. Jose-Luis Bermudez, Pierre Boss, Cedric Buholzer, Thomas Horst, Pierre Lorin, Jean-François Ravot,
Ralf Schneider, Serge Therry and Thomas Westman
In Thailand
Manoch Sangsuvan and Ekkehard Zeitz
In Turkey
Taner Danisment, Sener Ertuna and Burhan Gundem
Also we would also like to thank Doble Engineering, IEEE, CIGRE, GE Energy, FLIR
Thermograpgy, Megger, Physical Acoustics, Electrical World Magazine, and the various other
organizations that allowed the use of their materials in this handbook.
Special thanks go to the three general reviewers
Pierre Boss, Dr. George Frimpong and Mark Turner
V
CONTENTS
DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTIES AND LIMITATION OF LIABILITY .......................................................... I
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS............................................................................................................................. II
FOREWORD................................................................................................................................................ III
AUTHORS.....................................................................................................................................................V
1 TRANSFORMER DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS .............................................................................. 13
1.1 CONFIGURATION .......................................................................................................................... 13
1.2 MECHANICAL CONSIDERATION ...................................................................................................... 13
1.3 THERMAL CONSIDERATIONS ......................................................................................................... 14
1.4 DIELECTRIC CONSIDERATIONS ...................................................................................................... 15
1.5 CONSTRUCTION TYPES ................................................................................................................ 15
1.5.1 Shell Form ............................................................................................................................. 15
1.5.1.1 Design Features .........................................................................................................................15
1.5.1.2 Mechanical Strength ...................................................................................................................16
1.5.1.3 Thermal Capability......................................................................................................................18
1.5.1.4 Dielectric Characteristics .............................................................................................................20
1.5.2 Core Form ............................................................................................................................. 22
1.5.2.1 Design Features .........................................................................................................................22
1.5.2.2 Mechanical Strength ...................................................................................................................23
1.5.2.3 Thermal Capability......................................................................................................................25
1.5.2.4 Dielectric Characteristics ..............................................................................................................26
1.6 BUSHINGS ................................................................................................................................... 27
1.6.1 Design and Construction of Capacitances in Condenser Bushings Complying with the IEEE
Standards .......................................................................................................................................... 28
1.6.2 Bushings Voltage Tap ...........................................................................................................32
1.6.3 Connections........................................................................................................................... 34
1.6.3.1 Internal Electrical Connections ........................................................................................................34
1.6.3.2 Draw Lead Connected Bushings.....................................................................................................34
1.6.3.3 Bottom Connected Bushings ..........................................................................................................34
1.6.4 Liquid Level Indication........................................................................................................... 34
1.6.5 Painting.................................................................................................................................. 34
1.7 ON-LOAD TAP CHANGERS ........................................................................................................... 35
1.7.1 Introductions .......................................................................................................................... 35
1.7.2 North-American Practices .................................................................................................... 36
1.7.2.1 General Description of LTCs.......................................................................................................36
1.7.2.2 Reactance Type LTCs ................................................................................................................36
1.7.2.3 Arcing Control Methods ..............................................................................................................37
1.7.2.3.1 Arcing Tap Switch ..................................................................................................................37
1.7.2.3.2 Arcing Switch and Tap Selector .............................................................................................37
1.7.2.3.3 Drive Mechanism for Reactance Type LTCs..........................................................................38
1.7.2.4 Vacuum Interrupter Type LTCs...................................................................................................38
1.7.2.5 Resistance Type LTCs ...............................................................................................................39
1.7.2.6 Drive Mechanisms for Resistance Type LTCs ............................................................................40
1.7.2.7 Failure Mechanisms for LTCs .....................................................................................................40
1.7.2.7.1 Electrical Connections............................................................................................................40
1.7.2.7.2 Insulation System...................................................................................................................41
1.7.2.7.3 Control System ......................................................................................................................42
1.7.2.7.4 Mechanism.............................................................................................................................42
1.7.3 European Practices ............................................................................................................... 42
1.7.3.1 Resistance Type OLTCs.............................................................................................................42
1.7.3.2 Diverter Switch OLTC .................................................................................................................43
1.7.3.3 Selector Switch OLTC ................................................................................................................44
1.7.3.4 Tie-In Resistors...........................................................................................................................46
1.7.3.5 Failure Mechanisms for OLTCs ..................................................................................................47
VI
1.7.3.5.1 Electrical Connections............................................................................................................47
1.7.3.5.2 Insulation System...................................................................................................................48
1.7.3.5.3 Motor Drive Mechanism .........................................................................................................48
1.7.3.5.4 Mechanism.............................................................................................................................48
1.8 STREAMING ELECTRIFICATION ...................................................................................................... 49
1.8.1 Charging Tendency and its Effect of Streaming Electrification ............................................. 50
1.8.2 Mitigation Strategies for Streaming Electrification................................................................ 51
2 A PRACTICAL APPROACH TO ASSESSING THE RISK OF FAILURE OF POWER
TRANSFORMERS...................................................................................................................................... 54
2.1 BACKGROUND .............................................................................................................................. 54
2.2 LIFE MANAGEMENT PROCESS ....................................................................................................... 54
2.2.1 Risk Assessment ................................................................................................................... 55
2.2.2 Layout of the Evaluation Procedure ...................................................................................... 58
2.2.3 Evaluation Procedure ............................................................................................................ 59
2.2.4 Probability of Failure – Individual Failure Rate...................................................................... 61
2.3 ASSESSMENT OF THE TECHNICAL RISK OF FAILURE BY CATEGORY (MTMPTM PROGRAM)................ 62
2.3.1 Mechanical Aspects .............................................................................................................. 62
2.3.2 Thermal Aspects ................................................................................................................... 62
2.3.3 Electric Aspects - Risk of Dielectric Failure........................................................................... 62
2.3.4 Aspects Related to Accessory Failure .................................................................................. 62
2.3.5 Total Technical Risk of Failure .............................................................................................. 63
2.4 RISK MITIGATION ......................................................................................................................... 65
2.5 SUMMARY .................................................................................................................................... 65
3 DIAGNOSIS OF TRANSFORMERS.................................................................................................. 66
3.1 DIAGNOSTICS METHODS FOR POWER TRANSFORMERS AND ACCESSORIES .................................... 66
3.1.1 Diagnostic Methods for Power Transformers........................................................................ 66
3.1.1.1 Stresses Acting on Power Transformers ....................................................................................67
3.1.1.2 Deterioration Factors and Failure Mechanisms ..........................................................................68
3.1.1.3 Diagnostic Methods ....................................................................................................................68
3.1.2 Diagnostic Methods for Bushings.......................................................................................... 69
3.1.2.1 Stresses Acting on Bushings ......................................................................................................70
3.1.2.2 Deterioration Factors and Failure Mechanisms ..........................................................................70
3.1.2.3 Diagnostic Methods ....................................................................................................................71
3.1.3 Diagnostic Methods for Surge Arresters ............................................................................... 71
3.1.3.1 Stresses Acting on Surge Arresters............................................................................................72
3.1.3.2 Deterioration Factors and Failure Mechanisms ..........................................................................72
3.1.3.3 Diagnostic Methods ....................................................................................................................73
3.2 GENERAL DIAGNOSIS TOOLS ......................................................................................................... 74
3.2.1 Oil Quality Assessment .........................................................................................................74
3.2.1.1 Factors Affecting the Health and Life of Power Transformers ....................................................74
3.2.1.2 Methods for Assessing the Quality of Transformer Oils..............................................................75
3.2.1.2.1 Dielectric Breakdown Strength (BDV) ....................................................................................75
3.2.1.2.2 Interfacial Tension (IFT) .........................................................................................................75
3.2.1.2.3 Acid Neutralization Number ...................................................................................................76
3.2.1.2.4 Power Factor..........................................................................................................................77
3.2.1.2.5 Test for Oxygen Inhibitor........................................................................................................77
3.2.1.2.6 Furan Analysis .......................................................................................................................77
3.2.1.2.7 PCB Content ..........................................................................................................................78
3.2.1.2.8 Corrosive Sulphur ..................................................................................................................78
3.2.1.3 Moisture in Transformer Insulation Systems ..............................................................................78
3.2.1.3.1 Transformer Oil ......................................................................................................................79
3.2.1.3.2 Relative Humidity ...................................................................................................................79
3.2.1.3.3 Paper (Cellulose) ...................................................................................................................80
3.2.1.3.4 Where Does the Water Come From.......................................................................................81
3.2.1.3.5 Moisture Equilibrium between Oil and Paper in Transformers ...............................................81
3.2.1.3.6 Cautions in Estimation of Moisture Using Moisture Equilibrium Curves .................................83
3.2.1.4 Limits for Measurement Oil Quality Parameters .........................................................................84
VII
3.2.1.5 Moisture and Bubble Evolution in Transformers .........................................................................87
3.2.2 Dissolved Gas in Oil Analysis (DGA) ................................................................................... 91
3.2.2.1 Introduction .................................................................................................................................91
3.2.2.2 Procedure ...................................................................................................................................92
3.2.2.3 Sampling.....................................................................................................................................92
3.2.2.4 Extraction....................................................................................................................................92
3.2.2.5 Analysis ......................................................................................................................................92
3.2.2.6 Interpretation...............................................................................................................................94
3.2.2.7 Air ...............................................................................................................................................94
3.2.2.8 Gas Spectrum – Types of Faults ................................................................................................94
3.2.2.8.1 Hot Metal Surface ..................................................................................................................94
3.2.2.8.2 Examples of Hot Metal Surfaces............................................................................................94
3.2.2.9 Overheated cellulose ..................................................................................................................95
3.2.2.9.1 Examples of Overheated Cellulose........................................................................................95
3.2.2.10 Electrical Faults ..........................................................................................................................95
3.2.2.10.1 Examples of Electrical Faults ...............................................................................................95
3.2.2.11 Factors affecting gas concentration in transformers ...................................................................96
3.2.2.11.1 Type and Brand of Oil ..........................................................................................................96
3.2.2.11.2 Oxygen .................................................................................................................................96
3.2.2.11.3 Load .....................................................................................................................................96
3.2.2.11.4 Oil Preservation Systems .....................................................................................................96
3.2.2.11.5 Gas Mixing ...........................................................................................................................97
3.2.2.11.6 Temperature.........................................................................................................................97
3.2.2.11.7 Gas Solubility in Oil ..............................................................................................................98
3.2.2.11.8 Other Factors .......................................................................................................................99
3.2.2.12 DGA Interpretation Methods .....................................................................................................101
3.2.2.12.1 Key Gas Method of Interpreting DGA .................................................................................101
3.2.2.12.2 Individual and Total Dissolved Key-Gas Concentration Method.........................................102
3.2.2.12.3 Rogers Ratio Method .........................................................................................................105
3.2.2.12.4 IEC Method ........................................................................................................................107
3.2.2.12.4.1 Carbon Dioxide/Carbon Monoxide (CO2/CO) Ratio............................................................ 107
3.2.2.12.4.2 IEC C2H2/H2 Ratio.................................................................................................................... 108
3.2.2.12.4.3 IEC Recommended Method of Interpretation ...................................................................... 108
3.2.2.12.5 Duval Triangle Method for Diagnosing a Transformer Problem Using Dissolved Gas
Analysis ...........................................................................................................................................109
3.2.2.12.6 ABB's Advanced Dissolved Gas Analysis Software (ADGA)..............................................112
3.2.3 Analysis of Particles in Transformer Oils ........................................................................... 113
3.2.3.1 Oil Sampling for Particle Analysis .............................................................................................113
3.2.3.2 Particle Counting ......................................................................................................................113
3.2.3.2.1 Normal and Abnormal Particle Count Levels .......................................................................114
3.2.3.3 Trace Metal Content of Particles...............................................................................................115
3.2.3.3.1 Method of Measurement ......................................................................................................115
3.2.3.3.2 Normal and Abnormal Metallic Content of Particles in Oil....................................................115
3.2.3.4 Diagnostic Examples of Particle Analysis .................................................................................116
3.2.3.5 Effect of particles on dielectric strength of insulating oil ...........................................................117
3.2.3.5.1 Current filtering practices on new transformers....................................................................117
3.2.3.5.2 Classification of contamination level ....................................................................................118
3.2.3.5.2.1 Bare electrodes.......................................................................................................................... 118
3.2.3.5.2.2 Covered electrodes ................................................................................................................... 118
3.2.3.5.3 Contamination deposited on insulating surface....................................................................119
3.2.3.5.4 Recommended corrective action..........................................................................................120
3.2.4 Winding Resistance Test..................................................................................................... 121
3.2.4.1 Measurement Method for Winding Resistance Measurement ..................................................121
3.2.5 Transformer Turns Ratio Test (TTR)................................................................................... 122
3.2.6 Insulation resistance............................................................................................................ 124
3.2.6.1 Measurement............................................................................................................................125
3.2.6.2 Interpretation.............................................................................................................................126
3.2.6.3 Polarization Index .....................................................................................................................127
3.2.7 Insulation Power Factor Tests............................................................................................. 127
3.2.7.1 Two-Winding Transformer ........................................................................................................128
3.2.7.1.1 Testing of Two-Winding Transformers .................................................................................129
VIII
3.2.7.2 Three-Winding Transformer......................................................................................................132
3.2.7.3 Typical Insulation Power Factor Values ....................................................................................133
3.2.7.4 General Guidelines for Assessing Power Factor Values ..........................................................134
3.2.7.5 Power Factor Tip-up Tests........................................................................................................135
3.2.8 Core Insulation Resistance Measurement .......................................................................... 135
3.2.8.1 Measurement and Diagnosis of Inadvertent Core Grounds ......................................................135
3.2.9 Excitation Current Tests ...................................................................................................... 137
3.2.9.1 Measurement Setup .................................................................................................................138
3.2.9.2 Analysis of Excitation Current Results ......................................................................................141
3.2.10 Infrared Thermography Analysis of Transformers and Accessories............................... 141
3.2.10.1 The Thermography Process .....................................................................................................141
3.2.10.2 Criteria for Evaluating Infrared Measurements .........................................................................142
3.2.10.3 Example Uses of Infrared Thermography diagnostics on Power Transformers ........................143
3.2.10.3.1 Loose connection at bushing outlet terminal ......................................................................143
3.2.10.3.2 Blocked oil flow in radiators or radiator shut off ..................................................................143
3.2.10.3.3 LTC overheating.................................................................................................................144
3.2.10.3.4 Low oil level in transformer or bushing ...............................................................................144
3.2.10.3.5 Moisture contamination of surge arrester ...........................................................................144
3.2.11 Bushings ......................................................................................................................... 145
3.2.11.1 ANSI & IEC – Common Diagnostic Tools .................................................................................145
3.2.11.1.1 Oil leakage inspection ........................................................................................................145
3.2.11.1.2 Insulator inspection and cleaning .......................................................................................145
3.2.11.1.2.1 Porcelain insulators ................................................................................................................. 145
3.2.11.1.2.2 Silicon rubber insulators ......................................................................................................... 145
3.2.11.1.3 Thermovision......................................................................................................................145
3.2.11.1.4 Oil sampling from bushing ..................................................................................................146
3.2.11.1.5 Dissolved Gas Analysis (DGA)...........................................................................................148
3.2.11.1.6 Moisture analysis................................................................................................................148
3.2.11.1.7 Dielectric Frequency Response Analysis (DFRA) ..............................................................149
3.2.11.1.8 Partial Discharge measurements .......................................................................................149
3.2.11.1.9 De-polymerization analysis.................................................................................................149
3.2.11.2 Diagnostics techniques for bushings complying with the ANSI/IEEE Standards ......................150
3.2.11.2.1 Condenser Bushing Power Factor Tests............................................................................150
3.2.11.2.2 Factors Affecting C1 and C2 Capacitance and Power Factor Measurements....................151
3.2.11.2.3 Bushing Hot Collar Test......................................................................................................154
3.2.11.2.4 What to do when Bushing Power Factor Tests are Doubtful ..............................................156
3.2.11.2.5 Special Case – Type “U” Bushings ....................................................................................156
3.2.11.2.5.1 History ....................................................................................................................................... 156
3.2.11.2.5.2 Recommendation..................................................................................................................... 162
3.2.11.2.6 Type “T” Bushings ..............................................................................................................165
3.2.11.3 Diagnostics and Conditioning on ABB Bushings Complying with the IEC Standard .................166
3.2.11.3.1 Capacitance and tanG measurement ..................................................................................167
3.2.11.3.2 Temperature correction ......................................................................................................167
3.2.12 Measurements for Assessing the Condition of OLTCs/LTCs ......................................... 170
3.2.12.1 Number of Operations ..............................................................................................................170
3.2.12.2 Resistance of the Electrical Connections..................................................................................170
3.2.12.3 Temperature .............................................................................................................................170
3.2.12.4 Motor Current............................................................................................................................170
3.2.12.5 Acoustic Signal .........................................................................................................................170
3.2.12.6 Relay Timing.............................................................................................................................171
3.2.12.7 Gas-in-Oil Analysis ...................................................................................................................171
3.2.12.7.1 Items Specific to the European Practice............................................................................171
3.2.12.7.1.1 Scope ........................................................................................................................................ 171
3.2.12.7.1.2 History ....................................................................................................................................... 171
3.2.12.7.1.3 Faults in OLTCs possible to indicate by DGA ..................................................................... 172
3.2.12.7.1.4 The Stenestam ratio ................................................................................................................ 172
3.2.12.7.1.5 Important principals for interpretation of DGAs in OLTC.................................................... 172
3.2.12.7.1.6 Interpreting the Stenestam ratio ............................................................................................ 172
3.2.12.7.1.7 Typical gas concentrations..................................................................................................... 173
3.2.12.7.1.8 Important to bear in mind........................................................................................................ 174
3.2.12.7.2 North-American Practice ....................................................................................................174
IX
3.2.12.8 Moisture ....................................................................................................................................175
3.3 ADVANCED DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS .................................................................................................. 176
3.3.1 Assessment of Mechanical Properties - Frequency Response Analysis (FRA) ................. 176
3.3.1.1 Purpose of the measurement....................................................................................................176
3.3.1.2 General description...................................................................................................................176
3.3.1.3 Principle of FRA measurement .................................................................................................177
3.3.1.4 Measurement procedure...........................................................................................................178
3.3.1.4.1 General prescriptions ...........................................................................................................178
3.3.1.4.2 Test Connection Protocol.....................................................................................................179
3.3.1.5 Reporting FRA measurements .................................................................................................184
3.3.1.5.1 Baseline Data.......................................................................................................................184
3.3.1.5.2 Comparison with Sister Units ...............................................................................................184
3.3.1.5.3 Phase Comparisons.............................................................................................................184
3.3.1.6 References/Standards ..............................................................................................................184
3.3.1.7 Observed signal distortions during measurements ...................................................................185
3.3.1.7.1 Influence of unshielded wire connections.............................................................................185
3.3.1.7.2 Influence of the coaxial cables .............................................................................................185
3.3.1.8 Examples of Problems Diagnosed using FRA ..........................................................................186
3.3.1.8.1 Axial Winding Collapse ........................................................................................................186
3.3.1.8.2 Hoop Buckling......................................................................................................................187
3.3.1.8.3 Shorted Turns ......................................................................................................................189
3.3.2 Assessment of Thermal Properties ..................................................................................... 191
3.3.2.1 Degree of Polymerization (DP) [] ..............................................................................................191
3.3.2.1.1 DP versus Life Plots.............................................................................................................191
3.3.2.1.2 Latest Research Findings on DP Analysis ...........................................................................194
3.3.2.2 Furanic Compound Analysis .....................................................................................................194
3.3.2.2.1 Origin of Furanic Compounds ..............................................................................................194
3.3.2.2.2 Detection of Furanic Compounds.........................................................................................195
3.3.2.2.3 Correlation Curves of Furanic Content with DP ...................................................................195
3.3.2.2.4 Issues to Consider in Using Furan Analysis.........................................................................196
3.3.2.3 Dielectric Frequency Response as a Tool for Troubleshooting Insulation Power ..........................
Factor Problems ......................................................................................................................197
3.3.2.3.1 Introduction ..........................................................................................................................197
3.3.2.3.2 Dielectric frequency response and X-Y model .....................................................................198
3.3.2.4 Causes of High Power Factor in Transformer Insulation ..........................................................201
3.3.2.4.1 Comparison of DFR to Power Factor Measurement ............................................................201
3.3.2.4.1.1 Influence of Oil Conductivity and Moisture on PF and DFR ................................................ 202
3.3.2.5 Dielectric Frequency Response Signature and Identification Techniques ................................203
3.3.2.5.1 Identification of high Core-Grounding Resistance Problems................................................204
3.3.2.5.2 Identification of Paper Contamination Problems ..................................................................207
3.3.2.5.3 Low Temperature Effect on Insulation Power Factor ...........................................................207
3.3.2.6 Summary ..................................................................................................................................209
3.3.3 Assessment of Electrical Properties - Partial Discharge Measurements ........................... 210
3.3.3.1 Purpose of measurement..........................................................................................................210
3.3.3.2 Electrical PD Measurement on Transformers ...........................................................................211
3.3.3.2.1 Calibration............................................................................................................................212
3.3.3.2.2 PD measuring procedure .....................................................................................................213
3.3.3.2.3 An Advanced PD system .....................................................................................................213
3.3.3.3 Procedure for Investigation of PD Sources ...............................................................................215
3.3.3.4 Acoustical Partial Discharge Measurement on Transformers ...................................................220
3.3.3.4.1 Acoustic PD Wave Characterization ....................................................................................220
3.3.3.4.2 Acoustic Partial Discharge Localization ...............................................................................222
4 ONLINE DIAGNOSTIC MONITORS FOR TRANSFORMERS AND KEY ACCESSORIES........... 224
4.1 POWER TRANSFORMER (TANK & CORE) ..................................................................................... 224
4.2 LOAD TAP CHANGER .................................................................................................................. 225
4.3 BUSHING & CT .......................................................................................................................... 225
4.4 EXAMPLE MONITORING SYSTEMS ............................................................................................... 226
5 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE OF TRANSFORMERS ................................................................. 234
5.1 BASIC AGEING PROCESSES ........................................................................................................ 234
X
5.1.1 Introduction.......................................................................................................................... 234
5.1.2 Paper Degradation ..............................................................................................................235
5.1.3 On-site Drying Methods....................................................................................................... 237
5.1.3.1 Traditional methods ..................................................................................................................237
5.1.3.2 On-site drying with low frequency heating (LFH) in combination with hot-oil spray .................238
5.1.4 Oil reclaiming....................................................................................................................... 239
5.1.4.1 Online oil reclaiming technology ..............................................................................................239
5.1.4.2 Comparison with oil change......................................................................................................239
5.1.4.3 Long- term stability ...................................................................................................................240
5.2 GENERAL MAINTENANCE OF TRANSFORMERS ............................................................................. 241
5.2.1 Recommended schedule of Maintenance activities ............................................................ 241
5.2.1.1 Monthly Maintenance Schedule................................................................................................241
5.2.1.2 Quarterly Maintenance Schedule..............................................................................................242
5.2.1.3 Annual Maintenance Schedule with The Transformer De-energized........................................243
5.2.2 Maintenance of Components .............................................................................................. 244
5.2.2.1 Transformer liquid and insulation..............................................................................................244
5.2.2.2 Bushings and joints...................................................................................................................245
5.2.2.3 Off-load tap changer (DETC) ....................................................................................................245
5.2.2.4 On-load tap changer .................................................................................................................246
5.2.2.5 Motor drive unit .........................................................................................................................246
5.2.2.6 Oil filtering unit ..........................................................................................................................246
5.2.2.7 Coolers .....................................................................................................................................246
5.2.2.8 Liquid conservator with rubber diaphragm (COPS) ..................................................................246
5.2.2.9 Gaskets.....................................................................................................................................246
5.2.2.10 Surface protection.....................................................................................................................247
5.2.2.10.1 Painted surfaces.................................................................................................................247
5.2.2.10.2 Zinc coated surfaces ..........................................................................................................247
5.2.3 Investigation of Transformer Disturbances ......................................................................... 247
5.2.3.1 Recording of disturbances ........................................................................................................247
5.2.3.2 Fault localizations advice for oil-immersed transformers ..........................................................248
5.2.4 Internal Inspection ............................................................................................................... 250
5.2.4.1 Opening the Transformer..........................................................................................................251
5.2.4.2 The Inspection ..........................................................................................................................251
5.2.4.3 Electrical Tests .........................................................................................................................253
5.2.5 Maintenance of Bushings .................................................................................................... 253
5.2.6 Maintenance and Service of OLTCs/LTCs ......................................................................... 255
5.2.7 General Quality Information for Various Types of LTCs ..................................................... 257
5.2.7.1 North-American Practices .........................................................................................................257
5.2.7.2 European Practice ....................................................................................................................261
6 REPAIR, REFURBISHMENT AND ON-SITE REPAIR ................................................................... 263
6.1 PREPARATION PHASE ................................................................................................................. 264
6.2 UNTANKING AND DISASSEMBLY OF ACTIVE PART ........................................................................... 265
6.3 REPAIR OF THE TRANSFORMER ................................................................................................... 265
6.4 ASSEMBLY AND TANKING OF THE ACTIVE PART ............................................................................. 266
6.5 DRYING ..................................................................................................................................... 267
6.6 FINAL ASSEMBLY ........................................................................................................................ 268
6.7 HIGH VOLTAGE TESTING ............................................................................................................. 268
6.8 QUALITY PLAN .......................................................................................................................... 269
6.9 FACILITIES SPECIFIC FOR ON-SITE REPAIR................................................................................... 269
6.9.1 Temporary Workshops ........................................................................................................ 269
6.9.1.1 Steel Buildings ..........................................................................................................................269
6.9.1.2 Large Tents...............................................................................................................................270
6.9.1.3 Foundation for a Temporary Workshop ....................................................................................270
6.9.2 Facilities for Heavy Lifting ...................................................................................................271
6.9.3 Moisture control ................................................................................................................... 271
6.9.4 Oil processing...................................................................................................................... 271
6.9.5 Drying equipment ................................................................................................................ 271
6.9.6 High voltage test equipment................................................................................................ 272
XI
7 ENVIRONMENTAL ASPECTS ....................................................................................................... 273
7.1 CONTAMINATION OF OILS WITH PCB (POLYCHLORINATED BIPHENYLS) ......................................... 273
7.1.1 General................................................................................................................................ 273
7.1.2 Dehalogenation Processes Using Sodium and Lithium Derivatives ................................... 274
7.1.3 Dehalogenation Processes Using Polyethyleneglycol and Potassium Hydroxide.............. 274
7.1.4 Dehalogenation in Continuous Mode by Closed Circuit Process........................................ 274
7.2 ELECTROMAGNETIC COMPATIBILITY (EMC) ................................................................................. 274
7.2.1 Introduction.......................................................................................................................... 274
7.2.2 Methods to Reduce EMF Levels in Existing Substations.................................................... 275
7.3 AUDIBLE NOISE .......................................................................................................................... 275
7.3.1 Introduction.......................................................................................................................... 275
7.3.2 Background ......................................................................................................................... 276
7.3.2.1 Characteristics of Transformer Noise .......................................................................................276
7.3.2.2 Propagation of Sound ...............................................................................................................276
7.3.3 Criteria for Community Noise Levels................................................................................... 276
7.3.4 Requirements ...................................................................................................................... 277
7.3.5 Methods of Substation Noise Control.................................................................................. 277
7.4 RELEASE OF INSULATING OIL ...................................................................................................... 279
7.4.1 Introduction.......................................................................................................................... 279
7.4.2 Use of Synthetic Ester......................................................................................................... 279
7.4.3 Use of Natural Ester .. ........................................................................................................ 280
8 ECONOMICS OF TRANSFORMER ASSET MANAGEMENT........................................................ 281
8.1 FAILURE STATISTICS FOR POWER TRANSFORMERS ...................................................................... 281
8.1.1 CIGRE Survey of Failures in Large Power Transformers .................................................. 281
8.1.2 Canadian Electricity Association Forced Outage Report ................................................... 283
8.2 ECONOMICS OF TRANSFORMER MANAGEMENT FOR FLEETS AND SPECIFIC UNITS ............................ 286
8.2.1 Introduction.......................................................................................................................... 286
8.2.2 General Concept for Economics of Transformer Management .......................................... 287
8.2.3 Description of the Simulation Model.................................................................................... 288
8.2.4 Case Study by a Utility ........................................................................................................289
8.2.5 Conclusions ......................................................................................................................... 291
REFERENCES.......................................................................................................................................... 292
INDEX ....................................................................................................................................................... 303
ABB SERVICE BROCHURES ................................................................................................................. 307
ABB TRES NORTH AMERICA SERVICE BROCHURES....................................................................... 333
XII
1 TRANSFORMER DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS [1]
1.1 CONFIGURATION
There are two basic configurations for power transformers: core form and shell form. The
principal physical difference between the two constructions is related to the geometry of
the magnetic circuit and the position, alignment, and types of the windings employed for
each design.
Fundamentally, for the shell form designs, the magnetic circuit forms a shell around a
major portion of the windings. Three phase shell form designs use 4 and 7 limb cores with
the usual horizontal orientation of the core limbs. Shell form 7 limb cores are used on
newer shell form designs due to lower weight, manufacturing simplicity, and lower core
loss. Single phase shell form transformers use 3 limb cores. In the shell form design, the
windings are interleaved; that is, the high-voltage and low-voltage windings are
subdivided into groups with the groups adjacent to each other in the axial (horizontal)
direction. Each group is assembled using interconnected rectangular pancake coils.
In core form designs the magnetic circuit forms a core through the windings. Three phase
core form transformers are usually constructed with a three limb core that has the center
limbs vertically oriented with the top and bottom yokes for main flux return paths oriented
horizontally. When shipping height becomes a limiting design factor, a five limb core may
be used to keep the shipping height within the shipping limitation. This configuration
enables the yoke depth to be reduced by providing a return flux path external to the
wound limbs. The only other occasion in which a three-phase, five limb core might be
necessary is when it is required to provide a value of zero sequence impedance of similar
magnitude to the positive sequence impedance. The core form single phase geometry
uses 2, 3, or 4 limb cores. Generally, the core form design uses several types of circular
coils (layer, helical, disc) that are concentric with each other and the vertical core limb.
For power transformers, there will be design requirements where one form of construction
will have an advantage over the other. The major parametric elements of the comparison
are MVA size, voltage class, impedance requirements, and loss performance
characteristics. ABB has the flexibility in design knowledge and manufacturing capability
to produce either construction.
The mechanical design of a transformer involves the analysis and determination of the
expected operational forces, the structural stress analysis of the insulation system and
support elements, and the proper choice of materials. A transformer must be strong
enough to withstand the mechanical stresses imposed by system-related events such as
short circuits. The mechanical stresses developed during normal operation are low, but
the stresses generated by a system short circuit event can be quite large. Also, the
13
magnitude of these stresses increase with the size and complexity of the transformer. The
majority of the mechanical stresses must be taken by the insulation system, which is
primarily composed of cellulose-based materials. These materials are weakest in bending
and tension. It is therefore best to apply these materials in compression. Also, to keep the
total forces as low as possible, the design of the windings should be made using the best
arrangement and overall geometry of the individual windings.
Temperature is one of the most important factors affecting transformer life. As the
temperature of the insulation increases, the insulation life decreases. The transformer
must be designed to operate within the guaranteed temperature parameters and the
prescribed standard allowances to ensure long transformer life. In an oil-filled transformer,
the insulating oil is used to conduct the heat away from the windings and the magnetic
core. To perform this function, the oil must circulate through the winding assembly and
usually through externally applied cooling apparatus.
For thermosiphon oil flow (natural oil flow), oil circulation is created when the weight of the
column of oil in the cooling equipment is greater than the weight of the column of oil in the
core and coil assembly. Also, the center of cooling must be above the center of heating.
This distance has a direct affect on the top-to-bottom temperature difference – the larger
the distance between the center of cooling and the center of heating, the larger the oil
flow and the lower the top-to-bottom temperature difference. This configuration is defined
in the standards as ONAN (oil natural, air natural) – the old nomenclature was OA.
x ONAN/ONAF (oil natural, air natural/oil natural, air forced – 100 %/133 %) – the
old designation was OA/FA
x ONAN/ONAF/ONAF – (oil natural, air natural/oil forced, air forced/ oil forced, air
forced – 100 %/133 %/167 %) – the old designation was OA/FA/FA
For larger transformer ratings, some design configurations may require the addition of oil
circulating pumps to meet the required temperature rise guarantees. With the addition of
oil circulating pumps, the top-to-bottom oil temperature difference attained by the forced
oil flow is usually in the order of single digits. The increased oil flow is usually
accompanied by internal means to direct the oil flow through the windings; this is
generally known as directed flow. When two stages of auxiliary cooling are employed, the
14
equipment is generally divided equally among the two stages. The designation for cooling
with auxiliary fans and pumps is defined in the standards as (past nomenclature shown in
parentheses):
x ONAN/ODAF (oil natural, air natural/oil directed, air forced – 100 %/133 %) – the
old designation was OA/FOA.
x ONAN/ODAF/ODAF (oil natural, air natural/oil directed, air forced/ oil directed, air
forced – 100 %/133 %/167 %) – the old designation was OA/FOA/FOA.
Other configurations for the use of auxiliary fans and pumps are sometimes applied, such
as using fans only for the first rating increase and energizing all of the pumps for the
second stage of cooling.
Additionally, transformers can be designed with a single rating that uses auxiliary cooling
equipment consisting of oil circulating pumps with an associated oil-to-air heat exchanger
or forced oil with a water-cooled heat exchanger.
The transformer insulation system must be designed to withstand the normal operating
voltages as well as over-voltages during lightning events, system short circuits, and
system switching surges. In addition, consideration must be given to produce
transformers that withstand these voltages with all elements operating below the corona
onset voltage.
The ABB Shell Form-Form Fit design features a rectangular shaped coil system made up
of a series of inter-connected pancake coils. The coil and insulation assembly is mounted
15
vertically in the tank bottom section. The core is positioned horizontally around the
outside of the winding and acts as a protective shell around the coil. The upper section
of the tank fits snugly over the core and coils to form a unit assembly with the
mechanical support completely outside the winding (see Figure 1-1).
The heat generated by the core and coils is dissipated by the circulation of the oil. The oil
flow from the bottom to the top of the tank is supported by the temperature differential or
thermal head during self-cooled operation. The addition of pumps and fans for forced
cooling will increase the flow of oil through the core and coils and the flow of air through
the heat exchanger. With either mode of cooling, the oil passes through a heat exchanger
where it cools prior to reentering the tank at the bottom.
The shell form insulation system consists of high dielectric strength pressboard sheets
and precisely located oil spaces designed to control voltage stress concentration.
The coils in a shell form design are large surface area pancake coils, and they are
assembled into winding groups with their faces adjacent to flat pressboard washers
which contain a planned pattern of spacer blocks cemented to the surface. The spacer
blocks provide a uniform support system to the turns and strands of the individual coils.
The complete phase is installed vertically in the tank bottom, and the core is stacked
around it. The upper section of the tank is fitted snugly over the core and shimmed with
vertical wooden slits spaced around the periphery of the core.
The total force between transformer winding groups varies as the square of the ampere
turns per group. If the current during fault conditions is ten times the normal load current,
16
the short circuit force will be one hundred times the normal load winding forces. As
transformers get larger, the ampere turns per winding group are reduced in a shell form
design by increasing the number of winding groups, or high-low spaces; thus controlling
the magnitude of the total force. Increasing the number of high-low spaces does not
increase the length of the average mean turn in a shell form winding; therefore, it can be
done economically.
The forces within successive winding groups in a shell form transformer are in opposite
directions. As they traverse the winding, the forces tend to cancel each other out. As a
result, the net total restraining force that must be applied external to the windings is only
the force corresponding to a single pair of winding groups (see Figure 1-2).
Figure 1-2: Section Through a Shell Form Winding Group with a High-Low Coil Configuration
(arrows illustrate mechanical forces)
In addition to the control of total force magnitude available in a shell form design, the unit
stresses on the winding insulation structures are kept at a low level. The major winding
force is perpendicular to the face of the pancake coils, and each coil is supported by
spacer blocks on its adjacent pressboard washers. Between spacers, the windings act as
uniformly loaded beams, and the total winding force is transmitted through the group by
compression of the spacer blocks. The shell form design uses large pancake coils; thus a
large number of spacer blocks are available to absorb the total force, and the unit
stresses in the pressboard are relatively low.
The total force magnitude in a shell form design can be reduced considerably with
multiple high-low coil arrangements. Even with this advantage it is essential to have a
rugged mechanical structure to withstand the ultimate forces encountered during thru-
fault conditions. In the ABB Shell Form-Form Fit design the major components of force
are taken by well-braced structures completely outside the winding. The close-fitting
Form Fit tank and the core assembly combine to restrain the total forces acting on the
winding. For the portions of the winding that are above and below the core, heavy steel
structural members welded to the tank provide the restraint for the forces. The bracing
17
structures are completely outside the winding and can be reinforced without any
compromises in winding design.
The ABB Shell Form-Form Fit design offers a combination of controlled maximum stress,
inherent stability, and high mechanical strength to withstand the forces produced by
system thru-faults. The use of the Form Fit tank as the major structural support makes up
to a 20 % reduction in total weight and as much as 40 % reduction in oil volume in ABB
shell form large power transformers possible (see Figure 1-3).
Figure 1-3: Partial Cutaway of a Shell Form Transformer Showing Support Structure for Core and
Coils
The HV and LV coils in an ABB Shell Form Transformer are arranged vertically in the
tank and pressboard insulation washers containing spacer blocks in a pre-designed
pattern are located on either side of each coil. The spacer block pattern provides ducts
on both sides of the conductor through which the oil travels from the bottom to the top of
the tank. The core in a shell form transformer is a stack of narrow-width steel punchings.
18
Oil flowing on both sides of the core adequately cools this area; therefore, oil ducts within
the magnetic circuit are not necessary.
The oil flow in the transformer tank during self-cooled operation is supported by the
temperature differential between the oil at the top and bottom of the tank. This
temperature differential, or thermal head, is approximately 12 °C for a shell form
transformer (see Figure 1-4).
Figure 1-4: Partial Cutaway of a Shell Form Transformer Illustrating OA (Self-Cooled) Cooling
Action
As the load on a transformer increases, the energy generated by the losses in the coil
system will increase in proportion to the square of the increase in load. Forced cooling is
applied to dissipate this additional energy and allow the transformer to operate at the
increased load and within temperature guarantees.
ABB applies both pumps and fans for forced cooled ratings on shell form transformers.
The pumps augment the circulation of oil that exists due to the thermal head, and since
the coils are positioned vertically, no barriers are necessary to direct the oil flow. The
additional oil flow provided by the pumps virtually eliminates the oil temperature
differential in the transformer and reduces the winding hottest spot temperature as much
as 10°C. The fans direct the airflow over the heat exchanger at a high velocity, thus
improving energy transfer to the atmosphere.
The addition of fans alone to a typical radiator bank will significantly increase its energy
dissipation; fans used in conjunction with pumps to provide forced air and forced oil
cooling will further increase the cooling capability of the same radiator bank. The forced
19
cooling can be operated continuously for heavily loaded transformers, or it can be
actuated in stages as the load increases.
Forced oil-forced air cooling is the most efficient method of increasing the capacity of a
transformer. This method of cooling coupled with the inherent thermal characteristics of
the ABB Shell Form Transformer design offer the highest thermal capability in large
power transformers.
Figure 1-5: Partial Cutaway of a Shell Form Transformer Illustrating FOA (Forced-Cooled) Cooling
Action
The effect of overvoltage and system surge conditions on the windings of a transformer
is determined by the characteristics of the particular coil and insulation system. As this
voltage surge enters the transformer winding, the initial voltage distribution will be
directly determined by the capacitance networks of the coil and winding system (see
Figure 1-6). Oscillations may develop as the surge progresses through the coil system,
which for certain designs may be amplified by the natural oscillation in these systems to a
value greater than the initial crest. This overvoltage condition may concentrate at some
point in the winding, such as the first several turns at the line end of the winding or
around a tap section, and stress the turn-to-turn insulation in these areas.
20
Figure 1-6: Equivalent Inductance-Capacitance Network of a Shell Form Winding Section
The coil assembly of an ABB Shell Form Transformer consists of a relatively few
“pancake” coils with a broad cross-sectional area and a narrow coil edge (see Figure
1-6). Since the capacitances between coils and from coil to ground are directly
proportional, respective to the cross-sectional area of the coil and the area of its edge,
the shell form coil system has a high coil-to-coil and a low coil-to-ground capacitance.
When the ratio of coil-to-coil capacitance to the coil-to-ground capacitance is high, as it is
in a shell form transformer design, the voltage distribution with rapidly rising voltage
surges is more nearly uniform.
Figure 1-7: Shell Form Transformer - Cross-Section of Line End Coils within the Core Iron
21
The turn-to-turn voltage stresses due to the initial application of the surges are thereby
reduced in the shell form design insulation system, and the succeeding oscillations
developed in the winding are also reduced. The large inherent capacitance of the shell
form design causes the natural period of the winding oscillation to be relatively long,
thus allowing the voltage surges to decay to a low value before the winding
oscillations can develop to a significant magnitude.
The insulation structures between coils, between coils and core, and between winding
groups are made of high dielectric strength oil-impregnated sheets. Oil spaces are
provided with a precise relationship to the coil and pressboard structures to control
voltage stress concentrations. Specially formed insulation pieces are used over the coil
edge where the voltage stress is highest. This insulation is stressed in puncture rather
than creep for additional strength.
The pancake coils in a shell form transformer are arranged to terminate at the top of the
transformer where line end and tap connections can be made with a short lead. The
magnitude of circulating currents induced by high fields is minimized in an ABB Shell
Form Transformer because of the short lead length and unique subdivided lead
construction.
The inherent design characteristics of ABB Shell Form Transformers assure their reliable
operation. The performance of ABB Shell Form Transformers is verified by exclusive
modeling techniques prior to manufacture.
Core Form construction (see Figure 1-8) utilizes a series of cylindrical windings stacked
on a steel core. The core is at ground potential; therefore, the lowest voltage winding is
located adjacent to it, and the higher voltage windings are separated from the core in
order of voltage. The highest voltage winding is on the outside of the assembly.
The windings are supported laterally by laminated winding tubes and properly selected
conductor tension. Vertical support for the coils is provided by a plate type pressure ring
and lock plate assembly restrained by channel end frames.
22
Figure 1-8: Partial Cutaway of a Core Form Transformer
Cooling of the core and coil assembly is accomplished by oil circulation through ducts
between the coils and also ducts within the core. The oil flow from the bottom to the top
of the tank is supported by the thermal head or temperature differential from the bottom
to the top of the transformer. The oil passes through a heat exchanger, where it cools
before reentering the transformer at the bottom.
The individual turns in the coil are insulated with high-density cellulose tape. Oil spaces
are provided between the disc sections of the coil with laminated spacer blocks. The oil
spaces between coils are maintained by vertical spacer rods.
The coil system of a core form transformer consists of cylindrical type windings placed on
a vertical steel core. The forces created by thru-fault currents tend to separate these
windings. The forces on the outer (or HV) winding push the winding out and place the
23
conductors in tension. The force on the inner (or LV) winding acts to compress the
winding, and the stress is transmitted to the winding tube (see Figure 1-9).
Figure 1-9: Section Through a Core Form Winding Group with an Expanded View of One Coil and
Spacers (arrows illustrate mechanical forces)
If the electrical centers of the coils are displaced by taps or an unequal winding
arrangement, a vertical force is introduced, which tends to telescope the windings. The
vertical forces can exceed 800,000 pounds per phase during the thru-fault conditions.
The forces in a core form transformer increase with transformer size; therefore, the
mechanical properties of winding tubes, vertical spacers, and radial spacers are critical to
the mechanical strength of the design. The tensile strength of the HV winding conductor is
also a very important consideration.
The vertical forces that act to telescope the windings are transmitted through radial
spacers to the pressure rings and then to the core end frames at the end of the winding.
These forces are transmitted through the winding across the narrow face of the
conductor, resulting in a high per-unit stress on the conductor and spacers. The vertical
forces tend to compress the spacer material, and over a period of time will cause
looseness between the disc sections of the coils. Preventing this will require some means
provided to maintain compression on the winding.
On ABB Core Form designs, the horizontal and vertical forces occurring during thru-fault
conditions are calculated during the design of a transformer, and the support structure is
designed accordingly. The coils are pre-stressed at the time of assembly to maintain the
vertical dimensional tolerances and the tightness of the coils.
24
Figure 1-10: Partial Cutaway of a Core Form Transformer Showing the Support Structure for Core
and Coils
The energy generated by the losses in the core and coil system of a core form
transformer is transmitted to the heat exchanger by the circulation of oil through ducts
between the coils and ducts within the core. The oil flow is supported by the thermal head
in the tank. The HV winding in a core form transformer is made up of a series of disc
sections positioned horizontally on the winding tube. The oil must travel through both
horizontal and vertical ducts to properly cool the conductors. Typically, the LV coil
construction is a helical winding that uses insulated rectangular or transpose conductors
and is cooled by oil flow through ducts on either side of the coil. The core has a relatively
large cross-sectional area and is located inside the coil assembly where heat is
concentrated; therefore, ducts must be provided within the core to allow oil circulation for
cooling.
The plate type pressure rings, which are located at each end of the coil assembly, tend to
block the flow of oil through the coil assembly; therefore, ducts and barriers must be
provided to direct the oil flow to the inner windings.
Forced cooling is applied to core form design by adding high velocity fans to the heat
exchanges to increase energy dissipation. The oil circulation is supported by the thermal
head in the transformer tank (see Figure 1-11).
25
If pumps are added for forced oil circulation, baffles must be provided to direct the oil
flow, otherwise the greater part of the oil volume will move upward in the area between
the HV winding and the tank wall. The barriers used to direct forced oil flow will impede
the flow during self-cooled operation. Transformer designs with continuous forced
cooling, such as generator step-up units, can advantageously utilize the baffled
arrangement.
(a) (b)
Figure 1-11: Partial Cutaway of a Core Form Transformer Illustrating (a) ONAN (Self-Cooled)
Cooling Action; and (b) OFAF (Forced-Cooled) Cooling Action
ABB uses a patented bypass valve on the core form design, which allows the proper
thermosiphon action to function during self-cooled operation. It will also properly direct
forced oil flow so that pumps can be used to an advantage during forced-cooled
operation.
Overvoltage and system surge conditions can cause severe stresses on the insulation
system of core form transformers if the coil system is not arranged to distribute the
voltage surge uniformly across the winding. The initial distribution of a voltage surge is
determined by the ratio of the capacitance networks of the winding.
Transformers designed for service with system ratings of 69 kV or below generally utilize
a continuously wound HV coil made up of a column of disc sections separated by
horizontal oil ducts. The ratio of coil-to-coil capacitance to coil-to-ground capacitance will
be relatively low for this type of coil; however, additional insulation can be added in
critical areas to withstand any voltage surges.
26
Core form transformers used where system voltages are above 69 kV employ a variety of
winding configurations to increase the coil-to-coil capacitance, thus improving the
voltage surge distribution. HV coils for ABB Core Form Transformers in these voltage
ratings are mechanically similar to the continuous wound coils, except the turns are
interleaved to obtain a high series capacitance and a uniform voltage surge distribution.
Transformers rated above 100 MVA would require several conductors in parallel in order
to carry the current in the HV coils, and the winding procedure would also be very
complex.
The taps in a core form winding are brought out near the center of the coil in order to not
displace the electrical center of the coil. The tap leads are generally brought to a
switching mechanism at the top of the core and coil assembly (see Figure 1-12).
When underload taps are required, a small regulating winding is often employed. If tap
sections are placed in the HV coil, thyrister devices are used between the coil sections to
reduce the turn-to-turn voltage stresses.
Figure 1-12: Partial Cutaway of a Core Form Transformer Showing Coils, Insulation, and Tap
Leads
27
c) Resin-impregnated paper insulation. Bushing in which the major insulation is
impregnated with a curable epoxy resin
x Non-condenser type:
a) Solid core or alternate layers of solid and liquid insulation
b) Solid mass of homogeneous insulating material (e.g. solid porcelain)
c) Gas-filled
Bushings may be further classified as either having a test tap, potential tap (also
referred to as capacitance, voltage tap) or not.
Condenser bushings facilitate electric stress control through the insertion of floating
equalizer screens made of aluminium or semi-conducting materials. The condenser
core in which the screens are located decreases the field gradient and distributes the
field along the length of the insulator. The screens are located coaxially resulting in the
optimal balance between external flashover and internal puncture strength.
Bushings, as with other electrical equipment, are bound by industry standards, which
vary between international, regional and national standards for the electrical and
mechanical performance of bushings. The international IEC standard has a broad global
acceptance but it cannot address specific regional issues. For this reason regional
standards deal with application issues such as atmospheric and seismic conditions or in
some cases the interchangeability of products among different manufacturers.
The rest of this section covers general information for bushing designed under
ANSI/IEEE standards and will focus mainly on condenser type bushings. Similar design
criteria are used under IEC standards.
Parts of the section related to bushings are excerpts from the ABB Instruction Manual
[3]
28
the voltage tap stud whereas the C2 layer/foil is permanently connected to the grounded
mounting flange. Under normal operating conditions, the C1 layer/foil is automatically
grounded to the mounting flange with the help of the screw-in voltage tap cover that
makes a connection between the tap stud and the mounting flange. The C2 insulation
under normal operating condition is therefore shorted and not subjected to any
voltage stress.
When such a bushing is used in conjunction with a potential device, the voltage tap is
connected to this device. Under this condition, the C1 and C2 capacitances are in series
and perform like a voltage or potential divider. The voltage developed across the C2
capacitance is modified by the potential device and is used for operation of relays,
and other instruments. Also, the voltage tap can be used for measuring the power factor
and capacitance of C1 and C2 insulation of the bushing. In addition, this tap can be used
for monitoring the partial discharge during factory tests and insulation leakage current
(including partial discharge) during field service operation. For condenser bushings with
potential taps, the C2 capacitance is much greater than the C1 capacitance and may be
10 times as much. Figure 1-13 shows the construction details of a typical condenser
bushing with voltage rating 115kV and above.
Voltage
Oil Impregnated
Equalizers
Paper
C1 Layer Foil
CENTER CONDUCTOR
Voltage Tap
Stud
Mounting
Flange
(Grounded )
C2 Layer/Foil
C1 C2
Figure 1-13: Design Details of a Typical Condenser Bushing, 115kV and Above
29
layer/foil, which is inserted during the condenser winding process. The C1 layer/foil
is internally connected to the test tap. These bushings have an inherent C2
capacitance, which is formed by the insulation between the C1 layer and the mounting
flange. This insulation consists of a few layers of paper with adhesive, an oil gap
between the condenser core and the mounting flange, and the tap insulator. Under
normal operating conditions, the C1 layer/foil is automatically grounded to the mounting
flange with the help of the screw-in test tap cover that makes a connection between the
test tap spring and the flange. The C2 insulation under normal operating conditions is
therefore shorted and not subjected to any voltage stress. The test tap is used for
measuring the power factor and capacitance of C1 and C2 insulation of the bushing. In
addition, this tap is sometimes used for monitoring partial discharges during factory
tests and insulation leakage current (including partial discharge) during field service
operation. For condenser bushings with power factor taps, the C2 capacitance is
typically of the same order as the C1 capacitance. See Figure 1-14 for condenser design
and test tap details.
Voltage
Oil Impregnated
Equalizers
Paper
C1 Layer Foil
CENTER CONDUCTOR
Test Tap
Mounting
Flange
(Grounded )
C1 C2
Figure 1-14: Design Details of a Typical Condenser Bushings, 69 kV And Below
For both constructions the condenser is housed in a sealed cavity formed by the upper
and lower porcelain insulators, the high-strength, one-piece flange, and the metal or
glass expansion domes. This cavity along with the condenser is evacuated and then
filled with highly processed transformer oil for a very low moisture content and low
bushing power factor. This low moisture content and low power factor is maintained
throughout the life of the bushing by permanently sealing the bushing cavity. Spring-
loaded center clamping hardware is used to apply sufficient clamping pressure to seal
30
the bushing cavity during manufacturing. The upper and lower insulators, mounting
flange, flange extension, spring assembly, sight bowl, lower support, and clamping nut
form an oil-tight shell to contain the condenser and insulating oil. The sealing between
components is accomplished with oil-resistant “O-rings” in grooves and/or oil-resistant
flat fiber reinforced gaskets. This seal is never broken. A dehydrated nitrogen gas
cushion above the oil allows thermal expansion of the oil in the sealed cavity. The oil
level in the bushing can be monitored by visual inspection of the sight bowl.
Figure 1-15: Cutaway View of ABB Type AB Bushing 138 kV of Bushing Capacitances
31
1.6.2 BUSHINGS VOLTAGE TAP
ABB bushings rated 115 kV and higher (e.g. Type O Plus C) have a small housing
containing a voltage tap outlet just above the mounting flange. The terminal in the tap is
grounded by means of a spring clip in the tap cover. This tap is connected to one of the
inner foil electrodes of the condenser. In the factory, the voltage tap is tested at 20 kV,
50/60 HZ for 1 minute. Under normal operation, this tap is grounded. If the voltage tap is
used in conjunction with a potential/monitoring device, the voltage between the tap and
ground should be limited to 6 kV. While the purpose of the tap is to provide connection
to a bushing potential device, it also provides a convenient means for making
connections for measuring power factor and capacitance by the UST (Ungrounded
Specimen Test) method.
Many bushing users make it a practice to measure the UST power factor and
capacitance at the time of installation. We endorse this practice, and it is discussed in
more detail under the heading of “Maintenance.” When a connection is to be made to
the voltage tap, either for use with a potential device or for power factor measurement,
open the housing by removing the tap cover (item 19 in Figure 1-16). Assemble the
potential device connection or proceed with the power factor measurement.
32
Figure 1-16: Sectional View of Bushing
WARNING:
DO NOT APPLY VOLTAGE TO THE BUSHING WITH THE VOLTAGE TAP COVER
REMOVED, EXCEPT WHEN USING THE BUSHING WITH A POTENTIAL DEVICE
OR WHEN MEASURING POWER FACTOR. IF THE TAP IS NOT GROUNDED, THE
VOLTAGE MAY EXCEED THE INSULATION DIELECTRIC STRENGTH, RESULTING
IN A FLASHOVER. THE VOLTAGE ON THE TAP MUST NOT EXCEED 5 kV WHEN
MEASURING POWER FACTOR. FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE GUIDELINES
COULD RESULT IN SEVERE PERSONAL INJURY, DEATH, OR PROPERTY
DAMAGE.
33
1.6.3 CONNECTIONS
1.6.3.1 INTERNAL ELECTRICAL CONNECTIONS
The method used in making connections between a bushing and the apparatus on
which it is mounted will depend upon the type of connection used in the apparatus.
WARNING:
DO NOT OPERATE OR TEST A BUSHING WITH A LOW INTERNAL OIL LEVEL.
THIS COULD RESULT IN SERIOUS DAMAGE TO THE BUSHING, APPARATUS ON
WHICH THE BUSHING IS MOUNTED, AND/OR THE TESTING EQUIPMENT BEING
USED. OPERATION COULD RESULT IN SEVERE PERSONAL INJURY, DEATH, OR
PROPERTY DAMAGE.
1.6.5 PAINTING
The metal parts at the top end are painted for protection against the weather. Care
should be used to prevent scratching these painted surfaces. If the metal becomes
exposed, the area should be wiped with a commercial safety solvent and then wiped
dry. The cleaned area should then be coated with suitable outdoor gray enamel paint.
34
1.7 ON-LOAD TAP CHANGERS [5]
1.7.1 INTRODUCTIONS
There are some differences between tap-changers used under IEEE standards and tap-
changers used under IEC standards. The main differences are listed in Table 1-1.
Current Limiting Method Mainly resistor type Resistor and reactor type
The tap (regulation) winding in a load tap changing transformer is used to adjust the
number of transformer winding turns, usually to keep a constant voltage on the
secondary side of the transformer. If many electrical steps are required a plus/minus
connection or a coarse/fine connection is used. A plus/minus connection enables the
tapped winding to either add or subtract its voltage from the main winding. A coarse/fine
connection enables a coarse winding to be added to the regulating winding. The switch
that makes this connection is named change-over selector.
On-load tap-changers must also be able to switch between the different positions
without interrupting the current flow. Different designed practices are used under IEC
35
and IEEE guidelines to achieve this smooth transition. The methods are outlined in the
sections below.
Voltage change must be provided smoothly and efficiently without interrupting the
secondary current flow, up to and including full load at the maximum nameplate rating,
plus any additional overload. When changing tap positions, the LTC mechanism must
“make before break” to avoid opening the secondary circuit. This causes the taps to be
connected together each time the LTC makes a voltage step. Electrically, this is a short
circuit in which a circulating current flows. The method used to limit this circulating
current defines the basic differences between the two types of LTC: reactance and
resistance types.
Both types use stationary and moving contacts. In some designs, the moving contacts
are located on an arm or shaft in the center of the fixed contacts and move over the
fixed contacts in a circular fashion. As the moving contacts make connection with each
fixed contact, a tap change is made.
1
Portions of this section are reprinted with permission from Electrical World Magazine, June
1995, copyright by The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc. with all rights reserved. This reprint
implies no endorsement, either tacit or expressed, of any company, product, service, or
investment opportunity.
36
preventive auto transformer fails, the entire transformer must be taken out of service,
and the main core and coil assembly may be contaminated with carbon and copper
particles. A costly transformer repair may be the result. To reduce this possibility, the
preventive auto transformer can be located in a separate tank or compartment.
Reactance type LTCs are designed to operate continuously in the bridged position, thus
the need for the preventive auto to carry the full load current plus the circulating current.
However, a major shortcoming of the reactance type LTC is that the inherent inductance
of the preventive auto transformer increases the arcing time as the fixed and moving
contacts separate. Three different methods minimize the effect of this arcing and extend
contact life for as long as possible between overhauls.
1.7.2.3 ARCING CONTROL METHODS
Circulating
Currents
Preventive Auto
37
Regulating Winding
Transfer
Switches
Preventive Auto
If the LTC is operated manually, movement must be fast and complete to limit contact
arcing. In a vacuum diverter LTC, the tap-selector contacts, diverter switches, and
vacuum bottles are connected by an extensive motor-driven gear train. Limit switches
stop the motor when a proper continuous operating position has been reached. In the
case of drive failure, it is possible for the mechanism to stop in an off-tap position so
that only one-half of the preventive auto transformer is in the circuit to carry the
circulating current. Most manufacturers state that, if this occurs, the mechanism must be
returned to a normal operating position as soon as possible or the transformer load
must be reduced to one-half of the nameplate rating. This off-tap position can also occur
in the arcing switch-and-tap selector type of reactance LTC.
Several users require that the preventive auto transformer be sized twice as large as
the normal center-tapped auto transformer and an alarm be included to avoid damage
from this condition. Manual operation of the vacuum diverter LTC, while energized, is
not recommended. If a vacuum bottle failed during a manual tap change, there would be
no way to stop the tap change from being completed, possibly damaging the
transformer and injuring the operator.
38
contacts into a vacuum bottle via two diverter switches. Because the arcing contacts are
housed in the vacuum bottle, there is no arcing to contaminate the oil (see Figure 1-20).
Minor arcing can occur in the switches that divert the current to the vacuum bottle.
Concentric drive shafts house the main current carrying contacts, diverter switches, and
vacuum bottles. These drive shafts operate in a precisely timed sequence so that
changes in the tap selector contacts only occur when no current is flowing. The tap
selector contacts usually last for the life of the transformer, since they are not burdened
with arcing and the associated contact wear.
Vacuum bottle switching eliminates multiple re-strikes and sustained arcing that occurs
in other types of reactance LTCs. The vacuum interrupter-and-tap selector is generally
good for 500,000 operations. This compares with 50,000 to 150,000 operations for the
other two reactance type LTC mechanisms. However, the complicated mechanical
interlocking and precise timing required is critical to proper operation.
Regulating Winding
Vacuum
Interrupter
Diverter
Switches
Because of the absence of inductance in the circuit, the arc is extinguished on the first
current/voltage zero. The high speed of the mechanism also contributes to the absence
of both re-strike and extended arcing. Arcing is limited to five or six milliseconds, which
is the average time to reach a current zero after contact separation. However, because
the bridged position is not used for continuous operation, the high-speed resistor
39
transition LTC needs 17 fixed contacts and 16 regulator winding conductors to provide
the electrical tap positions.
There is a second type of resistance LTC known as the resistive diverter. This type is
primarily used in Europe, where it is applied to the high-voltage transformer winding.
The main contacts of this mechanism are usually housed in the main transformer tank,
while the arcing contacts are housed in their own compartment.
Regulating Winding
Transition
Resistors
Electrical connections
Insulation system
Control system
Mechanical system
The typical failure mechanisms under each group are discussed below.
1.7.2.7.1 Electrical Connections
In an LTC, there are electrical connections that will not be opened during the lifetime
of the unit. In addition, there are switching contacts that will be opened and closed on
a frequent basis. The contact surfaces of the switching contacts are typically covered
40
with silver or an alloy of tungsten and copper. Because of the friction during the
switching, small particles will rub off the contact and move around in the oil. If many
particles come together, they are able to build a chain, which can create a short circuit
across contacts. Furthermore, these particles change the electrical fields within the
LTC and can cause partial discharges.
As the contact material becomes depleted, the underlying copper surface of the contact
becomes exposed. The copper and silver can react with oxygen in the oil or bond with
organic components that are present in some LTCs to form copper or silver oxides.
These materials form stable films on the surface of the copper and silver contacts,
resulting in an increase in resistance and in contact temperature. The increase in
temperature increases the deposition rate of the oxides and can lead to coking failures.
Coke, a black carbon material, is a by-product of oil degradation and is generated when
hydrocarbon-based insulating oils are subjected to extreme heat and arcing. The
presence of water contributes to the formation of the film as well as metal oxides on all
surfaces. The coking process tends to compound in nature. A point source of heat
begins the process. The resulting coke forms a carbon film resistor on the contact
surface, increasing mating resistance and heat by virtue of the higher I2R power loss.
The added heat anneals the spring material that holds the mating surfaces together,
releasing contact pressures and further adding to the problem. Eventually, the coke
formation prevents the contacts from moving, and a major failure can occur when the
LTC is required to make a change [6].
But the main destructive agent for the oil is hotspots, which are caused by joints or
contacts that have developed high-resistance surfaces and interfaces. The
temperature can go well over 150 °C on the connection surface. A by-product of the
hotspot degradation is the generation of soot particles in the oil. In addition, the
generation of some of the hydrocarbon compounds (C2H6, C2H4, and CH4) is greatly
enhanced by the presence of hotspots in the LTC.
The oil will also be destroyed by the high temperature of arcs, which occur during
normal switching operations. Partial discharges can be created by moving particles in
the oil as well as rough surfaces. As mentioned in the preceding section, at high
41
temperatures, oxygen and sulfur in the oil will react with copper and silver to form metal
oxides and sulfides on joints and contacts.
Excessive amounts of moisture in the oil will decrease the electric strength of the oil
and enhance the possibility of discharge activity.
1.7.2.7.3 Control System
The switching of the LTC is controlled and monitored by a system of relays and
RTUs. A failure of any of these components will lead to a failure of the LTC to
operate.
1.7.2.7.4 Mechanism
The force to switch the LTC is generated by a motor and transmitted by gears to the
contacts. The motor and the gears will age with time or develop their own set of
functional problems. For example, binding in the gears or the shafts that hold the
switches and contacts can slow down the switching sequence or prevent the
mechanism from moving. These problems as well as material or assembling failures
can cause a failure of the LTC.
x Carry the current during the switching operation when the main contact is
moving from one position to another
x Reduce the circulation current that will start with the switching operation when
one loop in the regulation winding is short circuited
The arcs during the switching operation are normally extinguished at the first
current/voltage zero.
The high-speed resistive transition OLTC mechanism uses the motor to charge a
spring. The spring cannot release its energy until it is fully charged, at which point the
tap change is made. Motor failure, loss of power, or control problems cannot stop the
OLTC mechanism in an undesirable contact position because this critical part is
controlled exclusively by the springs.
The high speed of the mechanism also contributes to the absence of both re-strike and
extended arcing. The average arcing time is five to six milliseconds, which is the
average time to reach a current zero after contact separation. The time for a high-
speed resistor type OLTC to switch from one position to another position is
approximately 40-70 milliseconds. Loading of the springs and preparation for a new
switching operation takes between 2.5-6 seconds.
42
1.7.3.2 DIVERTER SWITCH OLTC
The diverter switch OLTC consists of a diverter switch and a tap selector. The diverter
switch, which breaks the arcs, is placed in a glass fiber (previously bakelite) cylinder.
This cylinder is tightly sealed to prevent the arcing products from entering the
transformer tank. The tap selector, which makes the connection to the tap (regulating)
winding, is placed under the diverter switch. Figure 1-22 shows the layout of a typical
diverter switch tap changer and Figure 1-23 shows a complete switching sequence
between taps.
43
Selector arm V lies on tap 6 and Selector contact H has moved in The main contact x has opened
selector arm H on tap 7. The the no-current state from tap 7 to and the arc has extinguished.
main contact x carries the load tap 5. The load current passes through
current. the resistor Ry and the resistor
contact y
The resistor contact u has The resistor contact y has The main contact v has closed,
closed. The load current is operated and the arc has resistor Ru is bypassed and the
shared between Ry and Ru. The extinguished. The load current load current passes through the
circulating current is limited by passes through Ru and contact u. main contact v. The on-load tap-
the resistor Ry plus Ru. changer is now in position 5.
Figure 1-23: Example of a switching sequence for a diverter switch type OLTC
44
Figure 1-24 : Selector switch tap-changers of UZ and UBB type
45
UZ design with fixed contacts The main contact H is carrying The transition contact M2 has
in a circle and the main contact the load current. The transition made on the fixed contact 1,
surrounded by the transition contacts M1 and M2 are open, and the main contact H has
contacts at the top. resting in the space between been broken. After that the arc
the fixed contacts. has extinguished. The
transition resistor contact, M2,
carries the load current.
The transition contact M1 has The transition resistor contact The main contact H has made
made on the fixed contact 2. The M2 has broken at the fixed on contact 2. The main contact
load current is divided between contact 1, and the arc has H is carrying the load current.
the transition contacts M1 and extinguished. The transition
M2. The circulating current is resistor and the transition
limited by the resistors. contact M1 carry the load
current.
46
The change-over selector is With a tie-in resistor the voltage With a switch that is only closed
moving and the tap winding is over the change-over selector at the time of the change-over
free floating. High voltages can can be reduced. There will, selector movement, the tie-in
appear over the change-over however, be extra losses due to losses can be avoided.
selector. the current in the tie-in resistor.
Electrical connections
Insulation system
Control system
Mechanical system
The typical failure mechanisms under each group are discussed below.
1.7.3.5.1 Electrical Connections
The contacts where the breaking takes place are typically of copper/tungsten material.
At each operation, the arcing will carbonize some oil and a small amount of the contact
material will also end up in the oil. The maintenance criteria of the OLTC are set to
avoid these products since they tend to lower the dielectric withstand voltage. If proper
maintenance is not performed or if too much moisture enters the OLTC, the dielectric
strength of the oil in the OLTC can reach a dangerous level. If a contact remains in one
position for a long time (several months or years), the normal wiping action which
cleans the contact surfaces during normal operation of the tap selector contacts does
not occur. Consequently, the temperature in the contact might increase and led to
growth of carbon particles on the surface of the contact. This will cause the
temperature of the contact to increase and progressively worsens the situation. The
final result is the formation of coke on the contacts. This can lead to the generation of
free gas, and potentially to a flashover, which may catastrophically damage the
transformer.
47
In extreme cases, the carbon growth (sometimes referred to as pyrolytic carbon
growth) between and around the contacts can bind the contacts together. This
condition can cause mechanical damage if an attempt is made to operate the tap-
changer. Depending on the design, this may be a potential problem especially for the
change-over selector in on-load tap-changers.
1.7.3.5.2 Insulation System
The insulation system of an OLTC consists mainly of oil and solid insulation materials.
Depending on the construction, the solid insulation material could be made of
fiberglass, epoxy resin or bakelite. In the diverter and selector switches, the oil will be
degraded by the arcs even during normal switching operations. The condition of the oil
and electrically stressed surfaces in the solid material will be influenced by the arcing
products. Tap selectors are normally placed in the transformer tanks and therefore
share oil with the main winding insulation. Since no arcs are typically generated during
tap selection, there is no concern for the generation of arc-decomposition products that
may degrade the oil. However, excessive amounts of moisture in the oil will decrease
its electric strength and enhance the possibility of discharge activity.
1.7.3.5.3 Motor Drive Mechanism
The switching of the OLTC is performed from the OLTC motor device. This cabinet
contains relays and switches. A failure of any of these components can lead to a
malfunction of the control system for the OLTC. A fault in the motor drive mechanism
will not lead to a tap-changer failure.
1.7.3.5.4 Mechanism
A motor is used to drive the shaft system and gears that will load the spring battery and
also operate the tap selector. It is essential that the shaft system is correctly
coordinated with the tap-changer, else severe failures can result. If the gear box is
jammed, it can result in the motor protection stopping the motor from operating. If the
wear in the gear box is abnormal, it can prevent the tap-changer from operating.
48
1.8 STREAMING ELECTRIFICATION
Inside a power transformer, the insulation between high-voltage parts (high and low-
voltage coils) and grounded parts (tank walls and iron core) is provided mainly by paper,
pressboard, and low conductivity oil. In transformers with forced-oil cooling (OFAF), the
oil is circulated by pumps in a closed circuit and acts additionally as a coolant for the
power apparatus. Several factors have been shown to influence the likelihood of
streaming electrification in transformers. These include the electrostatic charging
tendency of the oil, the oil flow velocity, the conductivity of the oil, the insulation
temperature, and the moisture content of the insulation.
At any liquid-solid interface, and also at the contact surface between pressboard
insulation and transformer oil, an uneven charge distribution can be observed. The
uneven charge distribution is caused by the difference in adsorption rate of the solid
surface for positive and negative ions in the liquid. In a transformer, the solid surface
adsorbs typically more negative ions, forming a charge layer trapped within the
pressboard. The corresponding positive charges form a mobile, diffuse layer extending
into the liquid. The positive ions in the liquid are subjected to two counteracting forces:
the electrostatic force keeping the ions close to their negative counterparts in the solid
and the agitation of the fluid diffusing the ions to regions of lower ion concentration.
Apart from the diffusion process, there is also the macroscopic flow of the liquid
entraining the ions [7].
When the low-conductivity oil shears over the pressboard surface, it entrains the
diffused positive part of the electric double layer, while the solid retains the
corresponding negative charges on its surface. This process is called streaming
electrification, where the entrained ions form a streaming current. The entrained
charges may recombine with other countercharges in the liquid, be deposited on a
remote solid surface, flow along with the liquid, or undergo a combination of all these
processes. The accumulation of uni-polar charges on an insulated part of the structure,
a process referred to as static electrification, generates a potentially dangerous voltage
buildup. When the corresponding electric field surpasses a certain threshold, electrical
discharges may occur, damaging the system.
The damage can range from deterioration of the transformer oil to flashover between
high- and low-voltage coils or between an AC coil and ground, the latter most likely
leading to costly repair or replacement [8]. Figure 1-27 shows a graphical depiction of
the process of streaming electrification as described above.
49
Figure 1-27: Streaming Electrification Model in Power Transformers [9]
One of the key determinants of the risk of streaming electrification failure is the
electrostatic charging tendency (ECT) of the oil. This is defined as the amount of charge
generated per unit volume of oil as it flows though a specific filter and is measured in
microcoulombs (PC/m3). In a transformer, it provides an indication of the capability of oil
to generate charges as it flows past the surface of the cellulose in the cooling duct. It
has been found that the use of oils with high ECT in a transformer result in a higher
level of charge density in the transformer. This increases the risk of streaming
electrification failure.
The ECT is measured by forcing a specified volume of oil through a specified filter. As
the oil flows through the filter, charge separation occurs. The charge collected on the
filter is measured by an electrometer and is used to calculate the ECT. The changing
tendency of new oils is typically in the range of 0-150 PC/m3. The charging tendencies
of oils in “normal” field units have been measured in the range of 5-200 ҏPC/m3.
50
Table 1-2 provides recommended limits of ECT for oils used in transformers in service.
The values provided in the table are to be used only as guidelines in determining the
risk of failure from streaming electrification. While most of the recorded streaming
electrification failures were in transformers with ECT values greater than 500, there
have been a few reported cases of failures in which the ECT was below 200. This points
to the varied number of conditions and mechanisms that can lead to a streaming
electrification failure. For example, if low-charging tendency oil is in a transformer that
has high flow velocities, and the transformer insulation is cold (as in a startup), sufficient
charge separation and accumulation can occur and increase the potential for streaming
electrification failure. On the other hand, in a transformer with normal flow velocities,
high-charging tendency oil at warm insulation temperatures would have reduced
potential for charge separation and accumulation. The risk of streaming electrification
failure would therefore be lower than the previous example.
Perhaps the most important factor that determines the level of charge separation in a
transformer is the flow velocity in the insulation ducts. The flow velocities in a large
power transformer vary depending on the design of the insulation ducts, the number of
pumps, and the volume flow rate of the cooling pumps. It is desirable to maintain as low
a flow rate as possible without affecting the cooling efficiency of the transformer. For
large power transformers that are a part of the installed base of inherited ABB
transformers, ABB design engineers have the capability to determine the flow velocities
in the cooling ducts to maintain the required cooling efficiencies. If a given transformer
is found to be susceptible to streaming electrification failure, ABB can make
recommendations for achieving the proper cooling efficiencies while minimizing the risk
of streaming electrification.
51
the temperature increases, the relaxation processes are faster and eventually
overtake the generation processes. Beyond this point, the transformer can be
assumed to be out of danger with regard to charge buildup and eventual failure
of the insulation system.
x The streaming electrification process is highly dependent on the charging
tendency of the insulating oil. High-charging tendency oils are likely to increase
the electrification characteristics by several times. The more high-charging an oil,
the more charges are generated under flow conditions. So, at low temperatures
there is more likelihood of extreme charge buildup, which can lead to damaging
discharges in the transformer. However, once the relaxation processes are
accelerated by temperature, these dangers subside as more charges relax than
are generated.
x It was observed that the primary source of charge generation was inside the
winding ducts. The lower plenum, which has washers extending into the oil space
and also the entrance regions to the ducts, were presumed to generate some
charges are well. This was evidenced by high levels of charge density and
streaming currents that were measured in the upper plenum oil space than what
was measured in the lower plenum oil space.
x It was also observed that the more open and leakage ducts there were in the
high-low voltage insulation of the transformer, the more charges were separated
in the ducts. This indicates that it may be possible to alter the design of the ducts
of a transformer so that there are fewer ducts open without sacrificing cooling
capability.
x The height of the lower plenum oil space was found to play a very important role
in the level of charge generation that occurs in the ducts and more importantly at
the tips of the washers and the entrance regions to the ducts. It appears the local
eddy effects generated in the lower plenum become diffused as the height of the
oil space is increased. There is therefore less charge sheared from the insulation
structures extending into the oil space. This may be a possible change to a
problem transformer that may help alleviate the dangers of streaming
electrification.
x It appears impurities that cause the charging tendency of the oil to increase can
be absorbed or loosely bonded to the cellulose fibers. Retrofitting with low-
charging oil after draining the high-charging oil may not be sufficient to reduce
electrification in the transformer. Perhaps, before oil retrofitting can be effective,
the cellulose insulation must be “washed” with oil that has a high degree of
solubility for impurities. This will hopefully dislodge most of the impurities from the
cellulose. Retrofitting with low-charging oil may then be effective.
x Perhaps the most important observation was that the electrification process can
be controlled via modifications of the operational processes of the transformer.
Charge density measurements revealed a tremendous decrease in charge
accumulation in the upper plenum beyond 50 °C, even under full pumping
capabilities. The transformer can therefore be operated under reduced oil flow
52
rates until the temperature is above this critical temperature. At this point, full oil
flow can be added without significant increases in charge densities and also any
dangers due to streaming electrification. The same procedure will be needed for
the reverse cycle.
x ABB further recommends that utilities should ensure that all winding temperature
gauges are operational and properly calibrated; that the cooling controls operate
properly and are set in the AUTOMATIC position for operation. Also, the utility
should have in place operating procedures that prevent the running of all the
pumps when the oil temperature is below 50 °C. The charging tendency of the oil
should also be tested along with the other oil quality tests.
x Several oil manufacturers recommend a chemical approach to solving this issue.
They focus on reduction of the ECT by using additives (inhibitors). This technique
could lead to a reduction in the risk of static electrification, especially for old
transformer designs.
53
2 A PRACTICAL APPROACH TO ASSESSING THE RISK OF
FAILURE OF POWER TRANSFORMERS
2.1 BACKGROUND
With the continuing ageing of transformers, it has become important to understand the
factors that contribute to elevated levels of risk of failure. The goal is that if these factors
are understood, then a risk of failure profile can be developed for each unit in an
organization’s fleet of transformers. This information allows the organization to target
appropriate strategies for mitigation, repair, upgrading, replacement, etc. for the correct
set of transformers as identified by the risk of failure profiles.
This section presents the general approach in a transformer risk assessment that
considers several factors, including condition indicators, known design capabilities, and
operational characteristics of a transformer. From these factors, a probable likelihood of
failure is calculated for each transformer. Together with the relative importance of each
unit to the power system, a prioritized strategy can be developed for transformers in a
fleet.
54
3. Life assessment decisions and their implementation (life extension via upgrading,
relocation, replacement etc.).
The risk assessment is used in the fleet screening process and its primary purpose is to
rank the transformers with respect to the risk. This allows us to prioritize the
transformers for follow-up corrective actions such as detailed design or condition
assessment, diagnostic evaluation, inspection, repair, or replacement. Another benefit
of a risk assessment is that the results (or scores) of the evaluation can provide the
basis for an intelligent estimation of the statistical technical risk of failure of the various
units.
In its true sense a risk consists of two different aspects – a probability of an occurrence
(e.g. a failure) during a time interval and the consequence of the occurrence. The
probability of a failure is the individually adjusted hazard function or failure rate. This
function depends on various technical factors – from design, service and diagnostics.
The consequence represents the severity of a failure and is determined essentially from
various costs of undelivered energy or power, costs of repair etc. It can also be
dependent on other factors such as strategic and environmental aspects etc.
As a Risk Index defined as a normalized product of the technical risk and relative
importance, Figure 2-1.
- In a two-dimensional diagram exemplified in figures 0-2 and 0-3 with the
technical risk and the relative importance on the two axes (Preferably the true
probability of failure and the true costs should be used but according to above
these parameters are difficult to determine).
55
Technical Risk*Relative Importance
Risk Index
Transformer Units
56
Technical Risk
B
Very Urgent
C A Urgent
Priority
Normal
100
Relative Importance
The Risk Index represents the statistically expected cost due to a failure for the unit
under scrutiny. In this sense the product is related to the insurance premium to be paid
by the utility for keeping the unit in operation. In Figure 2-1 the Risk Index compares the
expected economical consequences of a failure for the different transformers belonging
to a utility. Discrimination between groups of units is clearly seen.
However, using a two-dimensional diagram is probably a better way to present the
results of a risk assessment. The two diagrams, Figure 2-2 and Figure 2-3, display the
outcome of analyses for two example fleets of transformers that have diverse risk of
failure characteristics as well as diverse relative importance. In the diagrams, each
transformer in the fleet is assigned a technical risk of failure and a relative importance
and is then displayed on the risk management plot. Those that fall in the (various
degrees of the) Red Zone are transformers with a combination of high risk of failure
and/or higher importance for the system. These are classified as Urgent (or very
Urgent), or those requiring immediate action. The next transformers are those in the
Yellow (Priority) Zone. Action would normally be taken on these transformers as soon
as the Urgent transformers have been taken care of. The transformers in the Normal
category would typically not require anything other than normal basic maintenance
unless circumstances move either the risk of failure or importance to a higher value into
the Yellow or Red Zone.
The intent of risk management is to move the identified transformers to areas of lower
risk. For example, a transformer can be moved from the Urgent zone to the normal zone
by reducing the expected technical risk of failure. (The arrows A in the figures exemplify
57
this case). The process of reducing the expected risk may begin with a detailed life
assessment study to identify ways of reducing the risk of failure. In the process, some of
the original assumptions regarding the risk of failure may also be modified to obtain a
more accurate view of the risk of failure. Actual methods for reducing the risk of failure
may include refurbishment of the transformer or accessories, moving the transformer to
an area with lower incidents of faults on the feeder lines, or it could involve system
changes like modifying reclosing practices or trimming trees in a right of way.
Another strategy of risk management involves reducing the relative importance of a
transformer. This is illustrated in the figures by case B. This strategy might involve
moving a higher-risk transformer to a less critical location. It might also include adding a
parallel spare transformer to reduce the impact of a failure.
Ideally, the actual strategies would include both types of solutions to reduce the risk of
failure and reduce the criticality of the application; exemplified by the case C.
Technical aspects include not only the traditional paper ageing aspects, but also other
aspects related to short-circuit strength, electric integrity, thermal degradation and
accessory failures. The focus on transformer functionality is fundamental. The aspects
that are addressed are linked to situations that are potentially dangerous to the
transformer operation. As can be seen in Figure 2-4, there are essentially four aspects
that are considered in determining the technical risk of failure of a given transformer:
58
x Mechanical aspects: This involves the risk of short circuit failure, which is based
on assessment of the short circuit strength of the windings and clamping
structure and the incidence and magnitude of short circuit through fault events.
x Thermal aspects: This involves the winding thermal condition and is based on
the condition of the paper insulation. Aged, brittle insulation is more likely to fail
under the mechanical stress conditions. Also, metal parts at high temperature
could pose a risk to the transformer.
x Electric aspects: This involves the risk of dielectric failure and is based on the
assessment of the dielectric withstand capability of the transformer insulation
system (oil, paper, etc.) and the electrical stress imposed by the power system
and naturally occurring events.
x Accessory failures: Failures of a transformer accessory such as a bushing,
pump, or tap changer may cause a failure or loss of service of the transformer.
Each of these factors will be explained in more detail later. As for the consequences or
importance of a failure, the various cost factors mentioned above (undelivered power,
environmental costs etc) should be evaluated. This is an exercise for the utility or the
utility and ABB working together. Most often the utility ranks its transformer fleet with
respect to the relative importance of the various units and assigns an evaluation value
between 0 and 10 or 0 and 100.
The data used for reasoning when evaluating a large number of transformers in a fleet
screening must be based on easily available information in order for the evaluation to be
economically reasonable. The data for reasoning is then pre-processed data based on
various influential factors such as DGA, dissipation factor, oil condition, time-in-
operation, size, etc.
As illustrated in Figure 2-5, there are essentially two procedures used in algorithms for
combining the data for reasoning.
59
Data for reasoning I.
Overall unstructured
method
Rules
w1
w2
Total Score
(Technical Risk)
wN
II.
Data for reasoning Rules Subgroup evaluation Method structured
along possible risks
Rules
Mechanical
Score wM
wE
Electric Total Score
Score (Technical Risk)
wT
Thermal
Score w..
Etc.
Figure 2-5: Procedures for obtaining the technical risk value for a transformer
In method I the total score is obtained through a formula applied directly to the data for
reasoning. Examples of such a formula are a weighing formula or a knockout criterion.
In the latter case the Total Score is determined only by the parameter having the worst
(maximum) influence. In method II the influential factors and data for reasoning are
combined in such a way that first an evaluation of the various subgroups are made and
then the risk scores of these subgroups are combined to a total evaluation.
The structure of method II can be extended beyond the “influential factor” procedure to
include a more detailed analysis involving design data and calculations and more
condition assessment measurements. This is a more precise risk of failure estimate
than performed with influential factors. It focuses on specific knowledge of the
transformer design and condition, in addition to the statistical and historical parameters.
60
The reasoning rules are based on known transformer relationships. This is the method
used in the Mature Transformer Maintenance Program (MTMPTM) offered by ABB.
In this evaluation a more pertinent statement of the condition and risk in connection with
various transformer stresses can be obtained, for example, regarding short-circuit
strength, dielectric strength, insulation ageing, tap changer status and loadability. The
more detailed design and condition ranking is for practical reasons applied only to a
reduced number of transformers since it requires more input data.
For an evaluation performed according to the structured method II, not only can a total
ranking be performed but also separate rankings according to the different types of
stress. The subgroup ranking can be made either when the data for reasoning is
obtained from influential factors or when it comes from more detailed
calculations/analyses.
A final step in a ranking procedure is to scrutinize the evaluation for parameters having
a large or significant single impact on the result – even if the total risk for the particular
transformer is calculated to be low. Knowledge of such parameters is used to direct the
engineering mitigation work.
STATISTICAL (RELATIVE)
FAILURE RATE MODEL TECHNICAL RISK
MODIFICATION
MODEL =
f (Technical Risk)
INDIVIDUAL
FAILURE RATE
Figure 2-6: Combination of a statistical failure rate function with a technical parameter value to
obtain an estimation of the individual failure rate of the addressed transformer
61
2.3 ASSESSMENT OF THE TECHNICAL RISK OF FAILURE BY
CATEGORY (MTMPTM PROGRAM)
The algorithms for technical risk of failure, as discussed above, are based on influential
factors related to the individual subcategories [17,18,19]. The total technical risk is then
determined either directly from these influential factors or from a combination of the
assessed risks for the subcategories. To aid in the understanding of the risks for the
fleet of transformers, the relative risks for each of these categories will be briefly
presented.
62
based on the type of accessory and the diagnostic evidence from DGA, power factor
(tan G)җ results, or other analyses.
In addition, a “Random failure risk” is included in the assessment. This risk is related to
external causes not associated with the design or condition of the transformer itself. It
takes into account other types of failure risks not accounted for in the other factors. The
parameters affecting random failure can be: the type of transformer, the location, cases
where a transformer must be removed from service to de-gas the oil, loading practice
etc. This type of risk also includes transformers at risk for streaming electrification due
to the design type, potential high oil velocity, and/or cooling operation philosophy.
Figure 2-7 shows a histogram of failure rates for over 200 power transformers. An
indication of the relative importance of each of the transformers is also calculated based
on the replacement cost for the transformer or the criticality of the transformer to system
reliability. In order to develop a priority for addressing mitigation strategies for the
transformers, a plot of the risk of failure vs. the importance is shown in Figure 2-8.
40
35
30
Number of Units
25
20
15
10
5
0
0.125
0.625
1.125
1.625
2.125
2.625
3.125
3.625
4.125
4.625
5.125
5.625
6.125
63
100
80
Relative Importance
A
60
40
20
B
0
0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0 5.0 6.0
Probability of Failure
Figure 2-8: Categorization of Risk (Technical Risk or probability of failure and relative importance)
Profiles for Power Transformers
In this chart, the transformers are grouped into three categories: Urgent (red), Priority
(yellow), and Normal (green). For each transformer in the Urgent or Priority regions
(these are considered the abnormal regions), a more detailed analysis is made to
identify which risk factors were prominent in placing it in that category. For those factors
that are flagged, the sub-factors are analyzed to determine which underlying
parameters triggered the abnormal status. All such sub-factors are summarized as the
reasons for the transformer being classified in a particular abnormal category. This
detailed analysis is then used as the basis of recommendations for mitigation actions.
The histogram in Figure 2-7 is also suitable when comparing the evaluation of a single
transformer with the evaluation of previously evaluated units. For instance, a new
transformer with the risk evaluation value 3 belongs to the upper 10 % most risky units
of all units evaluated so far.
64
2.4 RISK MITIGATION
For all of the transformers identified in the Urgent or Priority category, recommended
risk mitigation actions are suggested based on the underlying factors that support the
high-risk evaluation. In some cases, immediate action such as replacement of an
offending bushing or inspection of a tap changer can be taken to correct the situation.
For other cases, additional diagnostic testing is needed to better evaluate the risk to
determine the most appropriate maintenance and risk mitigation actions. In such cases,
the evaluation is taken further to include also condition assessment and design
assessment if possible
One important risk management area is to identify spare transformers for the Urgent
and Priority transformers in the system. The risk of failure ranking is used to identify
which transformers to begin with. In many cases, especially those where design issues
such as short circuit strength are involved, it may be more appropriate to replace a high-
risk transformer with a new unit and keep the older transformer as a spare in order to
reduce the risk and improve the system reliability.
For a great number of the transformers that have been analyzed, the greatest risks of
failure are (1) risk of accessory (bushing, tap changer, pump, etc.) failure, (2) failure due
to through-fault currents caused by close-in faults on the transmission system, and (3)
risk of dielectric failure due to various causes.
2.5 SUMMARY
In this section we have discussed the principle and methods for the risk assessment of
power transformers that takes into consideration various risk factors that together
present a comprehensive risk profile for a given transformer. Each of these risk factors
is assessed based on certain condition indicators and/or the design and/or the
application of the transformer. This results in a quantitative and repeatable assessment
of the risk of failure. The risk of failure is used in conjunction with the relative importance
of each transformer to classify the overall risk of each transformer. By understanding
the underlying reasons for the risk classification of each transformer, the appropriate
mitigation actions can be prescribed. Because of the quantitative nature of the analysis,
mitigation options can be evaluated to determine the most cost effective means of
reducing risk of failure of a given transformer. So far, this method of risk assessment
has been performed on a large number of transformers, including industrial
transformers, generator step-ups, and power transformers of various voltage classes
and MVA sizes.
65
3 DIAGNOSIS OF TRANSFORMERS
Power transformers are of prime importance for electrical power systems. The condition
of a power transformer is crucial for its successful operation and, as a consequence, for
the reliability of the power system as whole.
General diagnostic methods include the analysis of oil quality (physical, chemical and
electrical properties, as well as dissolved gases), core and core insulation analysis,
winding and insulation analysis and analysis of the condition of the accessories.
In addition, there are advanced diagnostic methods that address the thermal, electrical
and mechanical condition of a transformer. Thermal assessment techniques are well
established and are typically used to analyze the condition and remaining life of the
transformer insulation. Electrical assessment includes partial discharge (PD) analysis,
which is a powerful tool used to detect incipient faults in the transformer insulation.
Mechanical assessment includes frequency response analysis (FRA), which is applied
to detect changes in transformer winding dimensions due to deformations,
displacements, shorted turns, etc. Other methods are presented in the proceeding
sections.
66
DC converter transformers, together with such associated equipment as shunt, series,
and saturated reactors. Power transformers may be equipped with on-load and/or de-
energized tap changers.
Power transformers are used to reduce the costs of power transmission by transforming
the voltage at which current is transmitted. Shunt and series reactor components are
similar to transformers but need to absorb reactive power and limit fault currents
respectively.
Kraft paper can also be converted into flexible creped paper and used for insulating
conductors and leads. Mineral insulating oil is used as an impregnating fluid for
dielectric and cooling purposes.
Since the mid 1960s, thermally-upgraded Kraft paper has been used as turn-to-turn
insulation in transformers. In more recent years, natural esters (vegetable oils) are
being used as insulating fluids in power transformers.
A definitive analysis of the subject of diagnostic tests on power transformers must take
into account that the majority of diagnostic indicators are sensitive to all three
fundamental stresses acting on the transformer. Therefore, the general interpretations
of the outputs of the diagnostic indicators, including the localization of faults, can be
problematic for a reliable evaluation of the risk of failure. The experience and
interpretation capabilities of transformer experts are crucial for a successfully diagnosis.
67
The situation is also complicated because dielectric failure is often the final stage
consequent to the mechanical and/or thermal stresses, especially if moisture and/or oil
deterioration have already placed the transformer in a hazardous condition. This fact
underscores the importance of assessing the service stresses (overvoltages,
overcurrents, temperature, etc.) jointly with a detailed knowledge of the design
technology and materials.
The interpretation of the values and trends of the diagnostics tools must therefore be
tailored to different units in order to avoid unjustified alarms.
Few transformers fail due to old age; they usually fail as a consequence of:
Diagnostic techniques have been introduced mainly to detect the presence of small
local faults and to monitor their development over time on a period of weeks or months.
They provide evidence to plan for further investigation and remedial work to take place
on a planned basis, rather than as an emergency.
3.1.1.3 DIAGNOSTIC METHODS
Table 3-1 presents the diagnostic techniques used most widely for power transformers,
together with their field of application, present status, effectiveness, and specific
references. Diagnostic techniques may give information on detection of incipient faults
as well as about the specific source or location in a transformer structure.
68
Table 3-1: Most Important Diagnostic Techniques Used for Power Transformers
SERVICE PROVEN
STATUS OF THE
CONDITIONS EFFECTIVENESS OF
PROBLEMS DIAGNOSTIC TECHNIQUES DIAGNOSTIC REFERENCE
OF THE 3 THE DIAGNOSTIC
2 TECHNIQUE 4
EQUIPMENT TECHNIQUE
GAS-IN-OIL ANALYSIS
A H 24, 25
6. Gas chromatography ON
A M 26
7. Equivalent Hydrogen method ON
OIL-PAPER DETERIORATION
THERMAL 8. Liquid chromatography-DP ON B M/H
27
method
9. Furan Analysis ON B M/H
HOTSPOT DETECTION
10. Invasive sensors ON B L 28
11. Infrared thermography ON A H
OIL ANALYSIS
12. Moisture, electric strength, ON A M 29
resistivity, etc.
2
OFF-S = equipment out of service at site, OFF-L = equipment out of service in laboratory, ON = equipment in service
3
A = generally applied, B = development stage
4
H = high, M = medium, L = low
69
Bushings are constructed to numerous design considerations, but commonly consist of:
x Center conductor
x Mounting flange
x Insulation (solid, fluid, plastic, or in combination) between conductor and flange
In a bushing having a non-condenser body design the electric voltage will be distributed
logarithmically between the conductor and the flange. In a bushing having a condenser
body design, it may include strategically placed conducting wrappings or layers to
uniformly distribute the voltage stresses in the core. Most high-voltage bushing designs
use the condenser principle.
70
3.1.2.3 DIAGNOSTIC METHODS
Bushings are ideally suited for field-testing by dielectric diagnostics to detect and
analyze defects or deterioration resulting from the conditions previously described.
Bushings are commonly field tested when new to confirm factory test data and to
monitor for shipping damage, and then periodically tested following system disturbances
or apparatus failures and routine outages.
Table 3-2 reports the diagnostic techniques used most widely on bushings alone or
installed together with their field of application. The present status and effectiveness of
the techniques and specific references for further description of the method are also
provided.
PROVEN
SERVICE STATUS OF THE
DIAGNOSTIC EFFECTIVENESS OF
PROBLEMS CONDITIONS OF DIAGNOSTIC REFERENCE
TECHNIQUES 5 6 THE DIAGNOSTIC
THE EQUIPMENT TECHNIQUE 7
TECHNIQUE
Moisture Capacitance/Power Factor OFF-S A H 34, 35, 36, 37
Tap voltage ON A M 34, 35, 36, 37
DC resistance OFF-S A L 34, 37
Hot-collar OFF-S A H 37
Corona Partial discharge (PD) OFF-S B M/L 37
Radio-influence voltage ON B M 37
Ageing Capacitance/Power Factor OFF-S A H 34, 35, 36, 37
DC resistance OFF-S A L 34, 37
Short-circuited Capacitance/Power Factor OFF-S ON/OFF-S A H 34, 35, 36, 37
condensers Tap voltage A M 34, 37
Internal surface PD/RIV OFF-S A M/L 34, 37
leakage Capacitance Power Factor OFF-S A M 34, 37
AC dielectric loss OFF-S A H 37
Poor Infrared scanning ON A H 37
connections
The majority of arresters in service are still of the so called conventional type, i.e. made
of the series combination of active gaps and non-linear silicon carbide (SiC) resistors,
encapsulated in a porcelain housing. For this type, the withstand voltage relies mainly
on the gaps, spacers, and the external grading rings used in higher voltage applications.
5
OFF-S = equipment out of service at site, OFF-L = equipment out of service in laboratory, ON = equipment in service
6
A = generally applied, B = development stage
7
H = high, M = medium, L = low
71
A very important feature is that the voltage distribution across the several gaps in series
is controlled by "grading" non-linear resistances and also sometimes by internal
capacitors.
Nowadays, Metal Oxide Varistors (MOV) are able to perform the voltage clamping
function as well as the insulator function: several tens of non-linear zinc oxide (ZnO)
varistors are connected in series, and gaps are no longer needed in MOV arresters.
3.1.3.1 STRESSES ACTING ON SURGE ARRESTERS
In addition to the obvious electric stress, arresters are also exposed to substantial
thermal stress. Sizeable temperature increase is caused by normal duty operation or by
external potential redistribution due to pollution or salt in combination with rain or fog.
In the latter case, internal discharges may also occur, generating reactive species that
can cause internal surface deterioration in the arrester.
Mechanical stresses are normally taken entirely by the porcelain insulator, whereas the
active arrester parts are well protected.
Moisture ingress: Condensation and corrosion inside the arrester can affect the
dielectric withstand of insulating pieces and surfaces, and the spark-over characteristics
of the gaps can also be affected. Tightness is a must for good performance of arresters.
Heavy external pollution: The surface currents on heavily contaminated housings,
especially for multi-unit arresters, affect the voltage distribution and may create
important temperature rises, jeopardizing the grading system of conventional arresters
or the blocks in MOV arresters.
Discharges inside the arresters: Decomposition products resulting from gas
discharges in the arrester can impair the chemical stability and the dielectric surface
properties of the internal parts, especially of the varistors.
Varistor deteriorations: ZnO blocks in MOV arresters, as well as grading resistors in
SiC gapped type arresters, may suffer from changes of their characteristics during
service. This results in higher leakage currents and losses. For conventional arresters,
the final stage of deterioration is sparking at service voltage; for MOV arresters, the final
stage is thermal runaway.
Grading capacitor deterioration: Less frequent than grading resistor deterioration, but
essentially the same effect.
Gap deterioration by arrester duty: Spark-over characteristics will be affected.
The failure rate of arresters depends on the keraunic level (number of thunderstorm
days/year), the system voltage, and the margin used in the selection of the rated
voltage. For healthy and well-designed arresters, the failure rate should not be higher
than about 1/1,000 per year.
72
Once a particular category of arresters (make, environment, age) suffers from one of
the above-mentioned problems, the failure rate becomes much higher. Diagnostic
techniques are then necessary to make decisions on the replacement policy. Otherwise
diagnostic techniques are not likely to be more intensively used than just being included
in the maintenance programs.
Table 3-3: Most Important Diagnostic Techniques Used for Surge Arresters
PROVEN
STATUS OF EFFECTIVE-
SERVICE
THE NESS OF THE
PROBLEMS DIAGNOSTIC TECHNIQUES CONDITIONS OF REFERENCE
8 DIAGNOSTIC DIAGNOSTIC
THE EQUIPMENT 9 TECHNIQUE
TECHNIQUE 10
- Visual inspection
ON A L
External pollution - Measurement of external leakage
ON ? L
current
- Leakage current
ON A L
- Harmonic decomposition of leakage
Deterioration of ON A M 39
current
varistor blocks ON A H 38
- Peak of resistive current
ON B H 40
- 3rd harmonic of resistive current
OFF-L A H
- Reference voltage
8
OFF-S = equipment out of service at site, OFF-L = equipment out of service in laboratory, ON = equipment in service
9
A = generally applied, B = development stage
10
H = high, M = medium, L = low
73
3.2 GENERAL DIAGNOSIS TOOLS
3.2.1 OIL QUALITY ASSESSMENT
3.2.1.1 FACTORS AFFECTING THE HEALTH AND LIFE OF POWER TRANSFORMERS 11
The three main components subject to deterioration and contamination in a transformer
are the paper, which is used for conductor insulation; the pressboard, which is used for
the major insulation and winding support; and the insulating oil. Water, air or gas
bubbles, particles of different origin, oxygen, and oil ageing products are agents of
degradation. The presence of these elements in the transformer can directly reduce the
dielectric strength of the insulation system or result in acceleration of the rate of ageing
of the insulation system.
The level of possible contamination of a transformer over years depends on its design,
especially on the effectiveness of the oil preservation system, and sources of
contamination. Detection of possible sources of contamination in the particular
transformer is a critical step of its condition assessment. The CIGRE working group
12.18 has suggested some possible sources of typical contamination that are listed in
Table 3-4. The objects of primary concern should be transformers that have poor
sealing, worn-out oil pump bearings, sources of overheating, aged oil and free-breathing
transformers operating with variable load.
11
This section is extracted by permission from CIGRE WG12.18 – Brochure N° 227, 2003 ‘Life Management of
Transformers’, CIGRE, Paris
74
Processes of insulation deterioration involve slow diffusion of water, gases, and ageing
products, and therefore affect basically only a part of the insulation structure, the so
called “thin structure” (conductor insulation, pressboard sheets, etc.), which comprises
typically 40-60 % of the total mass.
Based on these observations, a review of the methods used to assess the level of
contamination in the insulation of transformers is presented below.
75
amount of force (dynes) required to pull a small wire ring upward a distance of 1 cm
through the water/oil interface. A dyne is a very small unit of force equal to 0.000002247
pound. Good clean oil will make a very distinct line on top of the water and give an IFT
number of 40 to 50 dynes per centimeter of travel of the wire ring.
As the oil ages, it is contaminated by tiny particles (oxidation products of the oil and
paper insulation). These particles extend across the water/oil interface line and weaken
the tension between the two liquids. The more particles are present, the weaker the
interfacial tension and the lower the IFT number. The IFT and acid numbers together
are an excellent indication of when the oil needs to be reclaimed. Low IFT numbers are
an indication of highly contaminated oil, which can lead to sludging. If such oil is not
reclaimed, sludge will settle on windings, insulation, etc., and cause loading and cooling
problems.
There is definitely a relationship between the acid number, the IFT, and the number of
years in service. The accompanying curve (see Figure 3-1) shows the relationship and
is found in many publications (this chart was originally published in the AIEE
transactions in 1955). Notice that the curve shows the normal service limits both for the
IFT and the acid number.
Figure 3-1 shows a plot of the relationship between acid number and interfacial tension
as a function of the number of normal years of service for a transformer.
76
Figure 3-1: Interfacial Tension, Acid Number, and Years in Service
77
diagnosis. Section 3.3.2.2 provides a detailed discussion about analysis of furans in
transformers.
3.2.1.2.7 PCB Content
Environmental legislation often requires that oil contaminated with PCB is given special
treatment. For this reason service providers may sometimes refuse to handle oil that
has not been proven to be PCB-free. There may also be strict rules for the disposal of
PCB-containing oil.
3.2.1.2.8 Corrosive Sulphur
In recent years there have been a significant number of failures, in different types of
equipment, due to the formation of copper sulphide in the cellulosic insulation. Also,
other problems due to the action of corrosive sulphur compounds in oil have been
reported. It has become apparent that commonly accepted tests for corrosive sulphur
used in oil specifications (ASTM D1275 (copper strip) or DIN 51353 (silver strip)) are not
adequate. Several oils that have passed these tests have caused copper sulphide
formation in real life and in some cases have resulted in failure of the transformer.
New tests have been developed that have higher sensitivity and are more relevant for
the failure mechanisms involved. A new more severe copper strip test has been
introduced (ASTM D1275 method B), and a covered conductor deposition test (“CCD”)
has been developed to identify oils that may cause copper sulphide precipitation in
cellulosic insulation. A simplified version of the latter test is presently under
consideration as a new IEC standard test for corrosive sulphur.
78
3.2.1.3.1 Transformer Oil
Mineral transformer insulating oils are refined from predominantly crude oils. The
refining processes could include solvent extraction, dewaxing, hydrogen treatment, or
combinations of these methods to yield mineral insulating oil that meets the
specification. It is mainly a mixture of hydrocarbon compounds of three classes:
alkanes, naphthenes, and aromatic hydrocarbons. These molecules have little or no
polarity. Polar and ionic species are a minor part of the constituents, but their presence
may greatly influence the chemical and electrical properties of the oil. Polar compounds
found in transformer oil usually contain oxygen, nitrogen, or sulfur. Ionic compounds are
typically organic salts found only in trace quantities.
Insulating oils, such as transformer oil, have a low affinity for water. However, the
solubility increases markedly with temperature for normally refined naphthenic
transformer oil. Water can exist in transformer oil in three states. In practical cases,
most water in oil is found in the dissolved state. Certain discrepancies in examining the
moisture content using different measurement techniques suggest that water also exists
in the oil, tightly bound to oil molecules (bound moisture), and especially in deteriorated
oil. When the moisture in oil exceeds the saturation value, there will be free water
precipitated from the oil in suspension or drops. Moisture in oil is measured in parts per
million (ppm) using the weight of moisture divided by the weight of oil (g/g).
3.2.1.3.2 Relative Humidity
Relative humidity can be defined in terms of the moisture –mixing ratio r versus the
saturation mixing ratio rs, %RH u rrs which is a dimensionless percentage. Relative
humidity for air is the water vapor content of the air relative to its content at saturation.
Relative humidity for oil is the dissolved water content of the oil relative to the maximum
capacity of moisture that the oil can hold (the saturation limit). The higher the %RH, the
closer the oil is to saturation. In a transformer, it is preferable to keep the %RH below
10-20 %, depending on voltage class (see Figure 3-2 for moisture content curves at
different %RH).
79
Figure 3-2: Relative Humidity Curves for Transformer Oil 12
Water in paper may be found in four states: adsorbed to surfaces, as vapor between the
cellulose fibers, as free water in capillaries, and as absorbed free water in the body of
the insulation. The paper can contain much more moisture than the oil. For example, a
150 MVA, 400 kV transformer with about seven tons of paper can contain as much as
223 kg of water. If it is assumed that such a transformer contains 80,000 liters of oil and
assuming a 20 ppm moisture concentration in oil, the total mass of moisture in the oil is
about 2 kg. This amount is much less than the moisture in the paper. The unit for
moisture concentration in paper is typically expressed in percent, which is the weight of
the moisture divided by the weight of the dry oil-free pressboard.
12
From IEEE Std 62-1995
80
3.2.1.3.4 Where Does the Water Come From
Moisture can be in the insulation when it is delivered from the factory. If the transformer
is opened for inspection, the insulation can absorb moisture from the atmosphere. If
there is a leak, moisture can enter in the form of water or humidity in air. Moisture is
also formed by the degradation of insulation as the transformer ages. Most water
penetration is the flow of wet air or rainwater through poor gasket seals due to pressure
differences caused by transformer cooling. During rain or snow, if a transformer is
removed from service, some transformer designs cool rapidly and the pressure inside
drops. The most common moisture ingress points are gaskets between bushing
bottoms and the transformer top and the pressure relief device gasket. Small oil leaks,
especially in the oil cooling piping, will also allow moisture ingress. With rapid cooling
and the resultant pressure drop, relatively large amounts of water and water vapor can
be pumped into the transformer in a short time. It is important to repair small oil leaks.
The small amount of visible oil is not important in itself, but it indicates a point where
moisture will enter the transformer.
It is critical for life extension to keep transformers as dry and as free of oxygen as
possible. Moisture and oxygen cause the paper insulation to decay much faster than
normal and form acids, sludge, and more moisture. Sludge settles on windings and
inside the structure, causing transformer cooling to be less efficient; therefore, the
temperature rises slowly over time. Acids cause an increase in the rate of decay, which
forms more acid, sludge, and moisture at a faster rate [46]. This is a vicious cycle with
increasing speed, forming more acid and causing more decay.
3.2.1.3.5 Moisture Equilibrium between Oil and Paper in Transformers
Since there is more water in the cellulose than in the oil and a significant part of the
protection of the transformer relies on the integrity of the cellulose insulation, it is
important to know the moisture in the cellulose. Unfortunately, this cannot be measured
directly without obtaining a sample of pressboard or paper from inside the transformer.
Methods have been developed to estimate the moisture of the cellulose insulation from
the moisture in the oil, based on the partitioning of water between the oil and the
cellulose under certain conditions. When the transformer is in equilibrium operation, this
provides a quick way of examining the moisture content in paper to predict future failure
by measuring the moisture in oil. A set of moisture equilibrium curves is shown in Figure
3-3. The original curves have been modified to include the insulation moisture limits for
different voltage classes of transformers. Given the average oil temperature of the
transformer and the measured moisture content of the oil, the moisture content of the
cellulose can be estimated from the chart in Figure 3-3. It can also be determined if the
moisture content is excessive and action is required.
Unfortunately, during regular operation of a transformer, the moisture in the oil and the
cellulose are never in equilibrium. Moisture constantly migrates from the cellulose into
the oil as the transformer load increases and the windings “heat” up. The reverse occurs
when the load is reduced and the transformer windings “cool” down. Equilibrium is
especially difficult to establish at low transformer temperatures. The situation improves
somewhat as the transformer oil temperature gets above 50 °C. It is important for users
of these curves to understand they may not be getting a true measure of the moisture in
81
the insulation. Advanced methods, such as the Dielectric Frequency Response (DFR)
analysis allow the direct measurement of moisture in the cellulose insulation. This
method is described in 3.3.2.3 of this handbook.
5.0
0oC 10oC 20oC 30oC 40oC
4.5
4.0
50oC
3.5
% Moisture in Paper
IEEE C57.106-2002
3.0 Insulation Moisture
o
60 C
Limits
2.5
69kV
70oC
>69kV - <230kV
2.0 230kV
80oC
1.5
1.0 90oC
100o
0.5
0.0
0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50
Moisture in Oil (PPM)
Figure 3-3: Oommen Curves for Low Moisture Region of Moisture Equilibrium for Paper-Oil
Systems [47]. (Note: Moisture limits from C57.106-2002 and shown in Table 3-6 have been inserted
into the equilibrium plots.)
The data from the moisture equilibrium curves and the recommended limits for moisture
in the solid insulation can be combined into a chart that gives the maximum allowed
equilibrium moisture in the oil at any given temperature and each voltage range. This
chart is shown in Figure 3-4. The chart indicates, for example, that at 60 °C the moisture
content in a 145 kV transformer at equilibrium should be no more than 30 ppm, whereas
for a 69 kV transformer the limit is approximately 65 ppm. Based on the measured
moisture in oil, the temperature, and the voltage class of a transformer, this chart can be
used to provide some indication of the moisture condition of a transformer.
82
Maximum Recommended Moisture in Oil Based on
Recommended Maximum Moisture in Cellulose
100
69kV
90 >69 - <230kV
Moisture Limit in Oil (ppm)
80 230kV
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100
o
Temp ( C)
83
5.0
0oC 10oC 20oC 30oC 40oC
4.5
4.0
50oC
3.5
% Moisture in Paper
3.0
60oC
2.5
70oC
2.0
80oC
1.5
90oC
1.0 100o
0.5
0.0
0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50
Moisture in Oil (PPM)
Table 3-5: General Guidelines for Interpreting Data Expressed in Percent Saturation
84
Table 3-6: Recommended Maximum Limit of Water Content in Mineral Insulating Oil of Operating
Gas Blanketed, Sealed, or Diaphragm Conservator Transformers a
b
Average Oil Suggested Maximum Water Contents in mg/kg and Percent Saturation
Temperature 50°C 60°C 70°C
c c c
mg/kg % saturation mg/kg % saturation mg/kg % saturation
69 kV 27 15 35 15 55 15
>69 - <230 kV 12 8 20 8 30 8
230 kV and 10 5 12 5 15 5
greater
NOTES
1 - These values are, by necessity, approximate but are adequate for maximum water-in-oil guides.
2 - The oil sample should, if practical, be taken when the load and oil temperatures have been relatively
constant for 48 h. The intent is to obtain a sample when the moisture content in the transformer is close to
equilibrium. If the load and/or ambient are variable, the oil temperature can be maintained relatively constant
by controlling the amount of cooling in operation. If you are confident that the temperature gauges are in
calibration, then record the top oil temperature at the time that the sample is taken. For Oil Natural Air
Natural (ONAN) and Oil Natural Air Forced (ONAF) ratings, subtract 10 °C from the top oil to obtain the
average oil temperature. If you are unsure of the gauge accuracy, record the actual sample temperature and
add 5 °C to approximate the average oil temperature.
3 - The above values are based on the following approximate percent by weight of water in solid insulation
values (see IEEE Std 62-1995):
69 kv 3% maximum
>69 - <230 kv 2% maximum
230 kv and greater 1.25% maximum
4 - Saturation values (mg/kg) at 100% saturation:
50 °C - 175 / 60 °C - 245 / 70 °C - 335
a) The data in this table is from sealed transformers and may also apply to free-breathing type transformers.
b) Calculated from formulas 1 and 2 in Clause 44 from Bruce, C. M., Christie, J. D., and Griffin. Paul [49]
c) Equivalent measurement is parts per million, ppm.
Table 3-7 and Table 3-8 are the recommended limits for oil quality tests performed on
new and service aged transformers (always refer to the latest IEEE standards for the
current suggested limits). Note that these are the suggested limits for acceptable
conditions. If any measurements are beyond the suggested limits, it is advisable to take
another sample to confirm the first result. If the results are confirmed, it is recommended
you contact ABB for advice on further action. Table 3-9 provides some guidelines on
actions to be taken based on the results of oil quality measurements.
Table 3-7: Test Limits for New Mineral Insulating Oil Received in or Processed for New Equipment
85
Test and Method Value for Voltage Class
69 kV >69 - <230 kV 230 kV - <345 345 kV and above
kV
c c c c
Neutralization number (acidity), 0.015 0.015 0.015 0.015
ASTM D974-02,
mg KOH/g maximum:
Water Content, 20 10 10 10
ASTM D1533-00, mg/kg
d
maximum :
Oxidation inhibitor content when
specified,
ASTM D2668-96,
Type I oil, % maximum: - 0.08
Type I oil, % minimum: - 0.0
Type II oil, % maximum: 0.3 0.3
Type II oil, % minimum: >0.08 >0.08
Total dissolved gas, 0.5% or per 0.5% or per manufacturer’s
e
ASTM D2945-90 (1998): manufacturer’s requirements
e
requirements
a) Oil dielectric testing in accordance with ASTM D877-00 has been replaced by ASTM D1816-97.
b) Alternate measurements of 0.04 in and 0.08 in respectively for gaps.
c) This value is more stringent than the ASTM D3487 requirement.
d) Equivalent measurement is parts per million, ppm.
e) This value should be obtained from a sample collected 24 to 48 hrs after the transformer is filled and applies only to
transformers with diaphragm conservator systems.
Table 3-8: Suggested Limits for Continued Use of Service-Aged Insulating Oil
86
Table 3-9: Maintenance Guidelines for In-Service Oils [50]
Not only does moisture in the cellulose decrease the breakdown strength of the
insulation system and increase the ageing process, there is also potential danger due to
enhanced chances of partial discharge activity and eventual breakdown of the
insulation.
Bubbles in a transformer may arise from several causes: 1) excessive gas generation
from faults, 2) nitrogen supersaturation in the case of gas-blanketed units, and 3)
gas/vapor release from overload conditions, particularly for paper insulated systems
such as large and medium power transformers. In experiments on gas evolution
performed at ABB [53, 54, 55], the following key observations were made:
87
The studies revealed that bubble evolution in paper-wrapped windings under overload
conditions is significantly influenced by the moisture in paper which tends to be released
as bubbles. At low moisture levels in paper, systems with low gas content and gas
saturated systems behave somewhat similarly. It appears the dissolved gas is not the
determining factor for bubble generation. Indeed, the data showed that bubble
evolution from overload conditions may not happen below 200oC in very dry
transformers, regardless of the gas content. A service aged transformer with two
percent moisture may release at 140oC when overloaded. An empirical mathematical
relationship to predict bubble evolution temperature [56] is shown graphically in Figure
3-6.
200
180
Gas
C
Content
o
0%
Bubble Evolution Temperature,
1%
160 2%
Zero gas content 3%
systems 4%
5%
6%
7%
8%
140 9%
Observed for N2
saturated systems
120
100
0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0
% Moisture in Coil
Figure 3-6: Bubble Evolution Temperature vs. Moisture Content in Paper and Gas Content in Oil
If the loading guidelines suggested by IEEE Std C57.91 for transformers under various
load conditions are superimposed on Figure 3-6, some rather critical decisions can be
88
made for what transformers can be operated under what load conditions. The resulting
chart is shown in Figure 3-7.
200
190
180
C Zero gas
Normal Life Expectancy Loading
170 content
o
Bubble Evolution Temperature,
140
130
120
110
100
0.0 1.0 2.0 3.0 4.0
% Moisture in Coil
The loading guidelines shown in Table 3-10 can be derived from Figure 3-7 and IEEE
C57.91. The table should be read as follows: a transformer with approximate gas
content of 9 % and moisture content of up to 2.0 % can be operated under long-time
emergency conditions so long as the hottest spot temperature never exceeds 140 °C.
However, it should never be operated under short-term emergency conditions. Another
important observation is that transformers with insulation moisture content greater than
0.8 % may be exposed to significant risk of failure if operated under short-term
emergency loading conditions.
89
Table 3-10: Loading Limits Based on Moisture Content
A word of caution should be given here regarding the preceding discussion. It is our
experience that an accurate determination of the transformer hotspot temperature,
especially on older transformers, can only be made after an updated engineering
calculation using modern design programs. Relying on readings from hotspot gauges or
on test reports may result in significant underestimation (or in some cases
overestimation) of the true hotspot temperatures. Also it is important to get a proper
measure of the moisture content of the paper insulation before subjecting a transformer
to overload conditions. At present, the Dielectric Frequency Response method (see
section 3.3.2.5) is the most accurate means of estimating the moisture content of the
paper insulation in transformers.
For most transformers, especially those that are continuously loaded, a more significant
effect of moisture in the insulation is the increased ageing associated with the moisture
in the cellulose insulation. Ageing calculations given in IEEE Std C57.91 assume dry,
oxygen-free insulation. Dry insulation is assumed to be approximately 0.5% moisture or
less. Field measurements done by ABB have demonstrated that most transformers in
the utility network have moisture levels higher than this. Since the ageing rate of
insulation is dependent on the temperature, the moisture level in the insulation, and the
oxygen level in the oil, the actual ageing rates are often much higher than might be
assumed for normal dry transformers.
90
3.2.2 DISSOLVED GAS IN OIL ANALYSIS (DGA) [57]
3.2.2.1 INTRODUCTION
For many years the method of analyzing gasses dissolved in the oil (DGA) has been
used as a tool in transformer diagnostics. The method has been used for several
purposes: to detect incipient faults; to supervise suspect transformers; to test a
hypothesis or explanation for the probable cause of failures or disturbances which have
already occurred; and to ensure that new transformers are healthy. DGA could also be
used as part of a scoring system in a strategic ranking of a transformer population.
What is said about DGA for transformers is also applicable to reactors, instrument
transformers and bushings. It is worth noting that DGA is a fairly mature technique and
is employed by several ABB transformer companies around the world either in own
plant or in co-operation with affiliated or independent laboratories. In assessing
dissolved gases in oil, the rate of increase of different gases during a time interval is
the most important indicator of the health of the unit. The actual gas levels may of may
not be of consequence for the operation or the health of the transformer.
The idea behind the use of dissolved gas analysis is based on the fact that during its
lifetime, all oil/cellulose insulated systems generate decomposition gases under the
influence of various stresses - both normal and abnormal. The gases that are of interest
for the DGA analysis are shown in Table 3-11.
All these gases except oxygen and nitrogen may be formed during the degradation of
the insulation. The amount and the relative distribution of these gasses depend on the
type and severity of the degradation and stress.
91
Over the years several different schemes have been proposed as evaluation schemes
for DGA. Several of these techniques are presented in the IEEE Standard C57.104 and
IEC Publication 60599.
A number of faults can not be detected by DGA. One example is faults that are not in
contact with the oil. Other examples are faults in which only very small energies are
released or in which the energy is spread over a large surface or large volume. Such
faults are typically associated with sporadic discharges or weak discharges.
3.2.2.2 PROCEDURE
The procedure for performing DGA consists of essentially four steps:
- Sampling of oil from the transformer
- Extraction of the gases from the oil
- Analysis of the extracted gas mixture through gas chromatography.
- Interpretation of the analysis according to an evaluation scheme.
3.2.2.3 SAMPLING
Suitable locations for sampling are valves in the cooler/radiator circuit. Because of
design limitations it may not always possible to take samples from these locations.
Other places from which to draw samples are the cover, bottom valve, the conservator
and from the Buchholz relay. In addition, care must be taken to make sure the sample is
not exposed to the atmosphere and that gases are not lost during sampling or
transportation to the laboratory. For more general information about sampling of gases
refer to the latest version of IEC Standard 60567 or ASTM Standard 3613. Figure 3-8
shows the sampling methodology used by ABB.
3.2.2.4 EXTRACTION
The removal of the gases from the oil can be accomplished by various methods:
- Partial degassing (single-cycle vacuum extraction)
- Total degassing (multi-cycle vacuum extraction)
- Stripping by flushing the oil with another gas.
- The head-space technique in which gases are “equalized” between a free gas
volume and the oil volume.
3.2.2.5 ANALYSIS
After extraction the gas mixture is fed into adsorption columns in a gas chromatograph
(GC) where the different gases are adsorbed to various degrees and reach the detector
after different periods of time. In this way the gas mixture is separated into individual
chemical compounds and their concentrations are calculated in volume gas at standard
temperature and pressure (STP) per oil volume and expressed in parts per million
(ppm).
It should be emphasized that this extraction and analysis may involve analytical errors.
It may therefore be difficult to directly compare results from two different laboratories.
One should not jump from one lab to another but instead try to stick with one well-
reputed lab.
92
SAMPLING OF OIL FOR GAS ANALYSIS
Important things to consider :
The syringe piston must be clean at use.
Used hoses shall not be returned to ABB Transformers.
Please remember to note the number of the syringe in the questionaire.
Connect the hose and T-piece to the syringe according to the Connect the hose from the sampling valve to the T-piece.
picture.
Put the hose with the T-piece in a bucket and open the valve Turn the handle on the syringe valve as in the picture and
on the transformer. Flush min. 3 times the valve and hose suck carefully in about 15 ml. of oil into the syringe.
volume. Let the oil flow during the sampling.
Hold the syringe so that the valve points upwards and press Suck carefully 20 ml of oil into the syringe. No air bubbles
the air and oil out. No airbubbles should be left. shall be seen in the syringe.
Close the valve on the syringe by turning the handle on the
Setfo/ta 980903 KR syringe valve as in the picture.
Gasanalys provtagning engelsk
Figure 3-8: ABB Method for Sampling Oil for Gas Analysis
93
3.2.2.6 INTERPRETATION
In order to properly interpret the results of the gas analysis, it is necessary to determine
the gas production rate for the period under consideration, i.e. how much the gas levels
have changed over a given time period. The absolute gas levels seldom give a sufficient
good basis for the interpretation.
3.2.2.7 AIR
Oxygen (O2) and nitrogen (N2) come from the air. Air contains about 20% oxygen and
about 80% nitrogen. The levels in the oil could be respectively 30,000 and 80,000 ppm
at air saturation. Oxygen and nitrogen have different solubility in oil. It is unusual to
measure oxygen levels below 1,000 ppm and nitrogen levels below 2,000 ppm. The air
content may be used to check the sampling procedure. The air content must not jump
up and down between subsequent samples. If that is the case, one can suspect that the
samples have not been taken with sufficient accuracy. The oxygen level could decrease
at high temperatures of the oil. Oxygen is also consumed during periods of strong
ageing of oil and cellulose.
A small amount (up to 200 ppm) of carbon dioxide, CO2 may also come from air, but
only if the oil is saturated with air (around 10%).
94
x Inadvertent grounds that create circulating currents.
x Increased resistance of the selector contacts for the tap changer.
x Circulating currents in the core. A low resistance between different core steel
packages or to metallic parts or to high burrs on the sheets.
x Induced currents due to non compensated currents in the core window.
x Currents in metal pieces which should have been insulated or which have
damaged insulation. Consider which joints there are in the unit, core bolts, etc.
x Closed loops for currents because of damaged insulation between parallel
conductors.
x The insulation of the steel band around the core becomes damaged.
3.2.2.9 OVERHEATED CELLULOSE
Carbon oxide (CO) and carbon dioxide (CO2) come mainly from hot cellulose. They are
produced at moderate temperatures (< 150 ºC) with the ratio CO/CO2 = 0.3.
3.2.2.9.1 Examples of Overheated Cellulose
x Overheated conductor insulation
x Insulated multiple grounds which conduct a high current
x Parallel conductors with common covering which come into electrical contact with
each other
x Conductors for the cleats and leads
x Winding conductors, obstructed cooling, loosened/wrongly positioned oil guiding
ring
x Overcurrents because of leakage fields
x Circulating currents in the yoke bolts
x Any of the conditions in the “Hot metal surface” list that involve surfaces that are
covered with cellulose.
95
3.2.2.11 FACTORS AFFECTING GAS CONCENTRATION IN TRANSFORMERS
Bladder
Air
Oil
Gas Space
Buchholz Buchholz
Oil Relay Relay
Oil Oil
II III
I
Conservator type Conservator type
Non-conservator type
with bleeder bag with open expansion tank
Gas-blanketed
(COPS Sealed) (COPS Open)
If there are increasing levels of nitrogen, oxygen, and carbon dioxide in a conservator
type transformer, there is a possibility the tank has a leak or the oil may have been
poorly processed. In this case, it is advisable to check the diaphragm or bladder for
leaks and to check for oily residue around the Buchholz relay and other gasketed
openings. There should be fairly low nitrogen and especially low oxygen in a
96
conservator type transformer. With time some air could leak through the bladder and
raise the oxygen and nitrogen levels.
3.2.2.11.5 Gas Mixing
Concentration of gases in close proximity to an active fault will be higher than in the
DGA oil sample. As distance increases from a fault, gas concentrations decrease. Equal
mixing of dissolved gases in the total volume of oil depends on time and oil circulation. If
there are no pumps to force oil through radiators, complete mixing of gases in the total
oil volume takes longer. With pumping and normal loading, complete mixing equilibrium
should be reached within a few days and will have little effect on DGA if an oil sample is
taken then or long after a problem begins.
3.2.2.11.6 Temperature
There is an old chemist's rule of thumb stating that a small increase in temperature (5-
15 ºC) can yield a two or threefold increase in gassing rate. The basic explanation of
this phenomenon is found in the well-known Arrhenius equation, which holds true for
most chemical reactions.
Gas production rates increase exponentially with temperature and directly with volume
of oil and paper insulation. Temperature decreases as the distance from the fault
increases. Temperature at the fault centre is highest, and oil and paper there will
produce the most gas. As distance from the fault increases the temperature decreases,
and the rate of gas generation also decreases. Because of the volume effect, a large
heated volume of oil and paper can produce the same amount of gas as a smaller
volume at a higher temperature. It is impossible to tell the difference by just analyzing
the DGA. It is important to note that the ambient temperature directly influences the
gassing rate. If there is a fault, the higher the ambient temperature, the higher would be
the gassing rate.
A gas generation chart [58] [59] is shown in Figure 3-10. Note that temperatures at
which gases form are only approximate. Moreover, the figure is not drawn to scale and
is only to be used for purposes of illustrating temperature relationships, gas types, and
quantities as fault temperature vary in a transformer. These relationships represent
what generally has been proven in controlled laboratory conditions using a mass
spectrometer.
The vertical band at left side of the chart shows what gases and approximate relative
quantities are produced under partial discharge conditions (low energy discharge
events). The total hydrogen produced by a partial discharge in oil could be as much as
75% of the total gases, the remaining part being composed of small percentages of
hydrocarbons, in decreasing order C2H2 > CH4 > C2H4 > C2H6. With paper or
pressboard added to the system, some CO is also produced. Discharges in cellulose
alone produce CO and H2 in large quantities, in approximately equal quantities.
97
ethane (C2H6), and ethylene (C2H4) production peaks at certain temperatures and
declines as temperature increases beyond the peak. At about 250 °C, production of
ethane (C2H6) starts. At about 350 °C, production of ethylene (C2H4) begins. This
suggests that low temperature thermal faults will produce virtually no ethylene, but
plenty of ethane and methane. Acetylene (C2H2) starts above 700 °C. This indicates that
a thermal fault of greater than 700 °C can produce trace amounts of acetylene. Larger
amounts of acetylene may only be produced above 900 °C and by internal arcing.
The C2H4/C2H6 ratio is a good indicator of the hotspot temperature for mild to moderate
cases of overheating. The following expression is generally used as an approximation of
the oil decomposition temperature in terms of the C2H4/C2H6 ratio [60]:
C2 H 4
T ( o C ) 100 u + 150
C2 H 6
98
the gas in the liquid medium and the prevailing temperature. The more soluble gases
would be found in a higher proportion in the oil than the less soluble ones. On the other
hand, the less soluble gases would be found in a higher proportion in the gas space.
The solubility of gases in oil varies with temperature and pressure. The solubility of all
transformer gases increase proportionally with pressure. The solubility of hydrogen,
nitrogen, carbon monoxide, and oxygen increases with temperature. The solubility of
carbon dioxide, acetylene, ethylene, and ethane decreases with increasing temperature.
The solubility of methane remains almost constant with temperature. Figure 3-11 shows
the distribution coefficient (or Ostwald coefficient) of gases at 1 atmosphere. These
coefficients are used to compute the gas space concentration corresponding to the
concentration in oil and vice versa.
10
Gas Solubility Coefficients in Oil
C2H6
C2H4
1 CO2 C2H2
CH4
O2
CO
N2
0.1 H2
0.01
0 20 40 60 80 100
o
Temperature ( C)
From the chart it is clear that the solubility of acetylene in oil is much greater than that of
hydrogen in oil. Indeed at 25 °C and 1 atmosphere, the solubility of acetylene is 122 %
and that of hydrogen is 5.6 %. It is clear that transformer oil has a much greater
capacity for dissolving acetylene than hydrogen. It should be noted that gas from the
gas space is lost as the pressure in the gas space is released.
3.2.2.11.8 Other Factors
Below is a list of factors that are known to influence the gassing rate. However, there is
presently no consensus on how the individual factors affect the gassing rate.
99
Temperature distribution in the oil and in the cellulose
x Since the gassing is strongly temperature dependent, the temperature
distribution will be important for the gassing.
- Average winding temperature
x When the temperature distribution is not exactly known, the average
winding temperature rise could be a good approximation.
x Ambient temperature
x Governs the absolute temperatures in the transformers
Oil production process
x It has been shown that how the oil is manufactured can influence the
gassing. The oil production process could be more or less harmful to the
oil.
- Transformer history
x What the transformer has gone through could be accumulated in the
insulation. The most common cases are when gasses are dissolved in the
cellulose and released at degassing or at temperature changes
- Repair
- Tests
x No load loss test
x Electrical tests
- Unaged insulation material
x New cellulose has weak links in the material, which are cut early in the
ageing process, giving higher gassing rates in the beginning
- Type of cellulose insulation: The manufacturing processes and the ingredients in
the board have an influence on the gassing rate
x Kraft, Insuldur, Thermally upgraded
x Pressboard
- Low density, High density
- Laminated wood
- Different manufacturers
- Laminated polyester or casein glued board
100
x Glue, Epoxy
x Paint
x Zinc
x Stainless steel
- Phenomenon
x Transport in and out of insulation: It has been shown that the solubility of
carbon oxide (CO) and carbon dioxide (CO2) is temperature dependent.
This means that the content of these gases will change when the
temperature changes. These gases will go out into the oil to a certain
extent when the oil gets colder.
x “Sweating”: If the level of a particular gas in the solid insulation is high, it
could take a substantial amount of time before the gas in the insulation is
in equilibrium with the gas in the oil.
CO2, O2 and N2 can also be absorbed from the air if there is an oil/air interface or if there
is a leak in the tank. For Type I preservation systems that have a nitrogen blanket,
nitrogen in the oil may be near saturation. As described above, each key gas is
identified with a certain type of fault. There are four fault patterns that can be associated
with key gases as shown in Table 3-12. The key gas is frequently the predominant gas
in the mixture of generated gases in the oil, but occasionally another gas could be in
high concentration. Such variations are possible, because over a wide range of
temperatures each gas attains a maximum generation rate at a certain temperature.
Depending on the temperature present at the fault site, one gas or the other may be in
larger proportion.
It should be noted that small amounts of H2, CH4, CO2, and CO are produced by normal
ageing. Thermal decomposition of oil-impregnated cellulose produces CO, CO2, H2,
CH4, and O2. Substantial decomposition of cellulose insulation begins at only about
100°C or less. Faults will produce internal hotspots of far higher temperatures than
these, and the resultant gases show up in the DGA.
101
Table 3-12: Key Gas and Fault Type Guide
Condition 1: Total dissolved combustible gas (TDCG) below this level indicates the
transformer is operating satisfactorily. Any individual combustible gas exceeding
specified levels in Table 3-13 should have additional investigation.
Condition 2: TDCG within this range indicates greater than normal combustible gas
level. Any individual combustible gas exceeding specified levels in Table 3-13 should
have additional investigation. A fault may be present. Take DGA samples at least often
enough to calculate the amount of gas generation per day for each gas (see Table 3-14
for recommended sampling frequency and actions).
Condition 3: TDCG within this range indicates a high level of decomposition of
cellulose insulation and/or oil. Any individual combustible gas exceeding specified levels
in Table 3-13 should have additional investigation. A fault or faults are probably present.
Take DGA samples at least often enough to calculate the amount of gas generation per
day for each gas (see Table 3-14).
Condition 4: TDCG within this range indicates excessive decomposition of cellulose
insulation and/or oil. Continued operation could result in failure of the transformer (see
Table 3-14).
102
If TDCG and individual gases are increasing significantly (more than 30 ppm/day), the
fault is active and the transformer should be de-energized when Condition 4 levels are
reached. A sudden increase in key gases and the rate of gas production is more
important in evaluating a transformer than the amount of gas. One exception is
acetylene (C2H2). The generation of any amount of this gas above a few ppm indicates
high energy arcing. Note however, that trace amounts (a few ppm) can be generated by
a very hot thermal fault (500 °C). One-time arcs caused by a nearby lightning strike or a
high-voltage surge can also generate acetylene. If C2H2 is found in the DGA, oil
samples should be taken weekly to determine if additional acetylene is being generated.
If no additional acetylene is found and the level is below the IEEE Condition 4, the
transformer may continue in service. However, if acetylene continues to increase, the
transformer has an active high-energy internal arc and should be taken out of service.
Further operation is extremely hazardous and may result in catastrophic failure.
Table 3-13 assumes that no previous DGA tests have been made on the transformer or
that no recent history exists. If a previous DGA exists, it should be reviewed to
determine if the situation is stable (gases are not increasing significantly) or unstable
(gases are increasing significantly). Deciding whether gases are increasing significantly
depends on the particular transformer.
Table 3-13: Dissolved Key Gas Concentration Limits in Parts Per Million (ppm)
CO CO2
H2 CH4 C2H2 C2H4 C2H6 *
Status (Carbon (Carbon TDCG
(Hydrogen) (Methane) (Acetylene) (Ethylene) (Ethane)
Monoxide) Dioxide)
Condition 1 100 120 35 50 65 350 2,500 720
Condition 2 101-700 121-400 36-50 51-100 66-100 351-570 2,500-4,000 721-1,920
Condition 3 701-1,800 401-1,000 51-80 101-200 101-150 571-1,400 4,001-10,000 1,921-4,630
Condition 4 >1,800 >1,000 >80 >200 >150 >1,400 >10,000 >4,630
*
CO2 is not included in adding the numbers for TDCG, because it is not a combustible gas
Compare the current DGA to earlier DGAs. If the production rate (ppm/day) of any one
of the key gases and/or TDCG (ppm) has suddenly gone up, gases are probably
increasing significantly. Refer to Table 3-14, which gives suggested actions based on
total amount of gas in ppm and rate of gas production in ppm/day.
Before going to Table 3-14, determine transformer status from Table 3-13; that is, look
at the DGA and see if the transformer is in Condition 1, 2, 3, or 4. The condition for a
particular transformer is determined by finding the highest level for any individual gas or
by using the TDCG. If the TDCG number shows the transformer in Condition 3 and an
individual gas shows the transformer in Condition 4, the transformer is in Condition 4.
Always be conservative and assume the worst until proven otherwise [62].
103
Table 3-14: Actions Based on Dissolved Combustible Gas
Conditions TDCG Level or Highest TDCG Sampling Intervals and Operating Actions for Gas Generation Rates
Individual Gas Generation
(See Table 4) Rates Sampling Interval Operating Procedures
(ppm/Day)
Condition 1 720 ppm of TDCG or <10 Annually: Continue normal operation.
highest condition based 6 months for EHV
on individual gas from transformers
Table 3-13 10-30 Quarterly
>30 Monthly Exercise caution.
Analyze individual gases to find cause.
Determine load dependence.
Condition 2 721-1,920 ppm of TDCG <10 Quarterly Exercise caution.
or highest condition Analyze individual gases to find cause.
based on individual gas 10-30 Monthly Determine load dependence.
from Table 3-13
>30 Monthly
Some information has been added to the table from IEEE C57-104-1991 as can be
inferred from the text. If the cause of the gassing can be determined and the risk can be
assessed, the sampling interval may be extended. For example, if the core is tested
104
with a M: -meter and an additional core ground is found, even though Table 3-14 may
recommend a monthly sampling interval, an operator may choose to lengthen the
sampling interval since the source of the gassing and generation rate is known.
A decision should never be made on the basis of just one DGA. It is very easy to
contaminate the sample by accidentally exposing it to air. Mishandling may allow some
gases to escape to the atmosphere and other gases, such as oxygen, nitrogen, and
carbon dioxide, to migrate from the atmosphere into the sample. If you notice a
transformer problem from the DGA, the first thing to do is take another sample for
comparison.
3.2.2.12.3 Rogers Ratio Method
In interpreting gas analysis results, relative gas concentrations are found to be more
useful than actual concentrations. For most purposes, only five gas concentrations (H2,
CH4, C2H6, C2H4, and C2H2) are sufficient. According to the scheme developed by R.R.
Rogers [63] and later simplified by the IEC, three gas ratios define a given condition. It
is important to note that in developing the ratio analysis, Rogers considered gas
measurements from mostly conservator type transformers with open expansion tanks
(Type III transformers). Like the key gas analysis discussed above, this method does
not provide guaranteed answers, but is only an additional tool to use in analyzing
transformer problems.
The three-ratio version of the Rogers Ratio Method uses the following ratios:
R1 = C2H2/C2H4
R2 = CH4/H2
R3 = C2H4/C2H6
Note that the Rogers Ratio Method is for analyzing faults and not for detecting the
presence of faults. Its use requires the establishment of a problem based on the total
amount of gas (using IEEE limits) or increased gas generation rates. A good system to
determine whether there is a problem is to use Table 3-13 (latest version) in the Key
Gas Method. If two or more of the key gases are in Condition 2 and the gas generation
is at least 10% per month of the L1 limit (Table 3-17), there is a high likelihood of a
problem. If a gas used in the denominator of any ratio is zero, or is shown in the DGA
as not detected (ND), use the detection limit of that particular gas as the denominator.
This gives a reasonable ratio to use for diagnosis. A further refinement in applying the
ratio methods is to subtract gases that were present prior to any sudden gas increases.
This takes out gases that have been generated up to the point of analysis due to normal
ageing and prior problems. This is especially true for ratios involving gases that are
generated during normal ageing, H2, and the cellulose insulation gases CO and CO2
[64].
In using these ratios, it is advisable to never make a decision based only on a ratio if
either of the two gases used in that ratio is less than 10 times the amount the gas
chromatograph can detect [64]. This rule makes sure that instrument inaccuracies have
little effect on the ratios. If either of the gases is lower than 10 times the detection limit, it
105
is most likely that the transformer does not have the particular problem that this ratio
deals with. When a fault occurs inside a transformer, there will be more than enough
gases present to make the ratios valid. Detection limits for the key gases are shown in
Table 3-15. Table 3-15 also provides possible diagnoses based on the values of the
three ratios.
Table 3-15: Rogers Ratios for Key Gases
Notes:
1. There will be a tendency for ratio C2H2 /C2H4 to rise from 0.1 to above 3 and the ratio C2H4 /C2H6 to rise from 1-3 to above 3
as the spark increases in intensity. The code at the beginning stage will then be 1 0 1.
2. These gases come mainly from the decomposition of the cellulose, which explains the zeros in this code.
3. This fault condition is normally indicated by increasing gas concentrations. CH4/H2 is normally about 1, the actual value
above or below 1, is dependent on many factors, such as the oil preservation system (conservator, N2 blanket, etc.), the oil
temperature, and oil quality.
o
4. Increasing values of C2H2 (more than trace amounts), generally indicates a hotspot higher than 700 C. This generally
indicates arcing in the transformer. If acetylene is increasing and especially if the generation rate is increasing, the
transformer should be de-energized as further operation is extremely hazardous.
General Remarks:
1. Values quoted for ratios should be regarded as typical (not absolute). There may be transformers with the same problems
whose ratio numbers fall outside the ratios shown at the top of the table.
2. Combinations of ratios not included in the above codes may occur in the field. If this occurs, the Rogers Ratio Method will
not work for analyzing these cases.
3. Transformers with on-load tap changers may indicate faults of code type 2 0 2 or 1 0 2 depending on the amount of oil
interchange between the tap changer tank and the main tank.
106
If samples from Type I transformers (N2 blanket) are compared to those from Type II
transformers (sealed conservator), it is necessary to make adjustments to gas
concentrations and consequently some gas ratios used for diagnostic purposes.
Fortunately, major adjustment is required only for the hydrogen concentration. Details of
the adjustment procedure were derived by Oommen [65]. The only gas ratio that needs
significant adjustment is the CH4/H2 ratio. The adjustment factor is 0.44 at 25 °C. This
means that a gas ratio obtained from measurement on a Type I transformer should be
multiplied by 0.44 to equate to a measurement on a Type II transformer. Since Rogers
developed his method based on sample from Type III transformers, there is some
uncertainty about strict enforcement of ratio codes to all types of transformers. With this
qualification, it may be pointed out that the ratio codes are of great value in diagnosing
transformer faults.
The severity of faults identified in transformers using the Rogers ratio patterns is shown
in Table 3-16. The level of urgency in correcting a problem will obviously depend on the
severity of the fault. While it may be sufficient to place a transformer with an overheating
conductor problem on a watch list, one with an arcing fault might require immediate
removal from service and subsequent investigation.
x PD Partial discharges
x D1 Discharges of low energy
x D2 Discharges of high energy
x T1 Thermal fault, T < 300 °C
x T2 Thermal fault, 300°C < T < 700 °C
x T3 Thermal fault, T > 700 °C
x Basic ratios: C2H2/C2H4, CH4/H2 and C2H4/C2H6
3.2.2.12.4.1 Carbon Dioxide/Carbon Monoxide (CO2/CO) Ratio
The formation of CO2 and CO from oil-impregnated paper insulation increases rapidly
with temperature. Incremental (corrected) CO2/CO ratios less than 3 are generally
considered as an indication of probable paper involvement in a fault, with some degree
107
of carbonization. Normal CO2/CO ratios are typically in the range 5 - 9. Ratios above 10
generally indicate a thermal fault with the involvement of cellulose. If CO is increasing
around 70 ppm or more per month (generation limit from IEC 60599), there is probably
a fault. In order to get reliable CO2/CO ratios in the equipment, CO2 and CO values
should be corrected first for possible CO2 absorption from atmospheric air; and CO2 and
CO background generation (see 6.1 and clause 9 of IEC 60599). The background
generation result from the ageing of cellulosic insulation, overheating of wooden blocks
and the long term oxidation of oil. For example, if air-breathing equipment is saturated
with approximately 10 % of dissolved air, there could be up to 300 µ/l (ppm) of CO2 just
from the air. In sealed equipment, air is normally excluded but may enter through leaks.
The concentration of CO2 will be in proportion to the amount of air present. When
excessive paper degradation is suspected (CO2/CO < 3), it is advisable to ask for a
furanic compounds analysis or a measurement of the degree of polymerization of paper
samples, if this is possible.
3.2.2.12.4.2 IEC C2H2/H2 Ratio
In power transformers equipped with on-load tap changers (OLTC), the tap changer
operations produce gases corresponding to discharges of low energy in the main tank
(D1). If some oil or gas communication is possible between the OLTC compartment and
the main tank, or between the respective conservators, these gases may contaminate
the oil in the main tank and lead to wrong diagnoses. The pattern of gas decomposition
in the OLTC, however, is quite specific and different from that of regular low energy
discharges in the main tank.
3.2.2.12.4.3 IEC Recommended Method of Interpretation
a) Reject or correct inconsistent DGA values. Calculate the rate of gas increase since
the last analysis, taking into account the precision of the DGA results. If all gases are
below typical values of gas concentrations and rates of gas increase, report as
"Normal DGA/healthy equipment". If at least one gas is above typical values of gas
concentrations and rates of gas increase, calculate gas ratios and identify fault.
Check for eventual erroneous diagnosis. If necessary subtract last values from
present ones before calculating ratios, particularly in the case of CO and CO2. If
DGA values are above typical values but below 10 times the analytical detection limit,
see the section in IEC 60599 on “Uncertainty of ratios”.
b) Determine if gas concentrations and rates of gas increase are above alarm values.
Verify if fault is evolving towards final stage. Determine if paper is involved.
c) Take proper action according to the best engineering judgment.
It is recommended to:
1) Increase sampling frequency (quarterly, monthly or other) when the gas
concentrations and their rates of increase exceed typical values,
2) Consider immediate action when gas concentrations and rates of gas increase
exceed alarm values.
108
3.2.2.12.5 Duval Triangle Method for Diagnosing a Transformer Problem Using Dissolved Gas Analysis
[66]
Duval developed this method in the 1960s using a database of thousands of DGAs and
transformer problem diagnoses. This method has proven to be accurate and
dependable over many years and is now gaining in popularity. The method and how it is
used is described below. Before this method is applied, it is best to follow these steps:
1. First determine whether a problem exists by using the IEEE method above,
and/or Table 3-17 below. At least one of the hydrocarbon gases or hydrogen (H2)
must be in IEEE Condition 3, and increasing at a generation rate (G2) from the
table below, before a problem is confirmed. To use Table 3-17 below without the
IEEE method, at least one of the individual gases must be at L1 level or above
and the gas generation rate at least at G2. If there is a sudden increase in H2
with only carbon monoxide (CO) and carbon dioxide (CO2) and little or none of
the hydrocarbon gases, use the (CO2/CO ratio) below to determine if the
cellulose insulation is being degraded by overheating.
2. Once a problem has been determined to exist, use the total accumulated amount
of the three Duval Triangle gases and plot the percentages of the total on the
triangle to arrive at a diagnosis. Also, calculate the amount of the three gases
used in the Duval Triangle, generated since the sudden increase in gas began.
Subtracting out the amount of gas generated prior to the sudden increase will
give the amount of gases generated since the fault began. Detailed instructions
and an example are shown below.
a) Take the amount (ppm) of methane (CH4) in the DGA and subtract the
amount of CH4 from an earlier DGA, before the sudden increase in gas. This
will give the amount of methane generated since the problem started.
b) Repeat this process for the remaining two gases, ethylene (C2H4) and
acetylene (C2H2).
c) Add the three numbers (differences) obtained by the process of step b)
above. This gives 100 % of the three key gases generated since the fault.
d) Divide each individual gas difference by the total difference of gas obtained in
step c) above. This gives the percentage increase of each gas of the total
increase.
e) Plot the percentage of each gas on the Duval Triangle, beginning on the side
indicated for that particular gas. Draw lines across the triangle for each gas
parallel to the hash marks shown on each side of the triangle (see Figure
3-12). The triangle coordinates, corresponding to DGA results in ppm, can be
calculated as follows: %C2H2 = 100x/(x+y+z); %C2H4 =100y/(x+y+z); %CH4 =
100z/(x+y+z); where x = C2H2, y = C2H4, z = CH4.
109
The diagnostic regions in the triangle are defined as:
PD = Partial Discharge
T1 = Thermal Fault less than 300 °C
T2 = Thermal Fault between 300 °C and 700 °C
T3 = Thermal Fault greater than 700 °C
D1 = Low Energy discharge (Sparking)
D2 = High Energy discharge (Arcing)
DT = Mix of Thermal and Electrical Faults
Table 3-18 provides examples of the typical faults in transformers for each of the
diagnostic categories in the Duval analysis triangle. The table is derived from the IEC
draft 60599 (Edition 2) [64].
CAUTION:
Do not use the Duval Triangle to determine whether or not a transformer has a problem.
Notice, there is no area on the triangle for a transformer that does not have a problem.
The triangle will show a fault for every transformer whether it has a fault or not. Use the
key gas or TDCG methods to determine if a problem exists before applying the Duval
Triangle. The Duval Triangle is used only to diagnose what the problem is. As with other
methods, a significant amount of gas must already be present before this method is
valid.
110
Table 3-17 : L1 Limits and Generation (G1, G2) Rate Per Month Limits
Table 3-18: Example of Faults from the Duval Analysis of Power Transformers
111
3.2.2.12.6 ABB's Advanced Dissolved Gas Analysis Software (ADGA)
It has been ABB’s experience that the design and application of a transformer can
make it have its own unique gassing pattern. ABB has developed an internal
software package that combines DGA raw data, ratios, trending, key indicators, and
ABB's resident design expertise and transformer construction knowledge to interpret
the results. By combining ABB's design and manufacturing knowledge with the
analysis capabilities of the software, the analysis is able to offer greater analytical
depth than what is standard practice in the industry. The program has the ability to
pinpoint specific sources and causes of gas generation, rather than simply identify
general categories of gas generation.
Figure 3-13 shows the results of an analysis performed with this software. In addition to
the individual gas concentrations, the program requests the rate of generation of each
gas and a series of inputs relating to the type of oil preservation system and application
of LTC, etc. The results are a prioritized list of diagnoses and colour-coded pictorials of
the severity of each gas concentration and diagnostic ratio. The likely sources of the
fault can be obtained by activating an explanation screen.
112
3.2.3 ANALYSIS OF PARTICLES IN TRANSFORMER OILS [67]
Transformer manufacturers and utilities currently use particle contamination as another
means of monitoring oil quality in transformers. This is due to the increasing awareness
of the factors that influence the dielectric strength of oil. High-level particle
contamination is recognized as an important factor. The breakdown strength of
transformer oil is a function of the concentration, size, shape, and type of the particles
and the moisture level in the oil.
113
Table 3-19: Particle Size Conversion
Counting is done in the cumulative mode, i.e., for any specified size, the number of
particles above that size would be measured. The ACFTD method suggested reporting
cumulative particle counts >1, >5, >10, >15, >25, >50, and >100 Pm sizes. These
correspond roughly to the recommended sizes of >4, >6, >10, >14, >21, >38, and >70
Pm sizes for the newer MTD method.
114
3.2.3.3 TRACE METAL CONTENT OF PARTICLES
The sources of particles with metallic content have already been mentioned. In this
section the technique used to measure trace metallic levels and the results obtained will
be described.
The exact methodology has to be worked out for each type of analysis. If particles are
extremely fine, e.g., below 10 microns, the sample would be more or less
homogeneous, and the furnace technique could be used. Only micro liters of the oil
sample are required, and no sample preparation is needed. However, the reproducibility
of the furnace technique is not high when small samples are used, and many particles
suspended in oil are greater than 10 microns. This type of analysis would give metallic
content of both suspended and dissolved material. This procedure of only analyzing
suspended particles has been found to be reproducible and correlates well with units
having known sources of contamination.
Meaningful metal analysis can be confined to four elements: iron, copper, lead, and
zinc. All these elements could be analyzed easily by the flame technique using
air/acetylene flame. The selection of iron and copper needs no explanation. Lead and
zinc are elements normally found in the pump bearing alloy material. It must be pointed
out that lead and zinc could be present in oil from other sources such as solders, zinc
plated parts, and paints; also, the wear of the alloy may not produce particles of the
same composition. Lead and zinc are relatively low melting, and may be partly lost
during wear process and sample preparation. Iron oxide is a component of dirt, dust,
and impure clay; therefore, a bad sample could show excessive iron content.
115
typically observed for each element in clean oil with total particle count not exceeding
500.
Based on a limited study of 200 samples taken by ABB from both factory and field units,
the following levels appear normal for both factory and field units:
If levels greater than these are measured, further study may be required. Most units
with reported bearing problems show higher than average upper levels. Considerable
caution should be used in the application of these limits. First, the analysis technique
between laboratories should be standardized. Secondly, the total volume of oil in the
transformer should be taken into account. The oil volume in large power transformers
could vary from 10,000 to 30,000 gallons. If particles originate from general degradation
processes, the particle concentration would be uniform regardless of the size of the
transformer. If, however, particles originate from a localized mechanical problem, the
total oil volume would influence particle concentration. This is especially true of oil
samples tested from residual oil after flushing operations. Both the particle level and
metallic level could be higher than normal. However, such concentrated samples may
still be of value for metal identification. The levels suggested above do not correct for
transformer size.
Table 3-21 shows some examples of problem diagnoses using particle analysis. They
show that excessive high particle levels may indicate wear and degradation. Also,
excessive copper content may be associated with pump bearing wear problems in some
cases. These examples and others reported in the open literature demonstrate that
particle level analysis coupled with AAS is a useful technique to monitor metallic
contamination in transformer oil.
Table 3-21: Diagnostic Examples of Particle Analysis
Case Description Total Visible METALLIC CONTENT (ppb) Comments
Particles Particles Iron Copper Lead Zinc
Pump failure from impeller 58,225 31 8.8 107.7 15.5 6.9 The excessive copper content
and thrust bearing wear. confirms the problem. Shiny metallic
Sample taken from bottom particles were visible. Pump bearing
of unit after pump failure. wear may not always produce such
high levels, but AAS and particle
counting could still be used to test
whether the problem exists.
Pump problem from radial 750 6 17.6 75 2.7 3.8 Visual inspection showed that the
bearing wear. Sample was rear radial bearing had frozen on the
taken from a unit with axle; the pump was, however, still
suspected pump problems. operating.
Pump motor winding short. 619 3 3.5 116.8 12.1 17.2 Although particle count is deceptively
This analysis was low, the metallic analysis showed
performed after a pump excessive copper content. The
winding failure in a factory shorting caused gas generation from
situation. oil decomposition in the pump
housing.
116
3.2.3.5 EFFECT OF PARTICLES ON DIELECTRIC STRENGTH OF INSULATING OIL13 [71]
The effect of particles on the dielectric strength of transformers has been characterized
to a large extent. Experimental investigations have been numerous and most of them
show a sizeable reduction of dielectric strength, especially if a large oil volume is used
and the voltage is applied over a long time period. Since investigations were mostly
carried out on bare electrodes, they are relevant only for the case of discharges initiated
in the oil. For discharges initiated at the electrode-to-oil interface, the effect of particle-
initiated discharges on the insulation is obviously considerable but has not yet been
characterized.
The measurement of the particle content in an oil sample has shown large
discrepancies when results from different laboratories are compared. Measurements on
different samples, carried out in a single laboratory, appear to be much more consistent
and successive measurements on the same sample have shown very good
repeatability. Particle counting is somewhat hampered by the very small volume of the
oil sample compared to the total oil volume of oil in the transformer. Depending on the
sampling valves and techniques used, it is possible to measure completely different
particle concentrations in the same transformer.
13
CIGRE SC A2 (ex 12) WG 17, - Particules in Oil, Nov. 1999
117
3.2.3.5.2 Classification of contamination level
118
simulating the main insulation between high-voltage and low-voltage windings in a large
transformer. The introduction of aluminum powder in the insulating oil only slightly
reduced the average breakdown voltage (7%), but the reduction on the minimum value
was more significant (32%). It is possible that the breakdown mechanism involved here
is quite different from the one in section 3.2.3.5.2.1.
Table 3-22: Typical contamination levels encountered on power transformer insulating oil
119
the test field was tangential. During the test with the 1-min step voltage application, it
was observed that the electric field near the tip of the rod had a cleansing effect on the
pressboard, progressively removing most of the deposited carbon. The breakdown
voltage of the contaminated sample was therefore not significantly lower than the clean
one.
120
3.2.4 WINDING RESISTANCE TEST
This test is a measure of the resistance of the conductors in the transformer winding.
The resistance measurement is corrected to either 75 °C or 85 °C, depending on the
average winding temperature rise of the transformer. The correction temperature is the
average winding rise plus 20 °C. If the temperature rise for the transformer is 55 °C, the
winding resistance is corrected to 75 °C, and if it is 65 °C, the resistance is corrected to
85 °C. The winding resistance will typically change if there are shorted turns, loose
connections on bushings, loose connections or high-contact resistance in tap changers
and broken winding strands. These conditions will typically lead to hotspots in the
winding or the affected areas and generate hot metal gases in the oil. The gases to look
for in a DGA in case of poor connections are ethylene, ethane, and to some extent,
methane. If the DGA suggests the possibility of any of the situations mentioned above,
a winding resistance test is in order.
Figure 3-14: Low Resistance Ohmmeter - Biddle Model 247001 (Courtesy of Megger)14
For Dry type transformers, the transformer shall be at rest in a constant ambient
temperature for at least 3 hours.
For Oil immersed transformers, the transformer should be under oil and without
excitation for at least 3 hours. In addition, it is important to ensure that the average oil
14
From website: http://www.megger.com/us/.
121
temperature (average of the top and bottom oil temperatures) is approximately the
same as the winding temperature.
In order to diagnose possible problems, the measured results are compared to the
factory values, values of other phases of the same transformer, or sister units, if
available. Before making such comparisons, the resistance has to be converted to a
common temperature base of 75 °C or 85 °C, depending on what is reported on the
transformer factory test sheet.
RM u (CF + CT )
RCT
CF + Winding Temp( o C )
where:
RCT = Corrected resistance
CF = 234.5 for copper windings; 225 for aluminum windings (IEEE C57.12.90)
CF = 235 for copper windings; 225 for aluminum windings (IEC 60076-1)
CT = 75 for 55oC rise transformers; 85 for 65oC rise transformers
RM = Measured winding resistance
Consistency in measurements and record keeping are the keys to making the proper
analysis using this test. If the unit has a tap changer, it is important to compare
resistances for the same tap position. The contact resistance of other tap positions can
be investigated by moving taps and repeating the measurements.
Np Ep
r
Ns Es
122
Where:
r = voltage ratio
E = open-circuit voltage
N = number of turns
p = primary
s = secondary
The IEEE standard (IEEE Standard 62) states that when rated voltage is applied to one
winding of the transformer, all other rated voltages at no load shall be correct within one
half of one percent of the nameplate readings. It also states that all tap voltages shall be
correct to the nearest turn if the volts per turn exceed one half of one percent of the
desired voltage. The ratio test verifies that these conditions are met.
The IEC 60076-1 standard defines the permissible deviation of the actual to declared
ratio as follows:
Principal tapping for a specified first winding pair: the lesser of ± 0.5% of the declared
voltage ratio or 0.1 times the actual short-circuit impedance. Other taps on the first
winding pair and other winding pairs must be agreed upon, and must not be lower than
the smaller of the two values stated above.
Measurements are typically made by applying a known low voltage across the high-
voltage winding (as a primary) so that the induced voltage on the secondary is lower,
thereby reducing hazards while performing the test. For a three phase delta/wye or
wye/delta transformer, a three phase equivalency test is performed, i.e. the test is
performed across corresponding single windings. The appropriate test configurations for
various connections for three phase two-winding transformers are shown in Table 3-24.
One of a variety of test sets used for performing these measurements is shown in
Figure 3-15.
15
From Megger® Website: http://www.megger.com/us/products/ProductDetails.php?ID=233&Description=ttr.
123
The TTR test value should not be greater than 0.5 % or less than 0.5 % of the
calculated values. For a three phase three-winding transformer, the following
measurements will be made in a TTR assessment.
For a three-winding transformer, the ratios can be from the primary to both the
secondary and the tertiary windings and can be used in further diagnosing which
winding may have a problem. For example, in a wye/wye/wye configuration, Table 3-25
can be used to diagnose possible problems in the 0-1 phase of the transformer.
Measure
Voltage
X0-X1 Y0-Y1 Possible Diagnosis
Apply
Voltage
H0-H1 Ratio Abnormal Ratio OK Problem in X0-X1 Winding
Ratio Abnormal Ratio Problem in H0-H1 Winding
H0-H2
Abnormal
Ratio OK Ratio Problem in Y0-Y1 Winding
H0-H3
Abnormal
Note that the TTR test can only indicate if one of the problems listed above is present in
the transformer. It cannot pinpoint the exact location of the fault. This must be
investigated via an internal inspection, which may involve un-tanking the transformer.
124
Primarily, this measurement gives information about the condition of the insulation and
ensures that the leakage current is adequately small.
3.2.6.1 MEASUREMENT
Insulation resistance of a transformer is measured by means of a resistance meter
using a DC voltage. In measuring resistance, it is recommended to always be sure that
the tank and core are grounded. Each winding of the transformer is then short circuited
at the terminals. Resistance measurements are made between each winding and all
other windings grounded. Windings are never left floating during insulation resistance
measurements. When any winding is installed with a solid ground, the ground must be
removed in order to measure the insulation resistance of that winding to the other
windings grounded. If the ground cannot be removed, the insulation resistance of that
winding cannot be measured. It is treated as part of the grounded section of the circuit.
Insulation resistance is expressed in mega ohms (MΩ).
1. Measure from the high voltage winding to the low voltage winding and
ground [H-LG]
2. Measure from the low voltage winding to the high voltage winding and
ground [L-HG]
3. Measure from the high and low voltage winding to ground [HL-G]
This test is easily performed in the field. Many manufacturers require that this test be
performed prior to energizing a transformer, to preclude start up failure caused by entry
of moisture into the transformer during shipment or storage. The test can also detect
other ground circuits that may exist in the transformer that may have been caused by
shipping damage. The test checks the complete circuit – bushings, leads and coils.
The measurement duration is 1 minute. The resistance readings R15 and R60 are taken
15 and 60 seconds after connecting the voltage. In order to compare these readings
with future measurements, it is important to record on the test report, the temperature,
measuring voltage, the meter used, as well as the measured resistances. Since
insulation resistances may vary with applied voltage, any comparisons must be made
with measurements at the same voltage.
WARNINGS
The following precautions should be taken in performing the insulation
resistance test:
x The test should be discontinued immediately if the current begins to increase
without stabilizing
x Under no conditions should the test be made while the transformer is under
vacuum
x After the test has been completed all terminals should be grounded for a period
of time sufficient to allow any trapped charges to decay to a negligible value
125
3.2.6.2 INTERPRETATION
The IEC Standard 60076-1 and the IEEE Standard C57.12.90 provide no limits for
insulation resistances. However, the ratio R60:R15, also called the absorption ratio, is
normally in the range 1.3 – 3 in a dried transformer. The condition of the insulation can
also be determined by comparing the measured resistance at 1 minute, R60, to a
minimum value for the voltage class of the winding. This comparison is performed only
after all measurements are converted to their 20 °C equivalents using the coefficients in
Table 3-26. For example, if the measured value is 20 Mȍ at 12 °C, according the table
this measurement is equivalent to 11,8 (=20 x 0,59) Mȍ at 20 °C.
CE
R60 =
kVA
Where:
• kVA is the rated capacity of the winding under test,
• C is a constant:
o 0.8 for oil-filled transformers at 20 °C, or
o 16.0 for dry, compound filled or untanked oil filled transformers
• E is the voltage rating of the winding under test
• R60 is the 1 minute reading of insulation resistance of winding to ground with
other windings grounded or between windings in Mȍ at 20°C
16
M. Horning et. al., Transformer Maintenance Guide, pp. 108-109, 2001
126
3.2.6.3 POLARIZATION INDEX
Polarization index is the relationship between the measured resistance after 10 minutes
and that measured after 1 minute. Since the conduction processes are enhanced for an
insulation system that is contaminated with moisture or impurities, the leakage current
will increase at a greater rate than for a dry, clean insulation. Consequently, under the
same test configuration, the insulation resistance of a wet or contaminated insulation
system will settle faster and at a lower value than that for a dry insulation. The result is
that the polarization index for a wet insulation will be lower than that for a dry insulation
system. Since the polarization index is a ratio, it does not require conversion to a
common temperature base before comparisons can be made. It also does not require
for there to be previous measurements before an assessment of the insulation condition
can be made. The following guidelines are used to assess the condition of insulation
based on the polarization index.
Polarization Insulation
Index Condition
<1 Unsatisfactory
>2 Good
Power factor test instruments typically have three leads: an output high-voltage lead for
energizing the test object, input measurement, and ground leads that measure current
through the insulation system. Internally, switches allow either input lead to be
connected to a current/wattmeter input or guard, depending on the testing configuration.
In the UST configuration, current flowing in the insulation between the high-voltage lead
and the measurement lead is measured by connecting the measurement lead to the
current/wattmeter input. The ground lead is connected to the guard, and therefore
currents that flow through the ground lead are not measured by the meter. In the GST
configuration, all currents flowing from the HV lead to ground are measured by the
meter. This is accomplished by internally connecting both the measurement and the
ground leads to the input of the current/wattmeter. In the GST/g configuration, the
measurement lead is connected to the guard, and the ground lead is connected to the
127
input to the current/wattmeter device. The only measured current is what is in the direct
path from the HV lead to ground.
The UST values can also be calculated from the difference between the measured GST
and the GST/g values. The reason for making all these measurements is to allow for the
evaluation of the various sections of insulation in the transformer. However, the most
important of these measurements is the UST test, since it measures across the major
insulation of the transformer. The power factor is calculated from the measured current
and watts loss recorded by the meter according to the following equation:
PF(%) = 10 x Loss(Watts)/Current(mA)
A system that is widely used by utilities in measuring power factor of insulation systems
is Doble Engineering’s M4000 Automated Insulation Analyzer shown in
Figure 3-16.
Figure 3-17: Schematic of Two-Winding Transformer Insulation Capacitance for Power Factor
Measurements 18
17
From the Doble Engineering Website: www.doble.com
18
The IEC equivalent nomenclature for the winding terminals is as follows: H1=1U; H2=1V, H3=1W; X1=2U;
X2=2V; X3=2W, X0=2N
128
The capacitance between these two terminals and between each terminal and the
ground terminal, represented by the tank and core, are shown schematically in Figure
3-17. In Figure 3-17, the capacitances are defined as follows:
x CH represents the insulation between the high-voltage winding conductor and the
grounded tank and core. The capacitance takes into account the HV bushings,
structural insulating members, the de-energized tap changer insulation, and the
insulating fluid.
x CL represents the insulation between the low-voltage winding conductors and the
grounded tank and core. The capacitance takes into account the LV bushings,
the winding insulation, the structural insulating members, the LTC insulation, and
the insulating fluid.
x CHL represents the insulation between the high- and low-voltage windings and
includes the winding insulation barriers and the insulating fluid.
129
Figure 3-18: Power Factor Measurement of CHL + CH Insulation (GST)
130
Figure 3-20: Power Factor Measurement of CHL Insulation (UST)
131
Figure 3-22: Power Factor Measurement of CL Insulation (GST/g)
132
Figure 3-24: Schematic of Three-Winding Transformer Insulation Capacitance for Power Factor
Measurements
133
Figure 3-25: High Voltage to Ground Insulation Power Factor for Representative Good Insulation
Systems
For oil-filled distribution transformers, the power factor numbers in the table are
doubled. For power factor values that are classified as bad or investigate, other test
methods are necessary to positively identify the cause of the high power factor. Such
tests include dissolved gas-in-oil analysis, moisture-in-oil analysis, dielectric frequency
response analysis (DFR), frequency response analysis (FRA/SFRA), and power factor
tip-up test. Most of these tests are discussed in more detail in later sections. A
discussion of the power factor tip-up test follows.
134
3.2.7.5 POWER FACTOR TIP-UP TESTS
The power factor tip-up test is performed by applying voltage in equal steps from zero to
the maximum allowed voltage. The test is performed on the section of insulation with
highest power factor reading. For each applied voltage, the current and watts loss
through the insulation is measured, and the power factor is calculated. If moisture or
other polar contaminants are the cause of the high power factor, the measured power
factor will be essentially the same for all applied voltages. If the power factor increases
with voltage, there is likely ionic contamination and/or carbonization of the oil or
windings for oil-filled transformers. For dry type transformers, the problem may be due
to ionic contaminants or the presence of voids in the winding insulation.
Several factors can lead to an inadvertent ground connection to the core: the core-
ground insulation can deteriorate to a point where the insulation becomes resistive; the
core-ground insulation can become damaged during transportation of a transformer; or
the core-ground insulation can become damaged in a through-fault incident. If an
unintentional core ground is established as a result of any of the above conditions, there
will likely be circulating currents in the core. The result will be hotspots in the core and
surrounding metal structures. The presence of these hotspots can be detected using a
DGA screening. Key gases to look for are ethane, ethylene, and/or possibly methane.
Depending on the location of the hotspots, cellulose may be involved, and the gases
may include CO and CO2.
The test is performed using a standard DC Megger® such as the one shown in Figure
3-26. The two test leads of the Megger test set are connected between the isolated
core-ground lead and the transformer ground. A DC voltage of no more than 1000 volts
135
is applied across the leads, and the resistance is measured. Depending on the resulting
resistance, Table 3-31 can be used to guide what action must be taken.
Measured Core-Ground
Possible Interpretation Action
Resistance
New transformer. Good core-
1000 MΩ NONE
ground insulation.
Service aged transformer.
100 MΩ Acceptable core-ground NONE
insulation.
Deteriorating core-ground Investigate cause of deterioration
10 to < 100 MΩ
insulation. and mitigate.
Deteriorated insulation is
Investigate and correct before
1 to < 10 MΩ possible cause of circulating
re-energization.
currents.
Check to make sure a limiting
resistor is not being used in the
Possible high-resistance ground
200-1000 Ohms core-ground circuit. If not, there is
between core and ground.
a possible high-resistance ground
that must be corrected.
Solid connection between core Investigate and correct before
< 10 Ohms
and ground. re-energization.
If the core-ground insulation is less than 10 MΩ, the first step in investigating the
inadvertent ground connection is to switch to an ohmmeter and measure the resistance
between the core and ground. This should help establish whether there is a solid
ground connection or a high-resistance ground present. In either case, there are field
techniques available in eliminating the unintentional grounds (see IEEE Standard 62).
19
From AVO website: http://www.avomegger.com/.
136
3.2.9 EXCITATION CURRENT TESTS
The excitation current test is one of the means of identifying problems associated with
the core or winding of the transformer. The test can possibly detect core problems
such as shorted core laminations and poor joints. Winding problems detected include
short circuited or open circuited turns, poor electrical connections, tap changer
problems, and other possible core and winding problems. The exciting current
consists of a magnetizing component and a loss component. The magnitude of the
magnetizing component is determined by the shape of the performance curve of the
core steel, its operating flux density, and the number of turns in the primary winding.
The loss component is determined by the losses in the core. Joint construction
severely affects the magnitude of the excitation current. Changes in the hysteresis
and eddy current characteristics due to handling the steel also affect the excitation
current.
To perform the test, voltage is applied to the primary windings one at a time with all
other windings left open. The excitation current of a transformer is the current which
the transformer draws when voltage is applied to its primary terminals with the
secondary terminal open. It is important to perform the excitation current tests before
any direct current (DC) tests. DC tests leave a residual magnetism in the core that
would distort an excitation current test. Before performing an excitation current test,
the following steps are necessary [75]:
x For routine tests, the load tap changer (LTC) should be set to neutral, then to
one step above neutral, then to one step below neutral, and then to full raise or
full lower. To ensure that the tap selector is functioning properly throughout the
entire range of selection, you may want to perform tests on all LTC positions.
x Test voltages should not exceed the rated line-to-line voltage for delta-
connected windings or rated line-to-neutral voltage for wye-connected
windings. These tests are generally made at 2.5, 5, or 10 kV, as the capacity of
the test equipment permits.
x Test voltages should be the same for each phase. Because of the nonlinear
behavior of exciting current, test voltages should be set accurately if results are
to be compared. If excitation tests have previously been performed, the same
test voltage should be used for the current test.
137
measured on the even steps and neutral positions are similar to each other but
different from those measured on the odd steps. The currents measured on the odd
steps are similar to each other. The difference is attributed to how the reactor-
switching device is connected to the tap winding when the tap is on an even or odd
position. For the even numbered and neutral positions, the two contacts of the
reactor-switching device are on the same stationary contact. For odd numbered
positions, the switching contacts bridge adjacent stationary contacts [76].
3.2.9.1 MEASUREMENT SETUP
The excitation current test can be performed using any high-voltage source and a
precision amplifier. However, since both are present in a power factor test set, these
test sets are normally used to perform the excitation current test. The testing mode
for all measurements is set to UST (Ungrounded Specimen Test). See Figure 3-27,
Figure 3-28, and Figure 3-29 for the setup of the excitation current measurements for
various transformer configurations. Table 3-32 is a summary of the test connections
and the means for analyzing test results.
For single phase transformers, the test is performed with high-voltage windings
energized alternately from opposite ends and reading the excitation current in both
configurations. The two currents obtained should be the same. Currents recorded for
single phase transformers should be compared either with similar units or with data
obtained from previous tests on the same unit. If single phase excitation current tests
were included in the factory test specifications, comparing test data reveals changes
undergone between the factory and the field.
138
Table 3-32: Excitation Current Test Connection Using Power Factor Test Set20
Transformer Measured
Energized Measurement Floating Normal Current
Type and 21 Ground Lead* Excitation
Lead Lead Terminals Pattern
Connection Current
H1 H2 X1X 2 IH1-H2
Single Phase IH1-H2 ~ IH2-H1
H2 H1 X1X 2 IH2-H1
Three Phase
H1 H0 H2H3,X 1X 2X 3 IH1-H0
Core Form
H2 H0 H1H3,X 1X 2X 3 IH2-H0 (I H1-H0 ~ I H3-H0) > IH2-H0
Wye-Connected
H3 H0 H1H2,X 1X 2X 3 IH3-H0
3-limb core
Three Phase
H1 H0 H2H3,X 1X 2X 3 IH1-H0
Shell Form
H2 H0 H1H3,X 1X 2X 3 IH2-H0 (I H1-H0 ~ I H3-H0) > IH2-H0
Wye-Connected
H3 H0 H1H2,X 1X 2X 3 IH3-H0
D core
Three Phase
IH1-H0 ~ I H2-H0 ~ I H3-H0
Core Form H1 H0 H2H3,X 1X 2X 3 IH1-H0
(The middle phase
Wye- H2 H0 H1H3,X 1X 2X 3 IH2-H0
may be slightly
Connected H3 H0 H1H2,X 1X 2X 3 IH3-H0
higher)
5-limb core
Three Phase
H1 H0 H2H3,X 1X 2X 3 IH1-H0
Shell Form
H2 H0 H1H3,X 1X 2X 3 IH2-H0 (I H1-H0 ~ I H3-H0) > IH2-H0
Wye-Connected
H3 H0 H1H2,X 1X 2X 3 IH3-H0
7-limb core
Table 3-32 lists the forms of transformer construction, the associated magnetic core
configuration, and the usual pattern of core excitation current measurements. In old
designs with non-step lap cores, the quality of the joint gaps has a large effect on the
magnitude of the exciting current such that end phases can have significantly
different measured values of exciting current. The magnitude of the difference can
well be in the same range or even higher than the difference between the measured
exciting current of the middle and end phases. Therefore, the rules on the relative
magnitudes of the exciting current may not apply to these cores. In such cases, only
much greater differences need to be considered as an indication of a problem.
20
The IEC equivalent nomenclature for the winding terminals is as follows: H1=1U; H2=1V, H3=1W; H0=1N;
X1=2U; X2=2V; X3=2W, X0=2N
21
All measurements are performed with the test set in UST mode.
*
If the secondary winding is wye connected, the neutral (X0) should be connected to ground.
139
Figure 3-27: Excitation Current Test Method for Single Phase Transformers
Figure 3-28: Excitation Current Test Method for Three Phase Wye-Connected Transformers
Figure 3-29: Excitation Current Test Method for Three Phase Delta-Connected Transformers
140
3.2.9.2 ANALYSIS OF EXCITATION CURRENT RESULTS
If the excitation current is less than 50 mA, the difference between the two higher
currents for a three phase transformer should be less than 10 %. If the excitation
current is greater than 50 mA, the difference should be less than 5 %. In general, if
there is an internal problem, these differences will be greater. When this happens,
other tests should also show abnormalities and an internal inspection should be
considered. If factory tests or prior tests exist, the results should be compared with
them to assess any deviations. High precision does not appear to be necessary in
excitation current tests. The serious faults that have been found have increased
excitation current magnitudes by greater than 10% over normal values [75].
22
FLIR website: http://www.flirthermography.com/cameras/camera/1016/.
141
When an object is heated, it radiates electromagnetic energy. The amount of energy is
related to the object’s temperature. The thermal imager can determine the temperature
of the object without physical contact by measuring the emitted energy. The energy
from a heated object is radiated at different levels across the electromagnetic spectrum.
In most industrial applications, it is the energy radiated at infrared wavelengths which is
used to determine the object’s temperature. The thermal imager focuses the emitted
energy via an optical system onto a detector. The detector converts infrared energy into
an electrical voltage which is used to build the thermal picture in the operator’s
viewfinder on board the thermal imager after amplification and complex signal
processing.
3.2.10.2 CRITERIA FOR EVALUATING INFRARED MEASUREMENTS
When carrying out thermographic inspections, faults are often identified by comparing
heat patterns in similar components operating under similar loads. There is typically
software available with the infrared camera to analyze the temperature signature of the
object under test. A reference point is established on the object for normal temperature.
The temperature rise of all other points on the object is then evaluated in relation to the
reference point temperature. If there are hotspots on the object, the criticality of the
hotspots is evaluated in regards to the magnitude of deviation from the reference
temperature (temperature rise above reference). There are several guidelines for
diagnosing the criticality based on the temperature rises. For example, in performing
temperature-rise tests on transformers, it is recommended that the surface temperature
of the tank, as measured by an infrared camera, be no more than 20 °C higher than the
top oil temperature of the transformer [80].
Temperature Above
Criticality Condition
Reference, Industry
Nominal possibility of
Nominal 0 to 10 oC permanent damage. Repair
next maintenance period.
Possibility of permanent
Intermediate 10 to 20 oC
damage. Repair soon.
Probability of permanent
damage to item and
Serious 20 to 40 oC
surrounding area. Repair
immediately.
Critical over 40 oC Failure imminent.
23
NASA RCM Specs.
142
3.2.10.3 EXAMPLE USES OF INFRARED THERMOGRAPHY DIAGNOSTICS ON POWER TRANSFORMERS [81]
This section provides a few examples24 of the use of infrared thermography to diagnose
problems in transformers and accessories.
3.2.10.3.1 Loose connection at bushing outlet terminal
When there is a loose connection at the terminal from the bushing to the bus work, it will
lead to overheating of the bushing top terminal when under load. The thermograph will
show the bushing terminal as hot, while the body of the porcelain will show normal
temperatures. Figure 3-31 shows a thermograph of a hot bushing terminal.
24
Examples are used courtesy of FLIR Systems: www.flirthermography.com.
143
3.2.10.3.3 LTC overheating
Under normal operating conditions and because of I2R and eddy current heating, the
main tank of a transformer will have a higher temperature than the LTC tank in which
there is essentially no heat generation under non-switching conditions. If hotspots
develop in the LTC compartment, this will increase the overall temperature of the LTC
compartment, which may become hotter than the main transformer tank. Such a
situation will be evident on an infrared scan, as shown in Figure 3-33.
144
In this case, the moist regions will show up as dim regions in the thermograph image
[82].
3.2.11 BUSHINGS
3.2.11.1 ANSI & IEC – COMMON DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS
A visual inspection for leakage may be performed during normal station supervision.
Clean the porcelain insulator with water-jet or wiping with a moist cloth. If necessary,
ethyl-alcohol or ethyl-acetatte may be used.
Clean the porcelain insulator with water-jet or wiping with a moist cloth. If necessay,
ethyl-alcohol or ethyl-acetatte may be used. 1,1,1, -Thrichlorethane or Methylchloride
are not recommended due to their possibly harmful and environmentally detrimental
properties.
3.2.11.1.3 Thermovision
Hot spots on the bushing surface can be detected by using an Infrared (IR)-sensitive
camera (see Figure 3-35). At maximum rated current, the bushing outer terminal should
show a temperature of about 35-45 °C above the ambient air. Significantly higher
temperatures, especially at lower current loading, can be an indication of bad
connections.
Figure 3-35 : Measurement indicating poor current path between bushing inner and outer terminal
145
3.2.11.1.4 Oil sampling from bushing
Oil samples shall preferably be taken during dry weather conditions. If, due to some
urgent reason, the sample is taken under any other conditions, the following must be
observed:
The internal pressure of the bushing must not be altered before and after the sampling
as the bushing is supposed to work within a specified range. This requirement is
satisfied if the sample is taken when the mean temperature of the bushing is between
0°C and 30°C.
The time when the bushing is open shall be as short as possible. Flushing with dry air or
nitrogen is normally not necessary.
The oil removed from the bushing shall always be replaced by the same volume of new
transformer oil. The new oil shall comply with IEC 296, class II and shall be clean and
dry.
The sample is taken from a plug in the top of the bushing, preferably with a syringe with
a rubber hose connected.
The location for the sampling plug is shown in Figure 3-36. The dimension of the gasket
is given in Table 3-34. The material of the gasket shall be Nitrile rubber with a hardness
of 70 Shore.
146
Figure 3-36 : Location of oil sampling plugs on some of the most common bushing types.
The tightening torque for the M8 sealing plug on GOB, GOE and GOH shall be 20 Nm.
The tightening torque for the M16 sealing plug on GOE shall be 50 Nm.
Sampling procedure for GOEK, GOM and other bushings with sampling valve on the
flange
Connect the end of the hose to a suitable nipple and connect the nipple to the valve on
the flange. The thread in the valve is (R 1/4") BSPT 1/4". Suck out the oil. Depending on
the temperature the pressure inside the bushing might be above or below atmospheric
pressure. After the sampling is finished the bushing shall not be energized within 12
hours.
Sampling procedure for GOA, GOC and GOG
On the GOA, GOC and GOG bushings, the oil samples are taken from the hole for the
oil level plug on the top housing as shown in Figure 3-36. If the bushing is vertically
147
mounted, the oil level is right at the plug level at 20°C. The sample is sucked out by a
syringe. If the oil temperature is slightly higher than 20°C the oil level will be above the
plug level. In such a case the hose on the syringe should be equipped with a nipple as
shown in Figure 3-37. The oil plug is removed and the hose with the nipple is attached
immediately.
If the temperature is below 20 °C, the oil level will be below the plug and the sample is
sucked out according to Figure 3-38. The tightening torque for the 5/8" sealing plug shall
be 50 Nm.
This method for diagnostics can only be used on oil filled bushings, for example, GOx
types. Normally, it is not recommended to take oil samples from bushings. The bushing
is sealed and tightness tested at the time of manufacturing. In order to take an oil
sample, the bushing has to be opened and this introduces a risk of improper re-sealing
after the sampling is finished.
However, when a problem is known, for example high power factor over C1, there might
be a need for oil sampling and gas analysis. The interpretation of the analysis is done
according to Technical Report IEC 61464. If questions remain, ABB can assist with the
evaluation.
148
It is sometimes difficult to get the proper moisture content in bushing oil. Compared to a
transformer, a bushing has a much higher ratio of paper to oil. This means that
regardless of the bushing manufacturing process, there will always be much more
moisture in the paper than in the oil. In paper the moisture content is measured in
percent, whereas in oil the moisture content is measured in parts per million (ppm).
Depending on the temperature of the bushing, the moisture will move from the paper to
the oil or from the oil to the paper. Due to this, a bushing will always show much higher
moisture content in the oil after a certain time of high temperature operation. To get a
proper value, the oil sample should be taken at least 48 hours after the entire bushing
has reached room temperature.
The bushing is delivered from ABB with maximum moisture content in the insulating oil
of 3 ppm. If considerably higher concentrations are measured, the sealing system is
likely damaged on the bushing.
If the moisture content is greater than 10 ppm, a tan G measurement of the bushing C1
capacitance should be performed. If the moisture content is greater than 20 ppm, the
bushing should be taken out of service.
149
3.2.11.2 DIAGNOSTICS TECHNIQUES FOR BUSHINGS COMPLYING WITH THE ANSI/IEEE STANDARDS
150
Figure 3-40: Bushing C2 Power Factor Measurement Setup (GST/g)
151
Condenser bushings rated 69 kV and below as mentioned earlier, have the main C1
capacitance, which is strictly controlled by design. The capacitance and power factor
values behave the same behavior and characteristics as those for the 115kV and above
bushings. However, these bushings have an inherent C2 capacitance, which is
dependent upon a few outer layers of paper with adhesive, an oil gap between
the flange and the condenser core, and the tap insulator. Variations in adhesive
in the outer paper layers and other factors can result in power factor variations
in bushings of the same style number. In addition, the close proximity of the C1 layer
with the mounting flange results in greater fringing effect between the two parts. As a
result of this, the porcelains, oil, and air surrounding the bushing can affect the C2
power factor test values. In particular, high current Type T condenser bushings with a
short mounting flange and a long internal C1 layer/foil tend to exhibit higher power
factors because of greater coupling effect between the C1 layer/foil and the surrounding
materials. Depending upon the design, the C2 power factor of these bushings can range
from 0.1 % to 2 %. It is important to note that the IEEE Standard does not specify any
limit for C2 power factor.
For bushings rated 69 kV and below, the IEEE Standard only requires stamping
of C1 power factor and capacitance on the nameplate. As a result of frequent
requests from customers, ABB Inc. Alamo, TN started stamping the C2 power factor and
capacitance test values on bushing nameplates since December of 2002. With this
addition, the nameplates of all AB, O Plus C, and T condenser bushings are now
stamped with factory test values of C1 and C2 power factor and capacitance. However,
because of the reasons mentioned above, users may see a greater variation in C2
power factor and capacitance values in different bushings of the same design.
It is important to compare the initial test values before installation with the
nameplate values. To verify nameplate values (especially for Type T bushings), the
measurements should be made with the bushing mounted on a metallic test tank/stand
with the lower end porcelain immersed in dry good quality oil. There should be sufficient
clearance (at least 16 - 20 inch) from the bushing lower porcelain/terminal to the
grounded tank. For C2 measurement, the center conductor should be guarded and the
test tap voltage should not exceeding 1 kV.
Once the bushing has been installed in the apparatus, it should be retested to establish
a benchmark value. It is important to compare the subsequent field test values with the
initial benchmark value after installation.
Table 3-36 provides typical and questionable power factor values for bushings from
several manufacturers and of various types.
152
Table 3-36: Typical Bushing Power Factors 25
25
Doble Testing Power Apparatus Bushings, 2004 International Conference of Doble Clients
153
3.2.11.2.3 Bushing Hot Collar Test
In cases where a bushing does not have a bushing tap, the C1 and C2 power factor
measurements described above cannot be performed. In such cases, a hot collar test is
performed. This test applies to compound-filled bushings, solid porcelain bushings, gas-
filled bushings, and oil-filled bushings that are not equipped with taps and for which the
bushing overall test cannot be performed. The hot collar test is also useful for various
other bushing checks:
x To check bushing oil level on oil-filled bushings without either sight glasses or
liquid level gauges
x For bushings with suspect or defective oil level gauges, to check bushing oil
level
x As a supplement test when overall or tap tests indicate possible problem.
The test is performed by applying single or multiple collars to various sections of the
bushing. Figure 3-41 shows the setup for a single-collar test in UST mode. This
configuration measures a portion of the insulating watershed, sight glass, core
insulation in upper area, and liquid or compound filler in the upper area of the bushing.
Figure 3-42 shows a similar setup but in GST mode. In addition to the items measured
in the UST mode, this configuration also measures the surface leakage from the collar
to the LV lead and from the collar to the bushing flange. Because the test measures
smaller sections of material, very small dielectric losses and currents are recorded.
Consequently, small changes in either value have tremendous impact on the value of
the calculated power factor. It is therefore advisable to use the value of the measured
dielectric loss as the determining factor in assessing the results of the hot collar test.
The recommended acceptable limits for hot collar tests are 0.1 W at 10 kV and 0.006
W at 2.5 kV. Also, the dielectric loss for the same section in the same type of bushing
should be approximately equal. As a cautionary note, because relatively small currents
are being measured in this test, it is important to clean and dry the bushings before
performing this test. The following cleaners have been suggested by various utilities: dry
clean cloth, water and soap, ColoniteTM, and WindexTM with Ammonia. It is never
recommended to use evaporative solvents on bushings.
154
Figure 3-41: Hot Collar UST Mode Power Factor Test
A hot collar test can yield one of three results: watt losses in normal range, increased
watt losses, or decreased current. Increased values in watt losses (0.1 W) typically
indicate contamination in the insulation system. Decreased values in current (compared
155
to similar bushings) may indicate the presence of voids in the insulation or low liquid or
compound level in the bushing.
1. Re-check all connections, including ground lead and bushing flange ground
2. Make sure ground connection is good
3. Check test circuit used for the measurement
4. Check test set and test set leads
5. Visually inspect bushing sheds and oil
6. Clean and dry all surfaces
7. Compare and analyze results of similar bushings
8. Research the history of the bushing for flashover or line surge activity
9. Verify temperature correction factor was used for C1 and overall tests (note that
C2 power factors are not temperature corrected)
10. If still uncertain, contact the manufacturer
3.2.11.2.5.1 History
General Electric, a major player in the electrical world since the early 1900s, was
engaged in the development and manufacture of apparatus bushings since as early as
1920. In the quest to develop the best bushing in the world, GE created many different
types and styles of bushings such as Types A, F, L, LC, OF, T, and U for both
transformer and circuit breaker applications.
Let’s concentrate on the Type U bushing history and technology first. Type U bushings
were manufactured with voltage ratings from 15 kV through 800 kV. A Type U bushing
is a condenser design with oil-impregnated paper inside an oil-filled shell. The shell
consists of a cap, an upper porcelain weather casing, a metal mounting flange, a lower
porcelain, and a lower porcelain support. For sealing purposes, all parts are held
together under a centrally clamped spring tension method. The principle behind a
condenser bushing is to incorporate equal capacitance layers to provide equal voltage
steps, resulting in a uniform voltage gradient throughout the bushing body and over the
bushing surface.
The type of design and the materials within a condenser core may differ between
manufacturers, but the design intention is the same. The type of construction used in
some Type U designs was a herringbone pattern, surface-printed ink that formed the
capacitive layers. A plain Kraft paper was wound into the condenser between the active
ink-lined paper layers. For most of the production, both the lined paper and the plain
paper were .008 inches in thickness (see Figure 3-43).
156
Figure 3-43: Surface-Printed Ink Condenser
So, what is the cause(s) related to the increase in power factor in Type U
bushings?
Through Doble Client Conferences, utility feedback, insurance company reports,
General Electric documents, and our own investigations, ABB has accumulated data
and has the following concern for Type U bushings.
The condenser design with ink-lined paper with plain Kraft paper allowed a gap at the
ends of the active layers in the condenser core. A heavily loaded transformer will
generate heat internal to the bushing, subject the bushing to a higher immersion oil
temperature, and consequently increase internal temperature in the bushing. The
heated bushing oil expands and intensifies the pressure in the confined gas space,
which causes an increased quantity of gas to become dissolved in the oil. Cyclic
reduction in transformer load and/or reduction of ambient temperature allow cooling of
the bushing oil. As the oil cools, it contracts, reducing the pressure of its gas blanket. If
the pressure reduction occurs rapidly enough, the gas-saturated oil will develop a
tendency to evolve bubbles of gas. This evolution will first occur in the highest
157
electrically stress regions of the bushings, normally between the lined paper and the
plain paper layers of the bushing core. A critical combination of gas bubbles and
dielectric stress causes partial discharges to occur within the insulation system.
The long-term effect of the discharges is an increase in the dielectric losses in the
insulation system, resulting in an increased power factor.
Figure 3-44: Rescon Conductive Ink Transfers from the Printed Paper Layers (left) to the Plain
Kraft Paper Layers or Conductor (right), Resulting in Corona Action and Slight Burning (circled)
158
What kV ratings of Type U bushings used herringbone ink processing?
The herringbone ink process was used in Type U bushings in the voltage range 15-345
kV. However, some Type U bushings in this voltage range have metal foil designed
condensers. Most bushings 345 kV and above have foil designed condensers, but many
have herringbone lined paper.
Should you be concerned only with Type U condenser bushings rated 15-345 kV?
Type U bushings were manufactured using a flex seal design. The flex seal is a copper
diaphragm located in the top cap of bushings 161 kV and above. The flex seal (see
Figure 3-45) was designed to allow for the expansion/contraction or movement of parts
during thermal cycling of the bushing.
The flex seal diaphragm in many cases, depending on catalog number and application,
carries the current from the main conductor to the cap cover to the upper terminal
connection. As the diaphragm experienced movement, acting as an accordion, the
diaphragm could experience mechanical stresses, which would crack and result in a
leak. Since the diaphragm is internal to the bushing, and is placed above normal oil
level, where could the bushing leak?
During processing of the oil in the transformer, the oil could be evacuated from the
bushing by vacuum if the bushing was inclined, or the bushing could become filled with
oil during the transformer vacuum/fill process. If the bushing is full of oil (with no
expansion space) and if the bushing is applied at higher temperatures, the oil will
expand and compromise the gasketing system.
The flex seal system is connected to the main conductor with a swell seal gasket and a
seal nut. This connection is also under oil and under spring tension of the bushing. The
159
upper connection at the cover relies totally on the cover bolt tightness to adequately
carry the current from the flex seal through the cover to the customer terminal
connection. If the cover bolts have become loose over time, hotspots will develop, which
will compromise the cover gaskets. This situation is best revealed in the field by utilizing
thermal scans with infrared apparatus.
Hotspots such as this can lead to catastrophic failure if not resolved immediately. GE
recognized that the flex seal design could be improved upon, so they introduced the slip
seal design in 1976 (see Figure 3-46). The slip seal design totally eliminates the flex
seal but still allows the bushing to expand and contract during thermal cycling.
Many Type U bushings were designed and manufactured to have the ability to change
top terminals in the field. For instance, if a customer damaged the external threading of
a top terminal, they could replace the top terminal without removing the bushing from
the transformer. Also, draw lead bushings have a removable top terminal to allow
disconnection from the transformer winding lead without requiring entry to or removal of
oil from the transformer.
160
How do you know if your Type U bushings have herringbone ink condensers or
foil condensers, flex seal systems, slip seal designs, or removable top terminals?
Contact ABB! ABB Alamo has the documentation for all GE bushings. We have all of
the original design, test, and manufacturing data for Type U bushings. If you have the
catalog number and the group number from the nameplate of your bushings, ABB can
help identify the type of bushing design to evaluate your critical needs, such as bushing
maintenance, repair, refurbishment, or replacement.
Depending on the age, voltage class, current rating, design, and the condition of the
existing bushing, Type U bushings may be refurbished. Certain Type U bushings are
excellent candidates for refurbishment. If the bushing external parts are in good
condition and the concern centers on the herringbone ink condenser or flex seal
system, it is very economical to refurbish Type U bushings rated 115 kV and above or
bushings below 69 kV that have a high current rating (such as 4,000 amps and above).
The key to refurbishing Type U bushings is access to the original design documents and
having trained, experienced people. All bushings refurbished by ABB will be updated
with the latest ABB design enhancements and will carry a new nameplate and warranty.
Were Type U bushings manufactured and supplied to the field with oil
contaminated with PCB?
Yes! We cannot determine the content of PCB in a bushing by the serial number,
catalog number or the group number off of the nameplate. The only way to determine
the PCB level is to have the oil tested. We can give some guidelines. Bushings
manufactured by GE Pittsfield from 1954 to 1973 can have PCB levels that range from
50 to 500 ppm. From 1973 to 1980 we have test reports reporting levels from 2 to 50
ppm PCB. From 1981 to 1986 the levels are normally non-detectable or less than 1 ppm
PCB.
161
In 1985, Doble Company published recommended limits for Type U bushings.
Today, ABB has approximately a 65 % market share of new bushings sold into the US
and is the leading supplier of replacement bushings for Type U bushings to the Utility
and Industrials in the United States. ABB has the following recommendations:
x If the bushing power factor doubles original nameplate value, the bushing is
questionable and should be replaced or refurbished.
x If the capacitance increases to 110 % of the original installation value, the
bushing is questionable and should be replaced or refurbished.
How can ABB make these recommendations, and on what basis can these
statements be made?
Being the sounding board for 170 major utilities and many industrials across the US, we
have seen the electrical industry increase awareness of Type U bushings due to high
power factors and failures of Type U bushings.
At the same time, we have noticed maintenance periods have been extended beyond
recommended levels. In today’s competitive marketplace, companies have downsized
maintenance programs and extended periodic maintenance from 1 year intervals up to
3 years and as high as 5 years or more.
Through field surveys and field experience, we have noted that if a Type U bushing is
exhibiting a rise in power factor, the rise accelerates very quickly once the action has
started. Therefore, many utilities know that if they are on a 3- or 4-year maintenance
interval and a bushing exhibits a rising power factor, the bushing will not perform for the
next 3- or 4-year period without failure.
The normal practice is to remove the bushings from the transformer immediately. Once
the corona (partial discharge) activity has started, the remaining service life of the
bushing can be very short, and it could fail catastrophically.
3.2.11.2.5.2 Recommendation
162
x If you have bushings with removable top terminals, proper maintenance must be
applied on a yearly basis either by thermal scan or manual inspection methods.
For manual inspection of top terminals, check to see if the terminal can be
loosened first. If the terminal cannot he removed, the terminal may have seen
overheating and/or corrosion build-up and should be removed from service.
x If the terminal can be removed, inspect the top terminal gasket and look to see if
there are signs of corrosion. If the terminal gasket appears to be brittle or have a
permanent set, replace the gasket. When replacing the gasket, be sure to
lubricate the gasket with petroleum jelly to prevent twisting of the gasket as the
terminal is tightened. Tighten the top terminal to the correct torque values with
the proper tools or fixtures.
x If bushing top terminals show signs of corrosion or the top terminal cannot be
removed, we recommend replacement or refurbishment of the bushing. Top
terminal overheating can compromise the bushing gasketing system or create
loss of life of the bushing insulating system. This could result in a catastrophic
failure if the proper action is not taken.
Bottom connected bushings 161 kV and above rated 1,600 amp and above can be
refurbished to the new ABB Unified top terminal design per Figure 3-47. The ABB
Unified top terminal design eliminates top terminal maintenance and overheating,
corrosion, or deteriorating gasketing systems.
163
Who can rebuild or refurbish Type U bushings to be like new?
Some major utilities have tried to rebuild their own bushings, a few small business
service shops have tried, and other bushing manufacturers have also tried to rebuild
Type U bushings. Most rebuilds by people other than ABB rely on guesswork or reverse
engineering to determine the makeup and design of the original bushing.
GE went through many design changes through the years. GE designed and
manufactured over 5,000 different catalog or styles of bushings, and within each catalog
or style there are an average of 7 design and manufacturing changes. That means there
are over 35,000 different Type U bushing designs in the field today. The key to
rebuilding Type U bushings is to have all the documentation, such as the drawings,
design changes, manufacturing processes, and test data. ABB has this design and
original manufacturing information as well as design engineers and technicians
experienced with GE technology. Table 3-37 shows typical design information for Type
U bushings. ABB will not rebuild bushings without the original design information. If
applicable or economical for the customer, ABB rebuilds Type U bushings to the latest
technology.
Table 3-37: Typical Type U Bushing Design Information
164
Are there other reasons why a customer should refurbish bushings?
Is the Type “T” bushing a predecessor to the Type “U” bushing manufactured by
General Electric?
Type “T” bushings were designed and manufactured by General Electric for low-voltage,
high-current, low-corona, transformer applications. GE supplied low-voltage, high-
current, stud type or bulk type bushings (Type “A” bushings) for many years, and then
the market demanded a bushing with low corona values. GE’s answer to the market
demand was the ultimate low-corona condenser bushing technology, the Type “T.” GE
manufactured Type “T” bushings from 1971 to 1985. Type “T” bushings range from 25
kV to 34.5 kV and current ratings 600 ampere draw lead to 18,000 ampere bottom
connected. These bushings were designed for low-voltage applications; therefore, GE
designed bushings for horizontal and vertical applications. To achieve maximum low
corona values, not obtainable by bulk type bushings, GE incorporated a condenser into
the design.
Type “T” bushings are basically designed and manufactured in the same manner as
Type “U” bushings. Outside shell and mechanical parts are very similar. What about the
condenser core process? The condenser design and process is the same as the Type
“U” using herringbone ink lined printed paper.
No. Some Type “T” bushings are designed for high-temperature (125 °C) applications.
Units designed for high-temperature applications used Nomex winding paper with foil
inserts for gradients. The ink process could not be applied to the Nomex winding paper.
165
Is the concern for Type “T” bushings as valid as the concern for Type “U”
bushings even though they are a low-voltage bushing?
Yes! Even more so. The normal application of these bushings is on the low-voltage side
of a transformer with higher current ratings, higher temperatures, and sometimes they
are applied in bus ducts. When these bushings are subjected to thermal cycling, gas
bubbles trapped in high-stress areas of the lined ink printed paper condenser can create
partial discharge leading to a high power factor or failure of the bushing.
How do you know if you have herringbone ink lined paper or foil gradients in your
Type “T” bushings?
Contact ABB. If you know the General Electric catalog number and the group number
from the nameplate of the bushing, ABB can research the General Electric drawings in
our archives and verify the type of design. If you wish to discuss applications, such as
high temperature, ABB can also verify if the units are suitable for 105 °C or 125 °C
applications. Many transformer manufacturers, utilities, and contractors tend to misapply
bushings in high-temperature applications assuming that higher current rated bushings
can be applied at higher temperature ratings. Overload conditions described in IEEE
Standard C57.19.100 section 4 are normally abused more with Type “T” and bulk-type
bushings than other types of bushings. The updated ABB “Criteria for Concern”
(power factor and capacitance values) and recommended maintenance applies to Type
“T” bushings as well as Type “U” bushings.
Can you buy new bushings to replace Type “T” bushings or can Type “T”
bushings be refurbished?
Yes & yes! ABB offers direct replacement bushings for Type “T” bushings. ABB
manufactures Type “T” bushings today with the same dimensional and electrical
characteristics as the General Electric bushings for ease of installation, proper fit, and
application, but ABB has incorporated into today’s Type “T” the advanced technology
and superior condenser design of the ABB Type O Plus C bushing.
Although Type “T” bushings are low voltage, they are typically high current, and the
economics of refurbishment is well worth the effort. Normally, a refurbished bushing is
approximately 65 % of the cost of a new bushing. Please be aware that GE went
through many gasketing system design changes in the early stages of the Type “T”
design. ABB utilizes the original GE design data and drawings to update bushings to the
best design and latest technology when refurbishing bushings to “as new” condition.
3.2.11.3 DIAGNOSTICS AND CONDITIONING ON ABB BUSHINGS COMPLYING WITH THE IEC STANDARD
166
WARNING
Make sure that the transformer is de-energized and out of service before any
work is performed on the bushing.
3.2.11.3.1 Capacitance and tanG measurement
Prior to taking a condenser bushing into service, and on suspected faults, the
capacitance and dissipation factor should be measured and compared with the values
given on the rating plate or in the routine test report. In connection with these tests, the
electrical connection between transformer tank and bushing flange shall also be
checked, for instance with a buzzer.
3.2.11.3.2 Temperature correction
The measured dissipation factor value shall be temperature corrected according to the
correction factors given in Table 3-38. GOx stands for all oil-impregnated paper
condenser bushings (OIP) and GSx stands for resin-impregnated paper condenser
bushings (RIP). For all bushings it shall be assumed that the bushing has the same
temperature as the top oil of the transformer. The test should be performed at a
temperature as high as possible. Correction shall be made to 20°C. The corrected
dissipation factor (tan G) shall be compared with the value on the rating plate or in the
test report.
0-25% increase: The value is recorded and no further measures are taken.
25-40% increase: The measuring circuit is checked regarding leakage and external
interferences. External interference can come from nearby current carrying equipment
167
and bus bars. If the difference remains, the problem may be due to moisture. The
gaskets of the oil level plugs need to be replaced according to the product information
for the bushing. The measured value is recorded, and the bushing can be put back into
service.
40-75% increase: Perform the measures discussed for 25-40% increase and repeat
the measurement within one month.
More than 75% increase: The bushing shall be taken out of service. However, if the
dissipation factor is less than 0.4%, the bushing may be restored to service even if the
increase in percentage from the initial value is greater than 75%.
Capacitance: The measured capacitance, C1 shall be compared with the value given
on the rating plate of the bushing or with the 10 kV routine test report. If the
measurement is more than 3% from the nameplate value, there could be a partial
puncture of the insulation. An extremely low value C1 value (disruption) may be due to
transport damage and the bushing must not be returned to service. In either case,
please contact ABB. The C2 capacitance is influenced by the way the bushing is
mounted onto the transformer and should not be used for diagnostics.
Figure 3-48: Tan G as a function of temperature and moisture level in OIP bushings.
168
It is clearly visible that the measurements at elevated temperature are more sensitive.
At 20 °C, moisture levels between 0.1% and 1% show approximately the same
dissipation factor. At elevated temperature (90°C) they differ by a factor of 5 or more.
For proper diagnostics, the important property is the dissipation factor at elevated
temperature and not the dissipation factor at 20 °C.
Comments on power factor measurements between the test tap and the mounting
flange on OIP or RIP bushings: There are several reasons to not use this value as a
diagnostic tool.
x It should be pointed out that if the test voltage (500V if the test-tap insulation is
delivery tested with 2kV and 2.5 to 5 kV if the test tap is delivery tested with 20kV) is
exceeded, partial discharges may occur in the region of the test tap. This will affect
the measurement.
169
Taking all the variations mentioned above into account, the dissipation factor of the test
tap insulation can vary between 0.4-3.0 %.
3.2.12.3 TEMPERATURE
This measurement is based on the fact that under normal operating conditions, the
main tank of a transformer, because of the I2R and eddy current heating, will have a
higher temperature than the LTC compartment where there is essentially no heat
generation under non-switching conditions. Under steady state conditions, the
temperature difference between the two tanks will follow a known pattern. As the LTC
switch contacts age and wear, their resistance increases and hotspots develop under
normal loading conditions. The hotspots will increase the overall temperature of the
LTC tank, and the difference between it and the main tank temperature will begin to
deviate from the known pattern. The onset of severe contact wear can therefore be
estimated by using the temperature difference between the main tank and the LTC.
Most of the systems available on the market use magnetic clamp temperature sensors
and computer software to measure and track the temperature difference.
3.2.12.4 MOTOR CURRENT
Under normal operating conditions, the motor that drives the LTC gears and switching
contacts have a distinctive signature. Any significant deviations from this signature
may signal problems (gear or contact wear, binding, etc.) in the LTC mechanism. For
LTCs in which the switching mechanism is controlled by a spring, deviations of the
motor current from the normal signature can be used to diagnose looseness in the
tensioning of the spring.
3.2.12.5 ACOUSTIC SIGNAL
During the switching of the LTC, an acoustic signal is generated [84]. This signal can
be measured using a piezoelectric sensor. If there is a change in the gears or the
26
See section 1.7.1 for comments on OLTC (IEC designation) or LTC (IEEE designation)
170
switching contacts, the acoustic signature will be different from the normal case. To
perform this diagnosis, the measured acoustic signals are compared with a certain
number of past signals using a sophisticated software program. Such a system can
be applied online and can generate warning or alarm signals if certain values are
exceeded.
3.2.12.7.1.1 Scope
This section deals with the use of Dissolved Gas Analysis as condition indicator in
conventional On-Load Tap-Changers (OLTCs) that use mineral oil insulation. By
conventional OLTCs, we refer to OLTCs in which arc quenching takes place in the
mineral oil. The information in this section is therefore not valid for electronic OLTCs;
OLTCs with vacuum interrupters and OLTCs that use insulating liquids other than
mineral oil. It is mainly valid for OLTCs that have dehydrating breathers as interface
against to the atmosphere.
3.2.12.7.1.2 History
Historically, DGA of oil in OLTCs have been considered worthless because of the large
amount of gases normally generated by the arcs. This opinion has however, been
reconsidered in recent years and the understanding today is that quite a lot of
information can be gained from DGA of oils in OLTCs.
171
3.2.12.7.1.3 Faults in OLTCs possible to indicate by DGA
There are three basic faults in OLTCs that can be detected by DGA:
x Discharges and arcings
x Thermal faults
x Ageing of cellulose insulation
Discharges and unwanted arcs cannot be detected because these are produced
during normal operation of the OLTCs. Ageing of cellulose is of no importance in
OLTCs manufactured by ABB since cellulose insulation is not used in the designs.
Thermal faults are possible to detect. During normal switching, the arcs generate
acetylene and hydrogen. In addition, the three gases indicating thermal faults,
methane, ethane and ethane are also generated. The temperature in the center of the
arc is several thousands centigrade and the molecules are totally degraded. Upon
recombination, the resulting gases are mainly hydrogen and acetylene. However,
there is a temperature gradient from the plasma channel in the center of the arc to the
surrounding oil. This gradient is high enough to produce all the thermal fault gases but
in certain ratios to the hydrogen and acetylene produced.
This relation between the gases is fairly constant as long as the gases are generated
by the arcs alone. If there is another source of thermal fault gases, such as an
overheated contact, the relation will change and a fault can be detected in an early
stage before any severe failures occur.
172
x 5 - An overheating has occurred. The unit should be taken out of service and
be repaired as soon as possible. Contact the manufacturer for advice!
In the range 0.5 to 5, the recommended intervals for new samples are as follows:
x 0.5 to 1 - 3 to 6 months
x 1 to 3 - 1 to 3 months
x 3 to 5 - within one month.
As can be seen, the levels can vary very much. In case there are questions concerning
the gas concentrations, you are advised to consult the manufacturer. Typically, in order
for the manufacturer to provide proper advice about a unit, it is important for the user to
supply the following information:
x OLTC type designation (from the rating plate on the motor drive mechanism)
x Serial No. of the OLTC (from the rating plate on the motor drive mechanism)
x No. of operations since last oil replacement
x Rated load and average load since last oil replacement
x Type of breather on the conservator
x Daily load variations
173
x Daily oil temperature variations
x Faults, if any, that have occurred since last oil replacement
Several users have established threshold gas concentration values for various models
and configurations of LTCs. It is advisable that users develop their own set of threshold
values. However, in the absence of such data, there are generic threshold values that
can be used. Table 3-40 is a summary of normal gas levels from an IEC study of several
normal and failed units. Note, however, that this study gave no difference to the
breathing configuration or type of interrupting mechanism.
174
Table 3-41: 90% Values of Gas Concentration for Different Breathing Configurations [88]
Once any of the gases in a unit rises above the “normal” threshold limits, there are
several gas ratios that can be used to diagnose the specific problem. Analysis
performed by Jakob et All. [88] suggests that regardless of operational count, the ratios
of arcing gases to heating gases would remain the same in a problem-free LTC. As the
contact surface changes and becomes more resistive, there is a correspondingly
greater increase in the generation of heat gases than arcing gases. There is reason for
great concern if the concentration of heat gases is more than that of arcing gases in an
LTC. The two most useful ratios for diagnosing overheating problems in LTCs are the
Ethylene/Acetylene and the Ethylene/Ethane ratios. The calculated ratios for LTCs
under “normal” operation based on the data in Table 3-41 are given in Table 3-42.
Ethylene/Acetylene Ethylene/Ethane
LTC Configuration
Ratio Ratio
Free Breather 0.31 7.95
Free Breather
0.17 3.64
w/Desiccant
Sealed 0.36 7.51
Vacuum 1.17 0.62
3.2.12.8 MOISTURE
The insulation capability of the oil decreases with the water content. The water
content can be measured by a moisture sensor in an online monitoring system. Also,
the moisture content and oil breakdown values can be measured at the same time as
the gas-in-oil analysis.
175
3.3 ADVANCED DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS
3.3.1 ASSESSMENT OF MECHANICAL PROPERTIES - FREQUENCY RESPONSE ANALYSIS
(FRA) [89] [90]
3.3.1.1 PURPOSE OF THE MEASUREMENT
Frequency response analysis (FRA) is a non-destructive, advanced diagnostic tool used
to verify the satisfactory placement of the active part in a transformer (windings and
core), by comparison with reference data from the same unit or results from similar
units. The goal of FRA is to test if physical displacements in the active part of the
transformer have occurred with age or after a particular event (e.g. refurbishment,
repair, accident, transportation, through fault, quality check). FRA measurements may
provide indications of damage to the transformer, which can be investigated further
using other techniques or by an internal examination.
FRA measurements are currently under study by IEEE and CIGRE committees, and
recommendations or standards will be published in the near future.
It is recommended to do FRA measurements on new units before shipment from the
factory and after installation at the site, in order to establish a reference for future
comparisons.
There are basically two distinct ways of injecting the wide range of frequencies required:
either via an impulse into the winding (impulse response method) or via a frequency
sweep using a sinusoidal signal (frequency response method). The impulse response
method has evolved from an earlier test method known as low voltage impulse
measurement, or LVI. Due to conversion of the time response into the frequency
domain using the technique of Fast Fourier Transform (FFT) it is in principle equivalent
to the sweep frequency method. Both methods are currently used within the industry
[91].
The impulse response method offers the advantage of a shorter measurement time than
the frequency response method. The frequency response method on the other hand
offers the following advantages over the impulse response method:
176
x Better signal to noise ratio
x Equal, or near equal, accuracy across the whole measurement range
x Wide range of injected frequencies
HV Phase Bushing
Voltage Measurement Cable LV Phase Bushing
FRA Equipment
(Source and Receiver)
A typical measurement set-up is shown in Figure 3-49. A voltage signal is injected via a
signal coax cable at some transformer terminal, and measured at the same point with a
separate measurement coax cable. The transferred signal at some other terminal
(usually the other end of the same winding) is measured with a third coax cable. It is
advisable to choose coax cables all of the same length, in order to compensate for
phase lag and damping. All cable shields are connected to ground in the shortest
possible way, at both the transformer terminals and the measurement device. The input
impedance of the measurement device is typically chosen to equal the wave impedance
177
of the cables (e.g. 50 :), in order to minimize signal distortion due to reflections at the
cable ends.
The following test procedures must be followed in performing the FRA test:
x The tests should be performed with the transformer assembled and oil filled.
x The transformer should be disconnected from any power systems or supplies,
except for auxiliary supplies to tap changers, pumps, fans, etc.
x Core ground bushings should be connected to ground; they do not normally form
a part of the test process.
x All windings should be tested as shown in section 3.3.1.4.2, based on the
transformer type
x Tests on windings with tap changers are suggested to be measured in 2 tap
positions (the tap positions should be noted on the test report for each test):
o With the DETC (De-Energized Tap Changer) and LTC (Load Tap Changer),
if equipped in the neutral position.
o In the tap combination that places all sections of the windings in the circuit.
x In practice, it is important to measure the FRA using the same position in the tap
changer as the reference measurements. This will allow results from similar test
configurations to be compared during the analysis.
x For bushings not under test, including neutrals, two basic possibilities have been
employed. Neither one appears clearly superior to the other, but the measured
response spectra look considerably different:
o Disconnect all bushings not involved in the measurements and leave them in
open circuit (it is preferred for new units before shipment). Note that in this
case the bushing capacitances have considerable influence on the result, so
in order to achieve reproducibility one must perform this measurement either
always with or always without the bushings.
o Ground all the bushings not involved in the measurements with short
grounding cables to the reference ground. This is the preferred method for
on-site measurements since it ensures safety, provides linearity at low
injected power, and helps avoid antenna mode coupling.
178
x In the case of on-site measurements, only the second choice may be acceptable
for safety reasons, but in test-room conditions it may be advantageous to perform
both types of measurements since 1) they are complementary, and 2) the open-
circuit conditions are easier to reproduce.
x Test coaxial cable shields involved in the measurements must be grounded at
both ends (at the base of the test bushing flanges and at the BNC connection to
the test set).
x The test set ground should be directly connected to the transformer ground.
All tests must be performed by qualified test personnel who are familiar with the test
equipment and capable of basic interpretation of the test results. The test personnel
must be able to recognize valid and invalid results or have access to support.
The connection of the transformer defines the number and the type of FRA
measurements to be performed. It is possible to define four groups of transformer types:
x Single phase transformers (normal or auto transformers)
x Single phase transformers with tertiary (normal or auto transformers)
x Three phase transformers (normal or auto transformers)
x Three phase transformers with tertiary (normal or auto transformers)
Additionally, in the case of three phase transformers, the connection between windings
can be Wye (Y) or Delta (D), with or without a neutral.
All these connection possibilities each require a specific protocol of measurements. For
example, Figure 3-50 shows a list of measurements for a YNd connected transformer
under IEC nomenclature. As mentioned earlier, during each measurement the terminals
179
that are not involved in the test can be left either floating or grounded. It is essential to
use the same configuration as that of the reference measurement to which a particular
FRA result is to be compared.
For transformers designed and installed under the ANSI/IEEE standards, the following
test configurations are possible. As mentioned above, the tests can be performed with
the untested terminals open or short-circuited. Open circuit tests are performed on a
winding with all other connections floating and disconnected. NOTE: The only exception
to this is where a delta winding has one corner completed external to the tank. Short
circuit tests are performed on a HV winding by shorting together the LV connections, but
without grounding them. The neutral is not included in the shorting process.
180
Single Phase – Auto transformer
Open Circuit Tests Short Circuit Test
Other bushings float X1-N shorted together and floating
HV Winding LV Winding
Test 1 Test 2 Test 3
Single Phase H1-X1 X1-N H1-X1
Two-Winding Transformers
Open Circuit Tests Short Circuit Tests
All other bushings float x1-x2-x3 shorted together;
x0 floating
HV Windings LV Windings
Test 1 Test 2 Test 3 Test 4 Test 5 Test 6 Test 7 Test 8 Test 9
Delta-Wye H1-H3 H2-H1 H3-H2 X1-X0 X2-X0 X3-X0 H1-H3 H2-H1 H3-H2
Wye-Delta H1-H0 H2-H0 H3-H0 X1-X3 X2-X1 X3-X2 H1-H0 H2-H0 H3-H0
Delta-Delta H1-H3 H2-H1 H3-H2 X1-X3 X2-X1 X3-X2 H1-H3 H2-H1 H3-H2
Wye-Wye H1-H0 H2-H0 H3-H0 X1-X0 X2-X0 X3-X0 H1-H0 H2-H0 H3-H0
If the tertiary winding is brought out as three separate bushings (the corners of the
tertiary delta), then three separate tests may be performed. If only one corner of the
delta is brought out, as is the case for external completion of the delta winding, then
only one test may be performed.
181
Three-Winding Transformer – (Wye-Delta-Delta)
Wye- Open Circuit Tests – all other bushings floating
Delta- HV Windings LV Windings LV Windings
Delta Test 1 Test 2 Test 3 Test 4 Test 5 Test 6 Test 7 Test 8 Test 9
H1-H0 H2-H0 H3-H0 X3-X1 X2-X1 X3-X2 Y3-Y1 Y2-Y1 Y3-Y2
Short Circuit Tests
X1-X2-X3 all shorted together and Y1-Y2-Y3 all shorted together and
floating; other bushings float floating; other bushings float
Test 10 Test 11 Test 12 Test 13 Test 14 Test 15
H1-H3 H2-H1 H3-H2 H1-H3 H2-H1 H3-H2
182
Figure 3-51 shows various equipments that are used by transformer owners and
manufacturers to measure FRA.
M5300 FRAnalyzer
produced by produced by
Doble Omicron
FRAx-101
produced by Agilent (HP) –
Pax Network
Diagnostics analyzer
AB
Traftek
SofT produced produced by
by ABB B&C
Diagnostics
Framit
FRA-100 produced by
produced by Utility &
Phenix Industrial
Products, Inc.
FRA 5310
produced by
Haefely
183
3.3.1.5 REPORTING FRA MEASUREMENTS
Trace comparison is the usual method for the analysis of FRA results. Comparisons can
be made against baseline measurements or previous measurements of the same unit,
measurements from sister units, or measurements on other phases of other units.
Assuming the test equipment provides repeatable results, the initial expectation is that
any data comparison should result in near perfect overlays. Field experience from
qualified test personnel is an invaluable asset for interpretation.
Various levels of expected comparison exist. The level of expected comparison may be
categorized by the following:
184
3.3.1.7 OBSERVED SIGNAL DISTORTIONS DURING MEASUREMENTS
FRA measurements are subject to a variety of noise sources. It is therefore very
important to have a good and well explained measurement procedure in order to avoid
distortion in measurements produced by external factors.
Figure 3-52: FRA signal from 200 kHz to 2 MHz - Unshielded wire lengths:
A2 = 1 m, A4 = 2 m, A6 = 3 m, A8 = 4 m, A10 = 5 m
The unshielded-wire length effect is insignificant for frequencies lower than about
500 kHz. At higher frequencies, there is a noticeable variation.
Presumably it is the inductance of the loop formed by bushing and unshielded wire
which interacts with the winding resonances, so it is important to keep the area of this
loop small, by
x Keeping unshielded wires as short as possible, and
x Placing them as close to the bushings as possible.
185
Figure 3-53: FRA signal from 200 kHz to 2 MHz – Coaxial cable lengths:
B2 = 10 m, B6 = 30 m, B10 = 50 m, B12 = 70 m
The coaxial cable length effect is insignificant for frequencies lower than about 1.4 MHz.
At higher frequencies, longer coaxial cables introduce visible distortion. Therefore, it is
recommended to keep coaxial cables short, although the distortion in the
measurements introduced by this parameter is lower than the one introduced by
unshielded wire connections.
186
Figure 3-54: Transformer with Axial Collapse of Winding
Figure 3-55 shows a typical signature of a winding that has experienced axial collapse.
x The winding loses shape and gains a “bump” when seen on end.
x It results in a bent–but not broken–winding.
x Gassing may result.
x The transformer is likely to be able to continue service.
x Transformer integrity is compromised.
187
Figure 3-56: Close-up of Transformer with Hoop Buckling
Figure 3-57 shows typical FRA signatures of windings that have suffered hoop buckling.
188
Figure 3-57: FRA Signatures of Axial Collapse of Winding
Shorted turns in transformers are produced by turn-to-turn faults and may have the
following characteristics:
Figure 3-58 shows typical physical evidence of shorted turns in a transformer winding.
189
Figure 3-58: Shorted Winding Turns
Figure 3-59 shows traces from the same transformer before and after a fault that
resulted in shorted winding turns.
190
3.3.2 ASSESSMENT OF THERMAL PROPERTIES
3.3.2.1 DEGREE OF POLYMERIZATION (DP) [92]
Cellulose materials, such as paper and pressboard, form the major part of power
transformer insulation. The chemical structure of the cellulose polymer is shown in
Figure 3-60. The molecular formula may be written as (C6H10O5)n, where C6H10O5 is the
monomer unit and n is the number of monomers in the polymer chain. n is also known
as the degree of polymerization (DP or DPv).
The complete fine structure of the cellulose fiber consists of fibrils, micro-fibrils and
chains. The polymer chain is the ultimate fine structure of the cellulose fiber. The DP is
measured by viscosity measurements according to ASTM method D4243 after
dissolving the fibers in cupriethylene diamine solvent. Only the chains remain intact
when the fiber is dissolved. The average of several viscosity measurements gives the
DP value (the approximate number of chains remaining in the solution). Solutions of the
cellulose chains in the solvent increase the viscosity, depending on the size (molecular
weight) of the chains.
Unprocessed virgin Kraft paper has DP in the range of 1,000-1,400; after drying and oil
impregnation the DP drops to approximately 900-1,100. As the insulation ages, the DP
drops to lower values with time. When it reaches a value of 200, the tensile strength
usually drops to about 20% of its original value and is generally considered at the end of
life. However, if the transformer does not experience short circuit forces and other types
of vibration, it may continue to function until the cellulose becomes carbonized and
brittle, at DP values of 100-150. Unprocessed wood fibers may have DPs as high as
1,500.
[93] provides an expression for the expected life of cellulose insulation to that follows
the equation:
191
1 1
-
DPEnd DPStart
Expected Life( yrs) . exp 13350
A u 24 u 365 T + 273
Where: DPEnd and DPStart are respectively, the DP value of the paper at the end and
start of the life of the insulation; T is the temperature of winding in contact with the
insulation in degrees Celsius, and A is a factor that depends on the type of insulation
and the conditions of operation the insulation is under. The value of the A factor is
influenced by moisture in the insulation, acidity of the oil, and oxygen concentration in
the oil. Recent research performed at SINTEF Energy Research in Norway [94] has
shown that the values of A, which affects the ageing rate of the insulation, is quite
different for thermally upgraded insulation (Insuldur) than for non-upgraded Kraft paper.
A sample of the values they report for various conditions is replicated in Table 3-43.
These values assume activation energy of 111 kJ/mol.
If it is assumed that the DP of transformer insulation is 1,000 at the start of life and 200
at the end of life, the expected life under the conditions specified in Table 3-43 can be
calculated using the life expectancy equation above. Figure 3-61 shows the life
expectancies of Kraft paper, and Figure 3-62 shows the life expectancies of thermally
upgraded paper.
192
10000.0
10.0
1.0
0.1
50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150
Temperature [o C]
10000.0
Dry & Clean (Insuldur)
Acidic Oil (Insuldur)
1000.0 1% Water Content (Insuldur)
3-4% Water Content (Insuldur)
Life Expectancy (years)
100.0
10.0
1.0
0.1
50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150
Temperature [o C]
193
3.3.2.1.2 Latest Research Findings on DP Analysis
The following is a summary of the latest findings on DP analysis for power transformer
diagnostics:
x Most researches and transformer insulation experts suggest DP at the end of life
in the range 100-200, with most favoring a value of 200 [95].
x Pahlavanpour [96] presents results that show that the DP of Kraft paper starts
decreasing at 120°C. The rate of decrease of DP increases rapidly with
increasing temperature and reaches end of life at 180°C.
x Hill [97] found a nonlinear relationship between tensile strength and DP. They
found the tensile strength of Kraft paper decreases slowly with decreasing DP
until the DP reaches a critical value of 500. At this point, the decrease in tensile
strength is more rapid with decreasing DP.
x Lundgaard [94] found that the ageing of Insuldur paper is slower by a factor of
about three and is less sensitive to moisture; the activation energy for the ageing
of Insuldur paper is the same as that of Kraft paper; the ageing of Insuldur does
not produce as much furfural (furans) as Kraft paper; the effect of water on
ageing of transformers is more dramatic than oxygen; ageing of oil also
increases the acidity of the oil; Insuldur paper produces more acids than Kraft
paper.
x Moser [98] reports that an increase of 0.5 % water content in an ageing
transformer will reduce the value of DP by one-half.
194
according to Burton and others who published the original research on furanic analysis
in 1984 [99] (see Figure 3-63).
195
Where: DP is the estimated DP value and F is the 2-furfural (or furan) content in ppm. A
graphical representation of these equations is given in Figure 3-64.
1000
Estimated DP Value
Chendong - Kraft/Upgraded
DePablo - Kraft
Pahlavanpour - Kraft
Shkolnik - Upgraded
100
0.01 0.1 1 10 100
Furfural Content (ppm or mg/liter of oil)
The latest research on this topic as mentioned in section 3.3.2.1.2 suggests that the
ageing of thermally upgraded Insuldur paper does not produce as much furans as Kraft
paper. Other findings [109, 110] are that the most significant production of furans occurs
below a DP value of 400. It is known that the Shkolnik curve was derived from data
collected on transformers with predominantly thermally upgraded insulation and is in
agreement with recent research findings. Since the Pahlavanpour and DePablo curves
were derived from European transformers, it is highly likely to be for predominantly Kraft
insulated transformers and the recent research discussion bears this out. The
Pahlavanpour curve is derived from the same data as the DePablo curve, but assumes
a more realistic ageing pattern for transformers: 20% of the winding paper and the inner
paper layers degrade twice as fast as the rest of the paper insulation. The
Chendong curve is suspected to be derived from transformers with mixtures of Kraft and
thermally upgraded insulation [111].
Use the curve in Figure 3-64 that is closest to the insulation type for the transformer
under consideration to estimate the DP value. Once an estimate of DP has been
obtained, the equation and conditions outlined in section 3.3.2.1.1 can be used to
estimate the remaining life of the insulation.
196
1. Long-term stability of furanic compounds in oil: If these compounds are not
stable in oil for long periods, we should at least know the rate of degradation. If
we know the rate of generation from lab studies, we could perhaps adjust for
the losses and estimate the absolute furanic content.
2. Distribution of furanic compounds between paper and oil: The furanic content
of oil is related to the furanic content of the paper insulation. The latter is
dependent on the paper to oil ratio and the temperature. The distribution
between paper and oil should be known over a wide range of ratios and
temperatures (just as moisture distribution between paper and oil).
3. When the oil in a transformer is changed (as in a reprocessing operation),
most of the furanic compounds are lost. This is similar to dissolved gases
being lost during oil change. It may, therefore, be necessary to maintain
accurate records of prior analysis.
4. Correlation curves for different types of paper and pressboard materials would
be needed to make meaningful correlation to DP from furanic estimations.
5. Thermally upgraded paper and non-upgraded paper give significantly different
results because of the chemicals used in thermally upgraded papers. Make
sure you are using the proper correlation curves for your transformers.
3.3.2.3.1 Introduction
The insulation power factor (or dissipation factor, tanδ27) measured at power frequency
is the most commonly used electrical test in North America and elsewhere for routine
evaluation of the insulation system of large power transformers and bushings. Typically,
defects in the insulation show up as either high or “unusual” power factor values [112].
While the test provides an important benefit to identify when a problem exists in the
transformer insulation, it is often difficult to determine the exact cause of the high or
unusual power factor reading. Often, the utility owners of the transformers will opt to just
process the transformer to remove moisture in an attempt to correct the power factor
results. This expensive process often works if the power factor problem is attributable to
moisture. However there are many instances when the underlying cause of the high
power factor remains unknown.
27
power factor (PF) is essentially equivalent to dissipation factor (DF) for the range of values under considerations
in transformer diagnostics. i.e. PF = DF (1 + DF )
2
197
3.3.2.3.2 Dielectric frequency response and X-Y model
The dielectric frequency response test (DFR) has been recently developed as a
diagnostic tool for transformer insulation system testing. The DFR measurement is
similar to the power factor or tan G measurement, except that it is a series of power
factor measurements at multiple frequencies. The advantage of doing the measurement
at multiple frequencies is that it provides much more information which makes it
possible to distinguish properties of both the cellulose and oil insulation separately.
Since the effect of moisture and ionic contamination on the dielectric properties of the
insulation system is more pronounced at low frequencies, the preferred measurement
frequency range is 1,000-0.001 Hz. The dielectric properties evaluated are the real and
imaginary capacitances (or permittivities) and the dissipation factor. Figure 3-65 shows
an example of a dielectric frequency measurement showing the complex permittivity
with the 50 Hz values marked.
The DFR measurement is similar to the power factor or tan G measurement, except that
it is a series of power factor measurements at multiple frequencies. The advantage of
doing the measurement at multiple frequencies is that it provides much more
information so that the dielectric parameters of the insulation may be determined. Since
the effect of moisture and ionic contamination on the dielectric properties of the
insulation system is more pronounced at low frequencies, the preferred measurement
frequency range is 1,000-0.001 Hz. The dielectric properties evaluated are the real and
imaginary capacitances (or permittivities) and the tangent delta (dissipation factor),
which is essentially equivalent to the power factor for the range of values under
consideration.
50 Hz
Figure 3-65: Example of dielectric frequency response measurement showing the complex
permittivity.
198
The DFR measurement is performed with an instrument capable of measuring the
complex impedance of the transformer winding insulation. One such device is shown in
Figure 3-66. A variable frequency voltage is applied to the object, and the complex
calculations are performed by digitizing and processing voltage and current signals. The
normal complement of measurements is possible, including winding capacitance to
ground with and without guard and the ungrounded specimen test. See section 3.2.7 for
coupling details.
Figure 3-66: IDA200 Dielectric Response Measurement System (Courtesy of General Electric)
Knowledge of the transformer designs is helpful in identifying the test setup and
connections. This information is also needed later for the analysis of the DFR results to
determine the dielectric properties of the insulation, including moisture content.
The analysis of the DFR measurement involves modeling the transformer insulation
materials and structure as measured [113]. Obviously the insulation structure is quite
different for different types or designs of transformers. The detailed information required
for this model is obtained from manufacturing drawings of the transformer insulation
system. For modeling purposes the complex geometry is represented by a simplified
equivalent structure, the X-Y model, Figure 3-67. The relative barrier content, X,
represents the solid insulation in series with the oil in the main insulation. The relative
spacer coverage, Y, represents the relative amount of the circumference that is covered
by the spacers. Typical values for X and Y are 10 – 40 %. In the absence of design
data, representative values for these parameters can be suggested by rough estimates,
typical values are for example X=Y=20 %.
199
Spacer y
Barrier
Oil 1-y
x 1-x
In the modeling the oil is characterized by its DC conductivity and power frequency
permittivity. The dielectric properties of the cellulose are characterized by DC
conductivity, power frequency permittivity, and dielectric response function. ABB has
compiled a database of such dielectric properties for oil-impregnated cellulose at
various moisture contents and temperatures. This database is merged into an analysis
tool developed by ABB that models the insulation geometry and the insulating materials
(oil, paper, pressboard, etc.) of the transformer.
In the modeling procedure, the design information and test data as described above are
input into the algorithm that calculates the response of the composite system. The
moisture in cellulose and oil conductivity values could then be optimized for a best fit of
the calculated response curve to the measured DFR data. In particular the influence of
the oil and the solid insulation on the dielectric response could be separated from each
other. Figure 3-68 shows an example of the ABB analysis tool. The red markers are
measured complex capacitance of a new dry transformer; the green markers measured
complex capacitance of an old wet transformer; and the solid line is a model fitted to the
old wet transformer measurement. The model provides an estimate of the moisture
content of the cellulose and the oil conductivity.
ABB has used these tools for the past several years for analysis of transformers both in
the factory and in the field. The experience gained from the tests and analyses have
shown the potential of the DFR test for identifying not only moisture problems, but also
other defects in the transformer insulation structure.
200
Model
Old Transf.
New Transformer
Figure 3-68: ABB analysis tool for DFR measurements on transformers. Measurements of New dry
transformer (red markers), Old wet transformer (green markers) and Model (lines) fitted to old
transformer estimating moisture content of cellulose and oil conductivity.
In the sections that follow a description of the use of DFR measurement to diagnose
each of these conditions is presented.
201
3.3.2.4.1.1 Influence of Oil Conductivity and Moisture on PF and DFR
The conductivity of mineral oil in a transformer can be affected by several factors such
as moisture, temperature, contamination, etc. The conductivity is directly related to the
dissipation factor of the oil and thus to the dielectric losses of the transformer. The
dielectric properties of cellulose insulation are also affected by moisture in the
insulation [114]. As a result, one cannot differentiate between the influence of moisture
and oil conductivity for the power factor measurement. This is demonstrated by the
following example. Figure 3-69 shows a typical 60 Hz power factor measurement result
for a single phase shell form transformer. Along with the power factor measurement is a
plot of the calculated DFR for the transformer assuming two different scenarios: one
with low moisture and aged oil and one with higher moisture and new oil.
As can be seen in Figure 3-69, it is not really possible to predict the moisture in the
insulation or the oil characteristic from the power factor test. In fact, it is entirely possible
to misinterpret a power factor reading as indicating high moisture when in fact it may
really be due to bad oil conductivity.
The DFR test on the other hand gives information to predict both the oil conductivity and
the moisture content in the cellulose insulation. Figure 3-70 shows the same information
as Figure 3-69, only the DFR test result is added. As can be seen from this data, the
actual transformer characteristic is 0.7 % moisture and an oil conductivity that is only
slightly aged.
1.000
PF =. 00324
0.010
0.001 1 1 8 3 5
Figure 3-69: Comparison of Power Factor Measurement to Two Different DFR Possibilities
202
1.000
Tan D
Measured DR
0.010
0.001 1 1 8 3 5
Figure 3-70: Comparison of Power Factor and DFR Measurement to Two Different DFR
Possibilities
HV XV
CORE
HV Bushing XV Bushing
Figure 3-71: Simplified Insulation Circuit Diagram for a Typical Two-Winding Transformer
203
The first step in the identification process is to identify the particular insulation section
that is responsible for the high or unusual power factor result. This is accomplished by
making various measurements of the circuit including node-to-ground and node-to-node
with other nodes either grounded or guarded (these correspond to the UST and GST
tests of the traditional power factor measurements). In many transformers it is possible
to guard out the core or the bushings in order to sectionalize and isolate the various
insulation paths. The DFR test is then performed on this isolated part of the insulation
system and the resulting response curve is analyzed by the calculation method
described earlier. From this analysis, a DFRS is generated that is used in the defect
identification process.
The identification of the defect or the cause of high power factor is accomplished by
comparing the DFRS to other DFRS functions from transformers with known defects or
to results from laboratory tests. This comparison involves both the section of the
insulation structure tested and the shape of the DFRS. The insulation section under
evaluation depends on the type of test performed (for example, a test between the HV
winding and ground with the LV winding guarded would address one insulation section).
This is important since the shape of a DFRS varies depending on the particular
insulation section involved. The comparison of the shape of the DFRS involves a
comparison in magnitude and frequency of two DFRS functions, one from the unknown
specimen, and the other from the library of DFRS functions for known defects or causes
of high power factor. By matching the insulation section and the shape of the DFRS
functions, the potential defects or the causes of the high power factor can be identified.
204
Normal Core Ground
Figure 3-72: DFRS Functions for a Normal and a High Value of Core Grounding Resistance
This data came from measurements on a core form transformer when a resistor was
added in series with the core grounding strap. As can be seen from Figure 3-72, the
effect of a higher than normal core grounding resistance manifests itself as an increase
in DFRS at higher frequencies, but with no effect at lower frequencies. For the case
shown in Figure 3-72, the effect is also clearly detectable at power frequency. This
shows that a high core grounding resistance affects the power factor results at power
frequencies.
Figure 3-73 and Figure 3-74 show results where the DFRS method was used to
diagnose high core grounding resistance in cases where the transformer power factor
results were abnormally high. During a standard power factor test in the field,
Transformer 1 (shown in Figure 3-73) showed normal results, and Transformer 2
showed elevated power factor results above 0.5%.
The DFR test was performed to aid in the determination of the cause of the higher
power factor. The diagnostic interpretation of the DFRS functions for the two shell form
transformers is that the core-to-ground resistance is higher than normal for Transformer
2. This high core-to-ground resistance condition was later verified and corrected.
Figure 3-74 shows the results of a test on a core-form transformer that exhibited high
(above 0.5 %) power factor results. The dielectric frequency response test was used to
205
isolate the section of the insulation that was causing the high power factor. The DFRS
function was then used to identify the cause. The insulation section was identified as the
low voltage to ground insulation and the analysis of the DFRS comparison identified the
cause as a high core-to-ground resistance. Upon inspection of the transformer, the high
core-to-ground resistance was traced to an auxiliary transformer used in a load tap
changer.
Figure 3-74 also shows the same DFRS function for the transformer after the auxiliary
transformer was modified to reduce the core-to-ground resistance. The DFRS function
measured after the repair is similar to the shape for a normal transformer core ground
as shown in Figure 3-72.
XV to Ground
Figure 3-74: DFRS Function caused by a High Core to Ground Resistance in Auxiliary Transformer
Normal Moisture
High Moisture
206
3.3.2.5.2 Identification of Paper Contamination Problems
Paper contamination in transformers is a rare occurrence. Nonetheless, it is of great
advantage to be able to recognize and differentiate between contamination and other
causes of high power factor. As with other types of transformer defects, this requires
experience from testing insulation systems, which happen to have this problem. With
limited experience in actual cases, it is not known if a single DFRS shape can be used
to identify all types of contamination. It is possible that different types of contamination
in different insulation sections will have different DFRS profiles.
Figure 3-76 shows a DFRS for a transformer where the high power factor was caused by
a chemical contamination of the windings. Although the profile is similar to that of the
high resistance core ground, the insulation section exhibiting the defect was different. In
addition, the frequency of the peak was lower than any of the core ground resistance
cases. This case opens an avenue for further study of contamination recognition using
the DFRS method.
207
Table 3-44: Comparison of Factory and Field Power Factor Results (Corrected to 20°C)
Figure 3-77: DFRS Functions for Both Factory and Field Measurements on a Shell Form
Transformer
To further investigate the difference between the temperature correction factors used in
the industry, and the actual variation of power factor with temperature for this
transformer, a curve was developed using the DFR software. Figure 3-78 shows a
comparison of the calculated temperature correction to the commonly used correction
factors. From this curve, we can easily see why the power factor test results reported
were so different between the factory with an oil temperature of 33.5 °C and the field
with an oil temperature of 9 °C. It should be noted that this shell form transformer has
an unusually high ratio of paper-to-oil in the high-to-low space where the measurement
was made. It is not known at this point if this contributed to the exaggerated difference
between the actual variation in power factor vs. temperature and the Doble or ANSI
correction factor curves.
2.4
2.2 ANSI Factors
2 Doble 230kV up
1.8 Case 3 Transformer
1.6
TCF
1.4
1.2
1
0.8
0.6
-5 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
Temperature,°C
Figure 3-78: Comparison of Calculated Temperature Correction Factor for Shell Form Transformer
to Commonly Correction Factors in the Industry
208
3.3.2.6 SUMMARY
This section demonstrates the usefulness of the dielectric frequency response signature
(DFRS) for identifying various causes of high insulation power factor, such as moisture
in cellulose, high resistance in the magnetic core steel circuit, and chemical
contamination. The method is suitable for troubleshooting power factor problems in the
factory or the field. In addition, it is important to emphasize that the dielectric response
test is used to estimate the dielectric properties of transformer insulation, such as the
average volume moisture [%] in solid insulation and the power factor of the oil. The DFR
method has been found to be more accurate than existing industrial methods, for
example, dew point test and moisture/oil equilibrium method. These methods
predominantly estimate the surface moisture of the insulation.
Using the derived DFRS method to diagnose the cause of high power factor will focus
maintenance resources in the proper direction and prevent costly drying or over-drying
of transformer insulation when moisture is not the issue.
It is clear that there could be problems in applying the Doble or ANSI temperature
correction factors for power factor for all transformers. As demonstrated in the one case
described above, the use of one of these factors can lead to erroneous conclusions
regarding the insulation condition. It is ABB’s opinion to not use any correction factor
unless a reliable calculated factor is used that is based on the actual properties of the
transformers insulation system. Further investigation is needed to determine a better
method for correcting power factor results that is applicable to different transformers.
209
3.3.3 ASSESSMENT OF ELECTRICAL PROPERTIES - PARTIAL DISCHARGE MEASUREMENTS
[115]
3.3.3.1 PURPOSE OF MEASUREMENT
A partial discharge measurement (PD-measurement) is a non-destructive tool used to
establish the condition of a transformer insulation system. A PD-measurement makes it
possible to detect and localize areas within the transformer that are exposed to elevated
dielectric stresses. Partial discharge measurements are explicitly specified in standards
or in customer specifications. They are to be carried out in conjunction with dielectric
tests in high-voltage laboratories using AC-voltage in the power frequency range. For
onsite PD measurements (for example on repaired transformers) other types of PD-free
excitation may be required. Partial discharge measurement should generally be the last
dielectric test conducted on the transformer.
210
Where:
BU = bushing
HV = high voltage
NT = neutral terminal
C1, 2, 3 = active part of transformer (including oil)
C1 = weak region
C2’ and C3’ = test object capacitance
If the two line terminals are connected together via an external capacitor Ck, the charge
movements within the series-connected insulation links (capacitances C2’ and C3’) will
also be reflected in the charge of the external capacitor, Ck. The charge movements can
be detected as circulating current impulses i(t) in the parallel-connected capacitors Ck
and the test object.
According to IEC, which is the preferred method for these tests, PD measurements are
conducted by measuring the “apparent charge,” q. In this context, the apparent charge
is obtained by integrating the PD current impulse using a “wideband” or “narrowband”
filter. The PD measuring system is connected via a coaxial cable to the measuring
impedance Zm (see Figure 3-80). The apparent charge q, measured in Picocoulombs
(pC), corresponds to the charge transferred during the ∆V voltage drop compensation
process at one of the parallel-connected capacitances Ct (transformer insulation) and
bushing capacitance C1 or coupling capacitance Ck. This voltage drop ∆V may be
caused either in the test object (internal partial discharge in the bushing or in the
transformer insulating system) or in the test circuit (external partial discharge). If PD
activity is detected during the test, the PD source must be investigated.
211
Figure 3-80: PD Calibration and Measurement Setup for Transformers; Bushings with Capacitive
Taps
3.3.3.2.1 Calibration
Calibration of the PD test circuit is performed using a battery-operated calibrator. A
calibrator consists of a square-wave generator with adjustable amplitude Vo connected
in series with a small capacitor C0, which should be less than 10 % of C1. For PD
measurements on transformers, the calibrator is connected across the bushing, or
across the coupling capacitor connected in parallel with the bushing (see Figure 3-80).
Calibration must be performed separately for each bushing. Under the assumption that
C0 << Ck, the injected impulse from the square-wave generator corresponds to the
charge q, which is set to predefined values (100 pC, 1,000 pC, etc.) by the adjusting the
amplitude Vo. IEC 60270 recommends that the rise time of the injected impulse should
be less or equal to 60 ns, amplitude V0 between 2 V and 50 V, selectable polarity, and a
repetition rate of 100 Hz. Based on this, the injected charge is calculated as:
q0 = V0 × C0
The measuring circuit, consisting of the capacitance Ct of the test object, coupling
capacitor Ck, measuring impedance Zm, coaxial cable, and measuring system, is now
calibrated. During the PD test the measuring system values are read directly in pC. This
pC reading is only valid for the specific calibrated bushing.
212
3.3.3.2.2 PD measuring procedure
According to the IEC Standards [116], PD measurements shall be carried out in
conjunction with induced voltage test. Any wide bandpass filter or narrow bandpass filter
can be used as a PD measuring system. The first PD measurement should be made at
a low test voltage level (approx. 10 % rated voltage). This value serves as a reference
for the background noise level in measurement system. According to the lEC
Standards, the background noise level must be lower than half of the required pC value
of apparent charge for the specific transformer. PD activity must be checked at all HV
bushings on the transformer. The best way to accomplish this is to apply a multi-
channel PD measuring system capable of detecting PD activity at all bushings
simultaneously. A description of such a system (ICMsystem) used by some ABB HV
laboratories is given below.
213
Figure 3-81: Advanced PD System, ICMsystem [118]
PD patterns identify a specific type of PD source (image of the physical process, see
Table 3-45 and Table 3-46).
x PD patterns are not influenced by the signal transfer function of the extended
insulating system (statistical behavior does not change).
x PD patterns can be used to distinguish between superimposed PD defects on the
basis of different statistical behavior.
214
Figure 3-82: Registration of PD Impulses in Advanced PD System (Statistical Analysis of PD
Impulses)
The first step is to exclude all possible external PD sources. Typical external PD
sources are:
Low-Voltage Power Supply: Noise such as thyrister pulses or harmonics from the low-
voltage power supply may especially influence a sensitive PD system, which is directly
connected to the power line. If these are present, a low-pass filter or insulating
transformer should be used. Due to the filtering effect of the step-up transformer of the
high-voltage source and of the HV filter in the PD system connection to the test object,
the noise from the low-voltage power line is usually sufficiently suppressed. If there is a
noise problem, a second step-up transformer may be used as an additional filter or a
PD system with a narrow-band filter could be used (f0> 1 MHz).
High-Voltage Source: An HV source must generally be PD free. If there is a problem,
the coupling capacitor can be connected directly to the source (without the test object)
to easily check the HV source.
High-Voltage Filter: In difficult cases (for example, a station with a lot of
electromagnetic interference), a PD-free, low-pass HV filter must sometimes be used.
Connections in the Test Circuit and Electrodes: All bushing tops (even grounded
bushings) and sharp metallic parts on top of the transformer (especially close to the
bushings) should be shielded. All connections should be PD free, i.e. with sufficient
radius). In addition, the bushing surface must be free of conducting particles. All
measuring impedances Zm, must have a good connection to ground. If there is a
problem, an ultrasonic detector (corona gun) may be used to detect an external PD
215
source. The PD type can be determined from the statistical analysis of the PD signals
(typical PD-pattern, see Table 3-45).
Coupling Capacitor: The coupling capacitor must be PD free. If there is a problem, the
coupling capacitor must be measured separately.
Conductive Objects Close to the Transformer under Test: Ungrounded conductive
objects close to the transformer under test could become charged to a high potential
due to the electric field. If the breakdown field value is reached, a pulse-like discharge
may occur. These PD impulses may be coupled to the PD test circuit and detected at
the measuring impedances and produce very high apparent charge amplitude. This PD
source can be recognized by comparing it with typical PD patterns, by visual
observation of the surroundings or by using an ultrasonic detector.
Once all external sources have been eliminated and there is still partial discharge
activity, the process begins of identifying the type and possible location. In reality, the
five typical PD patterns appear in many variations. Because of the charging and
discharging effect at the PD site, there is continuous change of both the surrounding
216
area of the PD source and the PD source itself. Consequently, there are only a few PD
patterns that exhibit constant behavior during the test.
During an analysis, the basic PD pattern characteristics that should be analyzed are:
Interpretation and screening of the correct type of PD pattern from the real PD pattern
results requires experience and a strong interpolation capability. If PD defects are
superimposed, a comparison with the typical types of PD patterns and finding the
correct type of PD pattern becomes much more difficult. An overview of the typical PD
sources in the transformer insulating system together with their typical PD pattern and
their typical behavior during the test is presented in Table 3-46 . If there is a clear
indication of internal PD activity in the transformer insulating system, localization of the
PD source must follow. Localization of PD sources is more effectively done using
ultrasonic techniques as described in the next section.
217
Table 3-46: Typical PD Defect Patterns in Power Transformer Insulation
218
Typical PD Defects in the Transformer Insulation Conducting Material = PD Pattern Type 2
219
Typical Defects in Transformer Insulation Bubbles = PD Pattern Types 3 and 4
Where:
ǻW1 = locally released energy
q1 = local charge
ǻV1 = local voltage drop
Acoustic wave propagation occurs only if the wavelength λ of the generated wave is
small compared with the length of the propagation path. In a specific medium the
wavelength is given by:
220
λ=v/f
Where:
λ = wavelength
Ȟ = sound velocity in a specific medium (1400 m/s in oil)
f = frequency of mechanical vibration (acoustic wave)
Oil by itself is a perfect medium for the propagation of acoustic waves, with no
attenuation or dispersion occurring. However, in transformers, acoustic wave
propagation is heavily influenced by the complicated structure of the insulating system
(winding barriers, core, and tank walls). The amplitude is affected due to signal
attenuation and the signal shape is affected due to absorption and dispersion by the
different media in the path of the acoustic signal emitted by the PD source.
Besides the absorption and dispersion phenomena, the multitude of wave types
complicates the analysis of acoustic PD signals detected in a multi-material structure.
Two types of waves must generally be considered for the analysis of acoustic signals:
The velocities of sound for the two wave types for different materials found in
transformers are given in Table 3-47.
The two waves take different propagation paths from the source to the walls of the tank.
An acoustic sensor positioned at a defined location on the tank wall detects both directly
propagated waves and wall-propagated waves. As shown in Table 3-47, the two wave
types have different propagation velocities.
In order to localize the PD sources by analyzing the time difference between the electric
and acoustic PD signals, there must be a possibility to distinguish between directly
221
propagated and wall-propagated waves. This information is theoretically hidden in the
wave front of the acoustic signal that is detected at the sensor on the tank wall. Special
processing software is used to analyze these signals.
A minimum of three acoustic sensors (piezoelectric transducers, such as the one shown
in Figure 3-83) and at least a four-channel digital oscilloscope or signal recorder are
required to localize PD sources using the time difference between electric and acoustic
signals. An advanced detection system previously manufactured by ABB uses three
transducers arranged geometrically as shown in Figure 3-84. The three transducers are
placed close to one another in an equilateral triangle with L = 0.15 m so that the
propagation path of the acoustic waves from the PD source is nearly the same. The
system defines its own x, y, and z coordinate system. The normalized coordinates (x, y,
z) give the direction to the source and depend only on time differences in the detection
system. It is assumed that the distance between the transducers L is considerably less
than the distance of the acoustic sensors to the PD source.
222
Figure 3-84: Geometric Layout of ABB Three Transducer (TTD) Acoustic Detection System
A typical result obtained by the acoustic-system is shown in Figure 3-85. Due to the
different paths of electric and acoustic PD signals through the insulating system of the
transformer, there is no simple relationship between the amplitude of apparent charge
and the amplitude of acoustic waves. Knowledge of the transformer insulating system
and experience in the analysis of the results are needed to localize PD sources by
analyzing acoustic PD signals.
223
4 ONLINE DIAGNOSTIC MONITORS FOR TRANSFORMERS
AND KEY ACCESSORIES
Power transformers and their accessories at critical nodes in electricity networks and
industries are subjected to heavy stresses during their lifetime. Load peaks –
predictable as well as unexpected – generate high temperatures which shorten
component lifetime. In the worst case, sudden failure can occur, causing havoc in the
network or losses of production. It is because of this risk, and the penalties that can
attach to it, that utilities give such a high priority to controlling and monitoring the status
and condition of their transformers [119]. It has also become clear that periodic
sampling of key condition indicators is ineffective at capturing the onset of some serious
problems in transformers. This is where the application of online monitors comes in. By
constantly measuring and accessing the appropriate parameters, these devices allow
asset managers to intervene before failure, malfunction or reduction of lifetime can
occur. Increasingly, for many utilities and industries, the watchword is ‘early detection of
failure conditions.’ In this section, we provide a discussion of some of the key
parameters that are useful to monitor on transformers and other key accessories.
224
It should be noted that although online monitoring of partial discharges (PD) on power
transformers is offered by a handful of vendors, it is still an evolving technology. The
difficulties include the ability to eliminate interferences and consistent interpretation of
the results. Due to the relative high costs PD monitoring is usually required only on
“problem transformers”.
Cooling control systems that integrate current and temperature monitoring may be a low
cost solution for power transformer retrofit. Hotspot temperature, remaining insulation
life and dynamic ratings can all be estimated from the current, temperature and
transformer design data [122,123,124].
225
Table 4-3 Bushing & CT Monitoring Needs [121]
Natural Outcome if Left Signals Used for Online
Natural Aging Process Factors that Accelerate Aging
Unchecked Monitoring
Rapid temperature swings or
extreme environmental Crazing allowing dirt build-up
conditions, conductive oil by- and water ingress with Changes in tan G ҏand
Damage to porcelain. reduction of insulation leakage current.
products built up on porcelain
inside walls, and oil leak leading properties.
to paper drying out and cracking.
Localized partial discharge
Partial discharge RF
promoting further paper (and
Core paper deterioration. Elevated operating temps. currents and changes in
oil) deterioration (possible
tan δ and leakage current.
runaway condition).
Localized partial discharge
Partial discharge RF
Similar mechanism as within promoting further oil (and currents and changes in
Oil deterioration. paper) deterioration (runaway
transformers. tan G and leakage current.
condition).
Design/manufacturing defects, Higher capacitance leading to Increase in bushing C1
Short circuits between foil layers.
paper/oil aging, and conductive increased capacitive current. (and possibly C2)
ink migration. capacitance.
Localized insulation damage
Partial discharge (corona) with formation of carbon Partial discharge RF
Small voids within insulation currents and changes in
caused by tiny flashovers inside and/or shorts between foil
system. tan G and leakage current.
voids in insulation. layers.
Frequent thermal cycling
results in excessive seal
Differing coefficient of expansion wear, in turn leading to oil Usually will show up as an
of bushing components and leak and/or water ingress. increase in tan G and/or
Large temperature variations. partial discharge RF
rapid cooling can create bubbles Also end paper damage &
in oil. currents.
possible corrosion in tap
chamber.
A limitation of many transformer monitoring systems is that they are not able to control
or make decisions and recommendations based on the available data, forcing engineers
to spend a great deal of time sorting and interpreting the information they receive.
ABB’s Transformer Electronic Control (TEC) monitoring system [119], offered for new
transformers, addresses this issue. To achieve the goal of making power transformers
“intelligent” and maintenance-free, ABB created and integrated a common electronic
interface to exchange information with the following apparatus:
TEC receives all the information it needs for transformer control from these sensors;
other necessary parameters are calculated. Through this interface, TEC provides exact
status information to enable utilities to extend transformer lifetime and save costs by
226
reducing maintenance and increasing availability. It does this by generating a model of
the transformer and its working condition and then comparing the measured parameters
with the simulated values. Discrepancies are detected and potential malfunctions and/or
normal wear in the transformer and its ancillaries are indicated.
For retrofit applications, ABB also proposes the T-Monitor, described in Table 4-4. In
addition to the standard data acquisition of various sensors and built-in models, an
implemented prognosis /diagnosis tool helps the operator in taking the right decisions.
With a remote control access option ABB can support the operator for troubleshooting.
Table 4-4 provides general descriptions of some of the systems available on the market
for monitoring various parameters and accessories on transformers. Note that this is
only a small sample of the various devices and systems that are available from a
multitude of suppliers.
227
Table 4-4: Examples of Typical Monitoring Systems for Transformers
Monitoring
Sample Pictures General Description
Systems/Devices
A common electronic interface to new
ABB transformers to provide add-on
functionality. The system is composed
of several sensors designed and built
into a new transformer. The system
measures or estimates the following
parameters:
x Hotspot at HV/LV/TV and estimate
of hotspot temperature
x Cooling control
x OLTC contact wear
ABB x WEB interface
Transformer Electronic
Control (TEC) Monitor x Moisture in oil measurement
x Bubbling temperature
x Insulation aging due to moisture
x Transformer temperature balance
x Oil level in conservator
x Online gas-in-oil interpretation
x OLTC temperature balance
x OLTC torque
A proven retrofit solution that provides
adequate predictive power by means of
easily fitted add-on sensors and
models that use the available
information about the transformer and
its component design. The system
measures the following parameters:
x Top oil and ambient temp
x Coolers temp
x Dissolved gas and moisture in oil
x Load current
ABB
T-Monitor x Bushings
x OLTC (Temperature difference
between main and OLTC tanks,
motor torque)
x Acoustic partial discharge
228
Monitoring
Sample Pictures General Description
Systems/Devices
Morgan Schaffer
Calisto
Dissolved Hydrogen and
moisture monitor
229
Monitoring
Sample Pictures General Description
Systems/Devices
230
Monitoring
Sample Pictures General Description
Systems/Devices
231
Monitoring
Sample Pictures General Description
Systems/Devices
Cutler-Hammer
InsulGard G2
232
Monitoring
Sample Pictures General Description
Systems/Devices
MR
Tap-changer TM100
monitoring system
233
5 PREVENTIVE MAINTENANCE OF TRANSFORMERS
5.1 BASIC AGEING PROCESSES [125]
5.1.1 INTRODUCTION
The main point of concern in ageing and life expectancy of transformers is the condition
of the insulation system, which is typically based on organic products. The following
organic products are found in an oil immersed transformer:
The organic products in a transformer degrade over time and finally they lose the
capability to withstand the stresses a transformer might see in daily life (short circuits,
energizing, vibration, etc.). It is possible to reverse the ageing of mineral oil through oil
reclamation that can restore the material properties close to the values when new.
Ageing of paper insulation however, is an irreversible process and is considered one of
the life-limiting processes of a transformer. The main factors that contribute to the
degradation processes of the organic materials are:
Temperature
Moisture
Oxygen
Acidity
The lifetime of this combination of mineral oil and paper in a transformer is very much
dependent on the operating temperature, oxygen content, acidity of the oil and the
moisture content in the insulation. Temperature is mainly dependent on the transformer
design, the loading, the cooling facilities, and the ambient temperature. Changing these
parameters is not easy and normally involves large investments. Moisture is
accumulated in the paper insulation of the transformer and has different sources. Poorly
maintained breathing apparatus on open breathing expansion tanks or damaged
gaskets on the cover can be a source of water from outside as can exposure of the
insulation material to air during a repair operation[126]. Also, the depolymerization
(ageing, degradation) of the insulation paper and the ageing of the oil create water as a
by-product inside the transformer [127,128].
New research also shows that the acid content plays a major role in the degradation
processes, in which the low molecular acids are of main concern. The acids are
produced as by-products of the oil and paper degradation. To extend the technical life
and to increase the reliability of the transformer, the moisture and acid levels in the
insulation should be kept as low as possible.
234
When a transformer leaves the factory, the insulation system is dry and almost free of
acids. This will change over the time as water and acids are produced through
degradation of the cellulose material and accumulate in the transformer. As a result, the
speed of degradation of the paper and oil will increase.
Removing moisture and acids from the transformer can slow down the ageing process
and thus extend the lifetime of the insulation system. These removal processes are
preferably performed on site, as moving a large power transformer to a transformer
workshop equipped with a vapor phase drying plant incurs considerable costs in both
time and money. Onsite drying and online oil reclamation are two processes that will
extend the remaining lifetime of the insulation system on site.
Paper (and pressboard) consists mainly of cellulose and some percent of hemicellulose
and lignine. The reduction in mechanical strength is due to chain scissions of the
cellulose molecules. New oil-impregnated paper has an average chain length of 1000-
1200 polysaccharide rings in series – denoted degree of polymerisation (DP). The
tensile strength depends on the DP as shown in Figure 5-1. Conventionally a DP value
of 200 is used as an end of life criterion
235
Instead of using tensile strength to estimate ageing, one can use the scissoring of the
cellulose molecules (η) , which in turn reduces the DP value and the Arrhenius
dependence according to Ekenstam [130]:
Ș = DPnew·A·exp(-E/(RT))·t = DPnew·k·t
The equation shows how the number of chain scissions (η) increases with time (t). The
expression A·exp(-E/(RT)) describes the ageing rate k. R is the molar gas constant, T
the absolute temperature and E the activation energy, which describes how the ageing
varies with temperature. The higher the value of E, the faster the ageing rate increases
with temperature. A is a factor that depends on the chemical environment of the
cellulose.
It has long been established that the ageing of cellulose can be divided in two
processes: oxidation and hydrolysis [131,132]. For both processes the ageing rate
increases with temperature. There are strong indications [133] that the temperature
dependence is different for the two processes, and it may well be that oxidation
dominates at lower temperatures and hydrolysis at higher temperatures.
Under oxidation, the ageing agent is oxygen from air ingress. The ultimate end products
of oxidation are the same as for combustion, i.e. water and carbon dioxide. However,
the mechanism of low temperature oxidation is quite different from that of combustion.
The oxygen concentration is an important parameter that determines the rate of
oxidation. However, most experimental studies show that the ageing rate is not so
strongly influenced by oxygen content. Typically, the overall degradation rate will no
more than double in experiments with oxygen present, compared to when oxygen is
totally excluded. It can therefore be concluded that the importance of oxygen to ageing
is limited.
The other major mechanism of paper ageing is hydrolysis. The significance of water
content is paramount: a humidity of 3-4% may increase the degradation rate of paper by
a factor of 10 or more, compared to dry paper. This underlines the importance of
assessing both moisture and temperature of the insulation system. It must be
mentioned that these studies are from laboratory samples and may not be directly
transferable to transformer life assessment.
Newer theories on hydrolyses proposes that the process is due to acid catalysis; H+ (or
rather H2+O) ions from carboxylic acids that are dissociated in water serve as catalysts
to the chain scissoring of the cellulose molecules [134]. Since both hydrolysis (and also
oxidation) produces carboxylic acids and water, this makes hydrolysis an auto-
accelerating process.
236
1200
Formic
1000 Acetic
Levulinic
Naphtenic
800
Stearic
DP-value
No acid
600
400
200
0
0 200 400 600 800
Time [hours]
Figure 5-2: Ageing of paper at 130 °C in oils with an acidity of 0,4 mg KOH/g
As can be seen from Figure 5-2, the high molecular weight acids (stearic and naphthenic
acids) do not accelerate ageing. The effect of the other acids on ageing rate is an
increase with decreasing molecular weight. The reason for the different influence on the
ageing rate is mainly due to the hydrophilic nature of the lower molecular acids. The
acids with lower molecular weights dissolve easier in the paper than the stearic and
naphthenic acids [136].
The significance of these findings for maintenance is important. The ageing accelerating
substances – water and low molecular acids - will tend to dissolve better in paper than
in oil. Removal of these substances from the cellulose is therefore what the winding
maintenance activity should aim for. Oil reclaiming will certainly remove some of these,
but other methods may be more efficient.
It is in this context important to note that the measurement of the neutralization value as
is standardized in IEC 62021-1 and ASTM D974 mainly detects acids formed by oil
ageing. A new measurement technique is needed for the detection of the dangerous
hydrophilic acids. Presently there are no standards methods for estimating the content
of these acids in a transformer. One technique may be “water washing” of an oil sample
to remove the low molecular weight acids from the oil sample. The difference in
neutralization number between a measurement of a “pure” and a “water washed” oil
sample may yield a descriptor for the low molecular weight acids.
237
Heat /Vacuum Cycles
This technology incorporates the following procedures:
Heating process:
Oil-spray through spreading pipes installed above the windings under vacuum.
Periodically circulate dry air through the tank to maintain the surface
temperature.
Drying process:
Cycle vacuum treatment with circulation of transformer oil through the oil heater /
filter followed with a cycle of oil spraying at low vacuum to maintain average
drying temperature.
5.1.3.2 ON-SITE DRYING WITH LOW FREQUENCY HEATING (LFH) IN COMBINATION WITH HOT-OIL SPRAY
[137]
Temperature and vacuum are the main factors for drying speed and drying quality. For
optimized drying the transformer should be heated at the same time as vacuum is
applied (as is done during the vapor phase process). With the combination of the low
frequency heating (LFH) technique and hot oil spray or hot oil circulation, this can also
be achieved on site.
The low frequency voltage is necessary in order to reduce the applied voltage on the
transformer when it is under vacuum. The reason is that the breakdown voltage of the
insulation system is much lower under vacuum than under atmospheric pressure. This
238
is also known as the Paschen law. In order to prevent hotspots during drying (due to
reduced cooling), the applied current for heating power transformers should not exceed
50% of the nominal current. Consequently, the copper losses will be no more than ¼ of
the nominal losses and the risk of potential hot spots at points with higher resistance will
be negligible.
In order to heat up both the low and high voltage windings, a frequency of approx. 1 Hz
is applied to the transformer. With the combination of LFH drying and conventional hot
oil spray method, the whole transformer can be heated very uniformly. The LFH system
heats the windings from the inside and the hot oil spray supports the heating process by
heating outer parts of the insulation system.
Spray
nozzles
Figure 5-3: Plant concept for a mobile LFH drying process in combination with hot oil spray.
239
From a technical point of view the continuous “washing” of the solid insulation
represents a great advantage. During ageing of the oil, large amounts of acids, sludge
and other degradation products are absorbed by the paper and other cellulose material.
These contaminants can later be redissolved into the new clean oil. In the case of
reclaiming, the contaminants are constantly being removed from the oil during the
process and they can be permanently removed from the cellulose material. In the case
of oil replacement without proper cleaning of the active part, the residual degradation
products will cause a substantial shortening of the life of the new oil. Without an
appropriate washing procedure, the oil will typically be degraded again after only a few
years (See Figure 5-4).
5.1.4.3 LONG- TERM STABILITY
The long-term stability and oxidation stability of reclaimed oil has been questioned. One
reason is that the conventional reclaiming process (without reactivation of the
absorbent) with the daily exchange of the Fullers earth was often performed using a
limited amount of absorbent. As a result, the ageing by-products were not effectively
removed from the cellulose material and were reabsorbed into the reclaimed oil. The
effect is a recontamination of the processed oil within a very short time, as shown in
Figure 5-4.
0,25
0,2
0,15
0,1
0,05
New oil
0
Before After process 3 mnd. 2 years 4 years 6 years 10 years
Time
Figure 5-4: Evolution of total acidity in oil after online reclamation, oil change and reclamation
with little absorbent
The modern reclaiming technology with the reactivation of the absorbent makes it
economically feasible to use much more active absorbent material. Typically 5-10 times
more absorbent is used compared with the old conventional systems. This leads to a
much better cleaning effect of the paper and to an excellent long-term stability of the
reclaimed oil.
240
For some transformers, there is data available for up to 10 years since reclamation. The
data shows very little change in acidity and color after 10 years in operation since the oil
was reclaimed. For a successful reclamation process with excellent long-term stability
approximately 700 kg of active absorbent is necessary to treat 1000 kg of oil.
To prevent excessive production of acids due to oil degradation, it is recommended that
the oil be reclaimed before it is severely degraded. Low molecular weight acids do
migrate into the paper insulation and become much harder to remove than from the oil.
The primary purpose of transformer maintenance is to ensure that the internal and
external parts of the transformer and accessories are kept in good condition (“fit for
purpose”) and are able to operate safely at all times. A secondary, equally essential
purpose is to maintain a historical record of the condition of the transformer.
For personal safety reasons, only a limited amount of maintenance activities should be
performed on the transformer when it is in operation. Be sure to follow the
manufacturer’s recommended safety requirements before any maintenance activity is
undertaken.
241
5. Check and record the line voltage and note any variation from rated value since
the previous check.
6. For transformers equipped with Sealedaire®, check and record the reading of the
pressure-vacuum gauge. If the gauge remains at or near zero when the oil
temperature varies, the transformer should be checked for leaks. This is an
important maintenance check which will verify the integrity of the transformer
seal.
5.2.1.2 QUARTERLY MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE
1. Check and record the readings on all indicating instruments, such as the liquid
level of the main tank, all oil-filled compartments, top oil temperature, and
winding temperature. The maximum reading and the present reading should be
noted on the temperature indicators. If the transformer is equipped with an
Inertaire® oil preservation system, check and record the tank pressure and the
remaining pressure in the nitrogen bottle feeding the system.
Examine the piping to the coolers or radiators and all bolted pipe joints for signs of oil
leakage. Tighten any loose fittings and repair any oil leaks.
2. Examine the coolers or radiators for accumulation of dirt and foreign material that
might impede airflow. The coolers or radiators can be cleaned by directing a
stream of low-pressure water over the surfaces. On FOA coolers, the water
should be directed to the front side of the cooler to wash any dirt toward the rear.
Be certain the fans are shut off before starting any cleaning operation. The
frequency of cleaning will vary depending on the conditions at the installation
site. Annual cleaning is generally sufficient, but installation subjected to salt spray
or heavy dust and dirt will require a more frequent schedule.
CAUTION: The control circuits may have dangerous voltage levels. De-
energize the auxiliary power source before working on any control
components. Failure to do so may cause personal injury or equipment
damage.
Control-circuit voltage
Collections of dirt or gum
Excess heating of parts (evidenced by discoloration of metal parts,
charred insulation, or odor)
Binding or sticking of moving parts
Corrosion of metal parts
Remaining wear allowance on contacts
Excess slam on pickup
242
Proper contact pressure
Loose connections
Condition of flexible shunts
Worn or broken mechanical parts
Excessive arcing in opening circuits
Excessive noise in ac magnets
Evidence of dripping water or liquids falling on controls
Operation, including proper functioning of timing devices and sequencing
of devices
2. If the transformer is equipped with air cooling, examine the fans to ensure that there
is no debris covering them or between the blades. Check to make sure that each fan
is operational and that the blade rotation is correct. If the cooling banks are staged,
check that the proper set of fans come on for each stage. Measure line currents on
the fan motor and check for any imbalances.
3. Examine the pump valves for evidence of leaking around the gland seals. Close and
open the flapper-operating arm. There should be some restriction to the flapper arm
movement if the packing is properly tightened.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to operate the pump valve when the pumps are in
operation. Always shut off the pump motor before opening or closing any
valves. Failure to follow these precautions may cause equipment damage and
personal injury.
Take oil samples from the main tank and any other oil-filled compartment, such as the
load tap changer. Perform general oil quality analyses on the oil sample. Oil samples
may also be taken at this time for gas-in-oil or metal particle analysis. If any test results
are questionable, contact ABB.
Perform insulation resistance tests on each winding to the other winding and to ground
and from all windings to ground and compare with the previous test values. Measure the
insulation power factor and compare with previous test values. Contact the Technical
Support Section if any of the tested values vary significantly from the initial tests.
4. Examine all bushings, arresters, and all the interconnecting hardware for
contamination and signs of electrical tracking. Clean any contaminated areas with a
soft cloth and suitable solvent, then wipe the area dry. Perform power factor and
243
capacitance measurement on the bushings and compare the values to the test
results made when the transformer was installed.
5. If the transformer is equipped with a load tap changer, inspect the tap changer as
noted in the tap changer instruction leaflet. Detailed information for the inspection
procedures and the frequency of inspection is supplied as part of the transformer
instruction book.
8. Examine the paint finish, particularly around welded joints and on accessory items
such as the radiators, coolers, and associated piping. Check for paint peeling or
cracking and evidence of rust. Clean the affected areas by wire brushing, then wipe
with a clean dry cloth. Paint the area with the touch-up primer and finish coat
supplied in the transformer details shipment box.
De-energize the auxiliary power source and inspect the control devices in the control
cabinet. Remove grease, oil, or other contaminants with a lint-free cloth moistened in a
nonflammable cleaning fluid. Do not soak the parts with the cleaner, but use just
enough to loosen grease or dirt so that it can be wiped off. For cleaning small parts, a
small paintbrush dipped into the cleaning solution is good for getting into corners and
crevices. Repair or replace any broken or malfunctioning parts, tighten all loose
connections, and eliminate any oil or water leaks into the compartment.
Moisture balance between the oil and the solid insulation implies that most of the
moisture will gather in the paper insulation. Moisture in insulation is one of the dominant
ageing accelerators. It is recommended to dry the insulation when the moisture exceeds
a certain level. Drying of the insulation and oil is recommended for large distribution and
power transformers since this can be technically and economically motivated.
Equipment for drying transformers at site is available, and the residual moisture in the
insulation will be less than 1% after drying with low frequency heating equipment.
During drying, the transformer has to be de-energized. Drying time can vary from one to
244
two weeks depending on the transformer size, amount of insulation, and initial moisture
level in the insulation.
Taking oil samples from hermetically sealed transformers is normally not necessary,
and should only be performed after consultation with ABB. The oil in this type of
transformer is not in contact with the atmosphere and less exposed to moisture. Oil
regeneration/reclaiming of oil may be technically and economically motivated, especially
for large distribution and power transformers. Reclaiming implies filtering, de-gassing,
removing ageing by-products, and adding an inhibitor if required. Reclamation of oil is
performed with the transformer in service (operation). The transformer is only de-
energized for a few hours when the equipment is connected and disconnected from the
transformer. If the oil is in good condition, except from particles present in the oil,
filtering can be recommended for removal of the particles.
245
Total expected lifetime depends on the number of operations, normal current, etc.
Inspection/maintenance of tap changers must only be carried out by trained and
experienced personnel. See supplier’s documentation provided.
5.2.2.7 COOLERS
Coolers are cleaned by brushing inside the water tubes or by air-side vacuum cleaning
when necessary. The need for cleaning is indicated by increased pressure loss,
decreased temperature-difference oil/water/air in/out, increased transformer
temperature, decreased water flow, etc. See the manufacturer’s documentation.
5.2.2.9 GASKETS
The gaskets of the cover and flanges, as well as between bushings and cover, are
usually made of liquid-resistant vulcanized cork sheet, nitrile rubber, or silicone sealant.
If the gaskets are leaking, leaks can usually be sealed by tightening the screws (bolts).
When these gaskets have to be replaced, it is recommended to contact ABB. Liquid
resistant rubber rings are used as gaskets for bushing bolts, shafts, and spindles. All
246
these gaskets can be tightened and replaced from outside the tank. When tightening the
gaskets, special care must be taken to prevent the breaking of screws (bolts) or else the
gasket “floats away” (if not in a groove) as a result of the heavy pressure. In particular,
stud nuts must be tightened very carefully.
5.2.2.10 SURFACE PROTECTION
247
Special mention should be made above the operation of the protective equipment on
the transformer. Operation of some protective equipment such as gas relay or
differential relay does not always mean that the transformer is damaged. The gas relay
can operate for example when:
x An air bubble has been left under the transformer cover. An air bubble is
colorless and odorless.
x A short circuit current has passed the transformer. No gas bubbles.
248
SYMPTOMS PROBABLE SOLUTIONS
CAUSES
Winding rupture. Contact ABB.
Triggering of differential relay during Internal failure in Contact ABB.
operation. the transformer.
Failure in current Check current transformers.
transformers
feeding the relay.
Spurious triggering during operation. Triggering and Check settings. Check thermometer.
alarm incorrectly
set. Incorrect
thermometer
operation.
Defect Ptl00 Check sensors or thermistors.
sensors or
thermistors.
Relays incorrect Check timing.
timing.
Short circuit in the Remove the failure in the control system.
control system on
the secondary
side.
Abnormal operating temperature Local heating at Clean contact surfaces and retighten.
measured by thermography. the transformer
terminals.
Excessive cable Undersized cables.
heating.
Winding and/or top-oil thermometer Insufficient Check ventilation of premises. Consider
alarm and/or trip. ventilation. installation of cooling fans.
High ambient
temperature.
Transformer Consider load reduction or installation of a
overloaded. transformer with higher power rating.
Reduced oil, Check oil, water, and air circulation.
water, or air
circulation.
Too high oil Reduce load.
temperature.
Measurement of unexpected voltage Ground failure on Remove failure.
to ground. one phase.
High acoustical sound level. Supply voltage Reduce supply voltage or change position
higher than on tap changer. Retighten.
presupposed.
Loose
accessories or
elements.
Reflection from Install sound damping panels. Place the
walls and other transformer in non-parallel direction to the
elements. walls. Use damping pads below the
transformer.
Low frequency. Contact electricity utility.
Oil flow trip. Oil circulation too Open valves in oil circuit.
low.
249
SYMPTOMS PROBABLE SOLUTIONS
CAUSES
Oil pump Check oil pump and protection.
protection.
Buchholz-gas relay alarm. Gas bubbles De-energize the transformer.
caused by local If the captured gas is flammable, carry out
overheating. dissolved gas analysis (DGA). Contact
ABB.
Gas bubbles If the captured gas is not flammable, bleed
caused by the transformer properly and energize.
incomplete
bleeding
Buchholz-gas relay trip. Arcing in active Carry out dissolved gas analysis (DGA).
part. Contact ABB.
Oil level too low. Adjust oil level and repair leakages.
Welding on the transformer is only allowed
if the transformer is filled by oil/inert gas
(nitrogen).
Oil level indicator: alarm high level or Incorrect oil level. Adjust oil level. Repair leakages, if any.
trip low level. Welding on the transformer is only allowed
if the transformer is filled by oil/inert gas
(nitrogen).
Leakage detector alarm. Leakage in Repair/change the cooler.
cooler.
On-load tap changer protective relay Sudden pressure Inspection/repair of tap-changer diverter
trip. rise in tap switch.
changer
compartment.
On-load tap changer out of step trip. Operation of tap Check tap changer, interlocking, and
changer failed. synchronism.
Pressure-relief device trip. Sudden pressure Carry out dissolved gas analysis (DGA).
rise transformer. Contact ABB.
Gas-monitoring alarm. Gas-detection. Carry out dissolved gas analysis (DGA).
Contact ABB.
NOTE: Contact ABB specialists before inspection, adjustment, and repair of vital parts.
250
WORK. GROUND ALL THE TRANSFORMER TERMINALS. FAILURE TO DO THIS
MAY RESULT IN EQUIPMENT DAMAGE AND SEVERE PERSONAL INJURY.
CAUTION: Do not enter any transformer until the gas in the tank is replaced by dry air.
Oxygen content inside the transformer must be at least 19.5 % before entering for
inside inspection. The oxygen content must always be checked. Oxygen contents less
than 19.5 % may cause drowsiness and/or injury and death.
If it is necessary to filter the oil, follow the proper procedures supplied by the
manufacturer.
5.2.4.1 OPENING THE TRANSFORMER
Remove the manhole cover and proceed with the internal inspection. The time the
transformer is open for inspection should not exceed two hours. Dry air must be
circulated in the tank during inspection. Consult the manufacturer’s instruction manual
for the required airflow rates.
Internal inspection and maintenance procedures will require removing and replacing oil
in the transformer. Pump the oil into clean storage containers. The oil level should be
kept as high as possible while the internal work is being done to minimize the exposure
of the insulation and to prevent the entrance of moisture.
CAUTION: Persons entering the transformer must not have loose dirt particles on
their clothing. Clean cloth shoe covers or nitrile rubber overshoes must be worn
by anyone entering the transformer. Failure to observe these precautions may
cause an electrical failure.
The amount of oil removed and the length of time the transformer is open will determine
the procedure for treatment of the oil. Open time starts each time the transformer seal is
broken and ends when the transformer is resealed, refilled with oil, or pressurized with
dry gas. The time is cumulative. Feed bottled dry air through a pressure regulator into
the tank while it is open.
If the insulation of the transformer has been exposed to air for some period of time
during the inspection/repair of the transformer, the moisture level in the insulation will
increase. Depending on increase in moisture level, on-site drying of the transformer
should be considered.
251
should be used as a guide during internal inspection. Pay careful attention to the
following areas:
Core:
x Open the core ground and measure core insulation resistance to assure
proper core isolation. Multiple core grounds may permit damaging circulating
currents to flow within the core.
x Visually inspect the accessible core components for movement, displacement
or looseness of core insulation, and mechanical supports. Look for evidence
of localized hotspots or discoloration on the core.
Windings:
x Inspect accessible winding conductors for mechanical deformation and
electrical damage.
x Disc windings are supported mechanically by multiple columns of pressboard
radial or key spacers arranged at intervals within the winding. This
arrangement provides the necessary mechanical support to couple vertical
winding forces (short circuit forces) into the primary mechanical winding
supports and end frame structures. It is important that these vertical spacer
columns are properly aligned and secure. Check the column alignment.
x On shell form transformers, check the inter-phase blocking to be certain that
the wedges are tight and secured. Tighten any loose wedges by tapping them
in place with a non-metallic mallet and secure the dowel pins at the top of the
wedges.
x Check the winding end insulation items for proper alignment and voids
between the top of the winding and the coil support. Check for any loose
radial spacer blocks. Look for tilt or misalignment of the radial spacer
columns, especially in the top 20% or so of the winding. A mode of short
circuit motion in the outer winding is a tendency for that winding to try to
“unwind” due to the repulsive forces between the outer and inner winding.
The effect on the inner winding is opposite with a tendency to tighten the
252
winding. Evidence of looseness or misalignment will require an engineering
analysis as to possible corrective actions. Some retightening is possible in
place but access to the inner windings is, of course, limited.
x Obtain samples of pressboard for DP analysis. The samples are best taken
from an area near the top of the outer winding and adjacent to the conductor,
as this is the area of greatest heat. Make sure a supply of properly dried and
impregnated pressboard is available to replace any spacer blocks that may
be removed for this analysis or found to be defective.
5.2.4.3 ELECTRICAL TESTS
If there is evidence of internal damage, contact the manufacturer. The following tests
may be made as part of the internal inspection procedure:
CAUTION: Do not attempt to conduct any electrical tests if the oil has been removed
from the transformer. The windings and the associated connections must be under oil
even for low-voltage tests. Failure to observe these precautions may lead to equipment
failure or severe personal injury.
Metal parts are painted for protection against the weather. Care should be taken to
prevent scratching these painted surfaces. The sight glass transparency may become
impaired due to reaction with atmospheric contaminants and should be cleaned
regularly to deter this reaction. In the event the sight glass does become opaque, it
should be replaced in order to maintain good visibility of the oil level.
In the unlikely event it becomes necessary to add oil to a bushing, the fill plug in the
spring assembly or the metal dome can be removed. Insertion of a clean standpipe, with
253
an outside diameter of slightly less than the diameter of the hole will provide a means of
adding small quantities (two quarts or less) to the bushing. This should return the oil to
the proper level. If not, the bushing must be removed from service and returned for
repair and processing. Follow the procedure outlined below for oil additions in the field.
Obtain the necessary oil from the Components Division Plant, Alamo, TN 38001, or
provide oil that meets the following standard:
To prevent oxidation of the bushing oil, the air space above the oil level should be
purged with dry nitrogen and the fill plug replaced immediately afterward.
WARNING:
DO NOT REMOVE THE FILL PLUG WHEN THE BUSHING IS AT AN ELEVATED
TEMPERATURE AS THE OIL INSIDE THE BUSHING MAY BE VERY HOT AND
UNDER HIGH PRESSURE. MAKE SURE THE BUSHING TEMPERATURE IS IN THE
15 TO 35°C RANGE. FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE GUIDELINES COULD RESULT
IN SEVERE PERSONAL INJURY.
Due to the inconvenience and possible service interruptions resulting from bushing
outages, many users have programs for Planned Preventative Maintenance. We
endorse such programs and recommend:
The following guidelines may be used to minimize the effect of contamination and
high humidity during power factor and capacitance measurements in the field.
254
b. Clean and dry the power factor tap insulator to remove any contamination or
condensation.
c. Avoid making power factor measurement in wooden crates to minimize the effect
of surface leakage due to moist wood.
d. Provide sufficient clearance between the bushings and other objects to minimize
the effects of stray capacitance.
e. Do not invert bushing as this may cause entrapment of gas and result in erratic
readings.
f. For information on ground connections and other guidelines, please refer to the
test equipment manufacturer’s Instruction Manual.
For satisfactory operation of a bushing, it is important that the top terminals are tight
at all times. If any of these parts are loose, overheating of the current-carrying joint
can take place and result in damaged terminal joints. This type of overheating can
deteriorate the bushing gasket seals, which could result in deterioration of the oil-
paper system.
Visually examine the bushings and look for discolored top terminal, external terminal
connector or bolts, and the draw lead cap nut. Look for steam rising from the terminal
during rain. Perform an infrared scan of the top terminals.
If the above examination indicates overheating, remove the transformer from service
and check the power factor and capacitance. Remove the top terminal and examine for
any damage. Examine the gaskets for any sign of hardening. If any signs of overheating
are present then the bushing should be taken out of service as the overheating may
have affected the other sealing gaskets at the top end. If the top terminal cannot be
removed, it has most likely suffered overheating damage at the threaded joint. Remove
the bushing for service.
If the top parts do not show any sign of overheating or damage and the power factor
and capacitance values are acceptable, then reinstall these parts by following the
proper instructions. Use new gaskets if they show any sign of damage.
Any repair of high-voltage condenser bushings should be done in the factory because of
the danger of contamination to the insulation if the seal is broken. In addition, the very
high vacuum and clamping pressure require the use of equipment not usually available
in the field.
28
See section 1.7.1 for comments on OLTC (IEC designation) or LTC (IEEE designation)
255
Table 5-2: General Pointers for LTC Maintenance
In addition, for OLTC types in which arcing occurs in the oil, it is important to thoroughly
clean the component as part of routine maintenance. Attention should be given to
mechanical wear and arcing contact wear. In non-oil-arcing LTCs, it is expected that the
oil will be relatively clean. It is necessary to check the wear gauge on vacuum
interrupters in order to assess contact erosion. The interrupters themselves must be
pull-tested to ensure they are still under vacuum and not filled with oil.
Additionally, the dielectric integrity of vacuum interrupters must be tested with an AC
high potential (HIPOT) tester.
256
5.2.7 GENERAL QUALITY INFORMATION FOR VARIOUS TYPES OF LTCS
Over the years as ABB service engineers and technicians have worked on LTCs,
several “tricks of the trade” have been compiled. Some of these quality tips are listed in
Table 5-3 to Table 5-10.
5.2.7.1 NORTH-AMERICAN PRACTICES
257
Table 5-4: Maintenance Quality Tips for Westinghouse LTCs
Model Potential Problem Potential Mitigation Action
Westinghouse Type UTT: Air x On the UTT (not UTT-A or UTT-B), the air x Check your UTTs and replace the gasket
Compartments compartment that houses the cam switch before it leaks.
assembly has a small plate on top of it. x The new gasket is 1/8" cork-neoprene approx.
x The gasket under this plate may deteriorate with 6X6". ABB S#4155D20H05.
age and eventually leak.
x A leak at this location will cause considerable
damage to the cam switch assembly.
x This damage is not evident to a careful visual
inspection from the ground until it is too late.
Westinghouse UTT: Cam x These units have black molded switches that x Replacement molded switches are no longer
Switches (Prior to UTT-A70) deteriorate with time. They can bind up, breaking available. Therefore, if this problem develops,
parts coupling the cam switch to the tap changer. UTT-B style switches can be adapted for use
The motor then runs until a mechanical limit is on these tap changers.
reached.
x This often results in expensive damage to the tap
changer motor mechanism and/or reversing
assembly.
Westinghouse Type UTT: x Tracking has caused problems on the Type UTT x In addition to flushing the LTC compartment,
Terminal Board Tracking terminal boards. make sure you wipe the boards to remove all
x This problem has been attributed to inadequate carbon deposits.
cleaning during maintenance cycles. x Inspect the boards carefully for any signs that
x In early stages, carbon tracks can be cleaned with tracking has begun.
sandpaper. x Proper maintenance will minimize the
x If the tracking is allowed to progress unchecked, a possibility of tracking on the Type UTT
flashover could result. terminal boards.
Westinghouse Type UTT: x Many UTT models previous to the UTT-B model x UTT-B contacts were developed to eliminate
Conversion Kits have experienced coking failures. this hazard and are available for all earlier
models.
Westinghouse Type UTH: x The balance coils on Westinghouse Type UTH x If the coils have crimped terminals, check the
Balance Coil Leads LTCs have been manufactured with terminals terminations very carefully to ensure that they
either crimped or brazed to the leads. There is are not loose.
potential for the crimped leads to loosen. x The coils are located on the LTC transfer
switches.
Westinghouse UVT x The dehydrating breather on the Westinghouse x Replacing the plastic vent with a brass filter,
Type UVT LTC has a plastic vent plug with a wire ABB part# 72A4551H01, will eliminate this
that when improperly maintained can prevent the potential problem.
breather from operating.
Westinghouse UVT, UVW x The faster operating LTCs (UVT, UVW) have very x To set the more complicated sequences on
critical timing sequences. these tap changers, timing wheels are
required.
Westinghouse Type UVT: x Certain vacuum LTCs require vacuum filling to x If the main tank is oil-filled, do not tie the LTC
GE LoadVac prevent damage to the vacuum interrupter bellows tank to the main tank and pull vacuum over
due to trapped air. the main tank oil.
x The terminal boards will withstand full vacuum
if the following conditions are adhered to:
x The board temperature must be less than
50°C.
x The pressure in the maim tank gas space
must be 0 psi.
Westinghouse URS: Drive x With age these motors appear to lose power and x New URS motors are no longer available at
Motor the LTC will not operate properly. any price.
x Motor rewind shops often find nothing wrong with x We recommend calling other users looking for
the motor. a used motor that is useable or at least can
x In fact the rotor running bar(s) are open at the be rebuilt.
shorting ring and restrict the development of
torque.
Westinghouse and ABB x "17” link type switches in ”shorted” position on x The switches must be left in the open position
Controls LTC controls means non-functioning circuits. for normal operation.
x Many Westinghouse and ABB LTC controls are x Be sure the “17” switches are open except for
equipped with one or more "17" sliding link type certain servicing operations.
shorting switches. These are shipped in the
shorted position for safety reasons.
258
Table 5-5: Maintenance Quality Tips for ASEA and Reinhausen Resistive Type LTCs
Model Potential Problem Potential Mitigation Action
Reinhausen Suction Tubes x Entrapment of air in high-stress areas can result x The "S' pipe is provided with a bleed screw for
in a failure. venting.
x Commonly missed are the suction tubes in
Reinhausen tap changers.
x This tube connects the "S" pipe to the bottom of
the diverter tank for draining.
ASEA & Reinhausen x Tighten the kerosene plug before the main tank
Resistance Type LTC is sealed. DO NOT over-tighten, or you will
crash the gasket and it will leak.
x Make sure the valve between the diverter
compartment and main tank is open during
vacuum processing and closed in service.
259
Idem Potential Problem Potential Mitigation Action
Gaskets x Properly applied gaskets provide better seal x Always use the correct gasket for the application
and maintain the proper compression.
x Cork-Neoprene is generally used for permanent
joints, such as air-filled cabinets and installment
mountings. Proper compression is 43%.
x Nitrile rubber is generally used where reusable
gaskets are required, such as inspection covers,
bushing flanges, etc. Proper compression is 33%
x % Compression = 100*(Gasket Thickness –
Compressed Thickness)/Gasket Thickness
Silicone Grease x A lubricant is often used on gaskets and seals. x Do not use silicone grease on load tap changers.
Silicone grease is a good insulator. But if the Put gaskets on dry or use petrolatum.
material migrates to the LTC contacts, high
contact resistance and overheating could result.
Transformer Openings x All transformer openings, such as upper filter x It is recommended to use Teflon paste for all
press/filling openings must be sealed at all times fittings.
to prevent introduction of water into the x Check the integrity of the tank after sealing.
transformer tank. x Pressurize the tank to 3 to 4 psig with dry
nitrogen.
x Allow the pressurized tank to stand for one to two
hours.
x Examine the tank and fittings for leaks by
applying a soap solution to all joints and pipe
fittings.
x After determining that there are no leaks reduce
the internal pressure to normal start-up limits.
Terminal Board x The design withstand pressure of the board can x Before applying vacuum to any LTC with the
be different between different types of LTCs. main tank at different pressures, make sure that
x The design withstand pressure of the board can the terminal board is designed to withstand the
be different between LTCs of the same type. pressure applied.
x If there are any questions, check with the
manufacturer.
260
5.2.7.2 EUROPEAN PRACTICE
Table 5-8: Maintenance Quality Tips for ASEA and Reinhausen Resistive Type OLTCs
Model Potential Problem Potential Mitigation Action
ABB diverter switch type UC x Correct diverter switch insert. x After the diverter switch is placed in the housing the
OLTC should be maneuvered 3 times before the
cover is put on.
ASEA & Reinhausen x Tighten the kerosene plug before the main tank
Resistance Type LTC is sealed. DO NOT over-tighten, or you will
crash the gasket and it will leak.
x Make sure the valve between the diverter
compartment and main tank is open during
vacuum processing and closed in service.
Reinhausen Suction Tubes x Entrapment of air in high-stress areas can result x The "S' pipe is provided with a bleed screw for
in a failure. venting.
x Commonly missed are the suction tubes in
Reinhausen tap changers.
x This tube connects the "S" pipe to the bottom of
the diverter tank for draining.
261
Part Potential Problem Potential Mitigation Action
found in very dirty conditions. compartment, do a very careful visual inspection.
x Often, broken parts, water, or other evidence of x Starting the cleaning process too soon will
trouble will be seen on the tank bottom. destroy this valuable evidence.
x
Oil filters x Make sure that the oil filter operates in the x A wrong operation direction can cause air
correct direction bubbles to enter the bottom in the tap-changer
x It is important that all joints are tight in the oil and create failures
filter circuit. x A leak in the oil circuit can cause that all oil is
drained from the tap-changer resulting in a
failure.
Gaskets x Properly applied gaskets provide better seal x Always use the correct gasket for the application
and maintain the proper compression.
x Cork-Neoprene is generally used for permanent
joints, such as air-filled cabinets and installment
mountings. Proper compression is 43%.
x Nitrile rubber is generally used where reusable
gaskets are required, such as inspection covers,
bushing flanges, etc. Proper compression is 33%
x % Compression = 100*(Gasket Thickness –
Compressed Thickness)/Gasket Thickness
Silicone Grease x A lubricant is often used on gaskets and seals. x Do not use silicone grease on load tap changers.
Silicone grease is a good insulator. But if the Put gaskets on dry or use petrolatum.
material migrates to the OLTC contacts, high
contact resistance and overheating could result.
Transformer Openings x All transformer openings, such as upper filter x It is recommended to use Teflon paste for all
press/filling openings must be sealed at all times fittings.
to prevent introduction of water into the x Check the integrity of the tank after sealing.
transformer tank. x Pressurize the tank to 3 to 4 psig with dry
nitrogen.
x Allow the pressurized tank to stand for one to two
hours.
x Examine the tank and fittings for leaks by
applying a soap solution to all joints and pipe
fittings.
x After determining that there are no leaks reduce
the internal pressure to normal start-up limits.
Terminal Board x The design withstand pressure of the board can x Before applying vacuum to any OLTC with the
be different between different types of OLTCs. main tank at different pressures, make sure that
x The design withstand pressure of the board can the terminal board is designed to withstand the
be different between OLTCs of the same type. pressure applied.
x If there are any questions, check with the
manufacturer.
262
6 REPAIR, REFURBISHMENT AND ON-SITE REPAIR
Power transformers are the most important components of electrical energy supply
networks. Although these components have high reliability, failures can occur due to
external factors such as short circuits in the grid. Failures can also occur due to ageing
effects of the active part, especially the insulation system, or ageing of important
accessories such as bushings or on load tap changers.
In case of failure, the first action is to identify the type of failure. The aim is to localize
the failure itself as well as its root cause. In order to fully understand the reason for the
defect, it is usually necessary to investigate if any abnormalities had occurred in the grid
prior to the failure.
The investigation into the failure location inside the transformer is performed using
different methods of condition assessment. These have been explained in greater
detail in other sections of this handbook.
263
After performing different measurements on site, it is necessary to decide whether the
repair should be performed in a repair factory or on-site. In cases with minor damage,
especially in case of a failure related to connections, bushings or tap changers, the
repair should be done on-site. In cases with more extensive damage or when windings
are involved, several criteria need to be considered. These include the practicality of
transporting the unit, the transportation time and risk, the consequences of non-delivery
of energy during the repair period and redundancy of the failed units i.e. availability of a
spare unit.
On-site repair is often the preferred alternative if the distance to a repair factory is
considerable. In such cases, the total time that the transformer is out of service can be
reduced by eliminating the long and risky transport of the transformer to a repair facility.
Additionally, on-site repair could be the preferred method of repair because of difficulties
in acquiring transportation authorizations by road or rail.
The on-site repair process is very similar to that in a repair factory. Therefore, all critical
elements of on-site repair have the same quality requirements as for factory repair and
should be performed with the same methods and tools where feasible.
To perform the different phases of repair operations on-site, ABB sends experienced
and skilled personnel to the site. The staffs at the site have the same skills as factory
staffs performing the same operations plus the additional experience of performing
sophisticated operations in the field.
The method for hauling the transformer to the temporary workshop is chosen
based on available means at site and the location of the workshop. If a spare
264
foundation may be used as a base for the workshop, means for hauling the
transformer may already be available.
If a temporary workshop is set up, all required tools and equipment will need to
be shipped to the site to be available in time for the different phases of the repair.
A more detailed description of how a temporary workshop is set up is described
below in the section “Facilities for On-Site repair”.
x Factory repair: In a factory repair, the active part is removed from the tank using
a fixed overhead crane with a high lifting capacity.
x On-Site repair: If an overhead crane is not available or if the crane does not
have enough lifting capacity, special lifting equipment is brought to the site to
untank, disassemble and reassemble the active part.
265
windings are manufactured in a transformer factory according to the design specification
for the transformer.
x Factory repair: For a factory repair, the delivered parts are installed upon
receipt. In case of a winding replacement, the windings are dried and assembled
on the core using the fixed crane. If repair of the core is required, the core is
placed in a horizontal position on a core stacking table. This allows the repair or
exchange of core sheets to be performed.
x On-Site repair: For an on-site repair, all windings and other components are
supplied from one of the ABB transformer factories. Before shipment to site,
windings and insulation components are dried using a vapor-phase process.
During transportation, the windings and insulation components are stored in
enclosures supplied with dry air, so they are ready for installation at site. To
keep the insulation dry during the repair and assembly of the active part, the
windings and insulation parts are sealed and supplied with a continuous flow of
dry air. If repair of the core requires the core to be placed in a horizontal position,
a mobile core stacking table is brought to the site. Mobile lifting equipment is
used to tilt the core stacking table.
266
6.5 DRYING
x Factory repair: After assembling, the whole active part is dried in a vapor phase
system, in which vacuum is applied with a certain time and temperature profile. In
addition, the active part is surrounded by kerosene vapor, which is why this
process is called vapor phase drying.
x On-Site repair: After the tank cover has been replaced and sealed, the
transformer is put under a low overpressure of dry air to avoid any possible
contamination (mainly moisture) until the drying phase begins. There are different
drying methods that may be used for drying the transformer at site:
o The most common method is the hot oil circulation and vacuum process. It
is a proven method that provides a good quality of drying within a
reasonable processing time (typically between two to 4 weeks). The drying
time can be reduced by including a hot oil spray system in the process. In
both cases, the transformer tank must be “vacuum tight”. If this is not the
case, then the quality of the drying (remaining moisture in the solid
insulation) will be limited and the required drying time will be significantly
extended.
o The most efficient method in respect of drying time and quality of drying is
the Low Frequency Heating method (LFH) in combination with hot oil
spray. The windings are heated by driving a low frequency current through
the high voltage winding of the transformer while the low voltage winding
is short circuited. Simultaneously hot oil is sprayed on the outside of the
winding and on the insulation parts. The drying is performed under periods
of heating and different levels of vacuum to achieve the most efficient
drying. The advantage of this process is that a Low Frequency (LF)
current heats the transformer coils from the inside, while the hot oil
267
simultaneously heats the outside insulation. Since the windings and the
insulation parts were dried using the vapor phase system and handled
under dry air during the storage and installation periods, the moisture
content should be quite low. The total drying time is typically one to a
maximum of two weeks.
o If an LFH plant is not available, simple hot oil spray or hot oil circulation
may be used. However, these processes may considerably extend the
drying period.
If the repair was performed in the factory then the transformer is typically disassembled
and prepared for shipping. This may involve the removal of the bushings and other
accessories and draining all the oil from the tank. The process is the same as is used
for the shipment of new transformers from the factory.
268
Additionally, impulse tests and determination of load losses can be performed using
modular extensions in additional containers, but this has not been used to date
because of the high costs involved.
Further, dissolved gases in oil are monitored during the first year after repair.
The testing process described above has proven to be an effective way of testing
transformers repaired at site in order to ensure a high standard of quality. Over the last
fifteen years, ABB has successfully repaired more than 200 transformers at site without
any subsequent failure in operation.
Based on experience gained within the ABB service centers that have performed on-site
repair projects, it is estimated that for approximately 50 % of repair projects a facility is
available at the repair site, normally a maintenance shop owned by the customer. For
the remaining 50 % of the projects it is necessary to set up a temporary facility. When a
permanent facility is available at site, the repair area has to be separated from the rest
of the facility in order to maintain cleanliness requirements.
To keep the repair time as short as possible the set up time for the facility should be
minimal.
269
one transformer will be repaired at the same site. The advantage with this type of
building is that it can be made to fit exactly the need and built by local constructing
companies practically anywhere in the world. It can also be designed to withstand
severe weather conditions. In some cases the steel buildings used for on-site repair
have been left at the site for future use.
Figure 6-7: Typical tent structure that may be used as temporary workshop
270
6.9.2 FACILITIES FOR HEAVY LIFTING
The major heavy lifting during repair of a core type transformer is the lifting of the active
part during untanking and tanking of the transformer. The active part of the largest
transformers can weigh up to 400 metric tons. In the factory an overhead crane is used
to do the lifting. At an on-site repair site, where an overhead crane is not available or
does not have the required capacity, mobile lifting systems are available from global
suppliers. For smaller transformers, the lifting may be performed with a mobile crane.
The lifting of windings required for disassembly and reassembly of the active part can
usually be performed using a mobile crane.
Figure 6-8: Active part assembled by using a mobile crane for lifting of winding
271
6.9.6 HIGH VOLTAGE TEST EQUIPMENT
ABB uses a mobile high voltage test field based on state of the art technology, making it
possible to perform high voltage tests at site for practically all types and sizes of
transformer. The system used is the worldwide first mobile HV test system for
transformers based on a frequency converter technique in contrast to conventional
motor-generator sets, which are quite heavy and therefore not easily transportable.
Motor-generator sets need extensive maintenance and are usually less robust than
frequency converters based on semi-conductor techniques. The frequency converter
system also provides more flexibility for testing at different voltages and frequency
ranges. The mobile high voltage test field is shipped to the site during the testing phase.
272
7 ENVIRONMENTAL ASPECTS [143]
Environmental consciousness has increased manifold in today’s society. Meeting the
environmental requirements in the design of new substations and in the renovation and
maintenance of existing substations is an increasing challenge for the electricity
industry. Successful resolution of community acceptance issues and compliance with
environmental regulations may become major milestones in the process of erecting new
or renovating existing substations. In their increasing efforts to satisfy customers and to
gain community acceptance for their facilities, utilities have employed various
environmental management systems to address these important issues. They have also
employed impact evaluation studies to assess the impact of substations on the
environment.
Most efforts to date have focused on the environmental impact of new substations.
However, existing substations have had and may continue to have a significant impact
on the environment, if they are not adequately addressed. Furthermore, the impact of
existing substations on the environment may be growing due to changes in the
surrounding land use, operation of ageing equipment, changes in environmental laws
and regulations, and changes in the community perception of substations. Sometimes
the environmental aspects are directly related to the safety of people, mainly in the case
of fires that produce fumes and toxic gases.
Transformers containing PCB contaminated oils shall not be considered waste whilst in
service. Should the oil became accidentally contaminated, there are several processes
and techniques available for both on-site and off-site decontamination of PCB
contaminated oils. These processes are based on chemical reactions between PCBs
and a reagent to remove the chlorine present. All PCB decontamination methods, either
off-site or on-site, shall be applied by skilled companies complying fully with local
regulations. Off-site decontamination techniques are limited because of concerns over
the safe transportation of contaminated equipment and liquid to an authorized oil
processing facility. Moreover, such processes are subject to local regulations.
29
IEC 60422-2005 - Mineral insulating oils in electrical equipment – Supervision and maintenance guidance
273
Warning
In some countries, the risk of presence of high concentrations of PCB in transformer oils
still exists. Therefore, it is necessary to verify the concentration of PCB in all apparatus
before treating the oil with an oil treatment machine which may be used for the
treatment of oil of new transformers. Note that by legislation, new transformer oil is
supposed to be free of PCBs.
These processes are typically applied in batch and use reagents based on metallic
sodium, sodium hydride, lithium hydride and additives, for the dehalogenation of PCB in
the oil. This type of process is typically run under pressure and medium to high
temperature (150 °C – 300 °C). This temperature is higher than the flash point of the oil
(140 °C – 150 °C) and therefore introduces safety risks.
WARNING
Proper measures shall be taken to minimize the risk of fire or explosion,
especially in the presence of wet oil.
274
distribution lines entering and exiting the substation, buswork, transformers, air-core
reactors and switchgear.
Although the reduction in EMF levels within existing substations cannot be done without
costly intrusive and extensive modifications, there are common techniques in practice.
Reductions in electric field levels can be accomplished by:
x Increasing the height of the buses
x Decreasing the phase spacing and bus diameter
x Lowering the operating system voltage, and
x Making use of vegetation as shielding
In addition, magnetic field levels can be further reduced by balancing currents on lines
and by shielding conductors and buses.
The health effects of electromagnetic fields have been studied extensively over the last
40 years. The results of these studies have been inconclusive and there is no general
consensus on the possible adverse health effects of these fields. In spite of this, the
electrical utility industry has taken a decidedly proactive stance and is committed to
reducing public exposure to EMF. This applies mainly to the area of distribution
transformers.
By far the most important source of noise is that generated by power transformers and
reactors. These pieces of equipment generate a continuous humming noise that might
be disturbing for communities living near the substation. Expansion of urban and
275
suburban areas in the last couple of decades has resulted in some of these substations
being located within and in direct proximity to residential areas. In these new situations,
the noise level generated by the equipment in the substation might not be found
acceptable and corrective measures are often required to reduce the level of noise to
acceptable levels. In addition, public concern regarding industrial noise has increased
over the past few decades and new, more stringent regulations and bylaws have been
introduced to limit noise levels in residential communities.
7.3.2 BACKGROUND
7.3.2.1 CHARACTERISTICS OF TRANSFORMER NOISE
The primary source of noise from transformers is due to magnetostriction of the iron
core. A secondary but much lower source arises from the electromagnetic forces
between the individual turns of the windings. The principal frequency of the resulting
vibration is twice that of the supply frequency (100/120 Hz) and, because the
magnetostriction characteristic of iron is nonlinear, harmonics (200/240, 300/360 and
400/480 Hz) are also generated. The harmonic content of the noise plays a major role in
contributing to the annoyance of the noise as perceived by individuals. The flux density
is controlled by the magnetizing current and the total noise output is proportional to the
exciting voltage times the magnetizing current. Consequently, the noise output remains
essentially constant for a given voltage even though unpredictable variations in the
radiation pattern occur with time. The noise output is normally unaffected by load.
In addition, the increase in noise level propagated due to temperature inversion seldom
remains constant. It normally varies with time over periods ranging from a few seconds
to a few minutes due to changing conditions in the atmosphere. This modulation of the
noise, particularly of the type generated by transformers, is another factor that increases
the subjective reaction as compared to that from a steady noise source.
276
cushion, however, is considered to be the minimum required to accommodate the
temporal variations in radiation pattern and the atmospheric effects previously
discussed.
7.3.4 REQUIREMENTS
Existing substations have to comply with newer, more restrictive noise regulations
sooner or later, especially when complaints are filed about the elevated noise level of a
certain substation.
Methods used to mitigate noise problems in existing substations will depend on factors
such as:
a) The level of noise exceeding the approved level for the area in which the
substations is located
b) The economics of various solutions – the analysis has to take into account the
life cycle cost of the installation, as well as, the benefits the utility may acquire by
addressing concerns of the community
c) Operational and maintenance implications of installing a certain sound mitigation
solution around transformers and/or reactors
d) Issues related to the ability to construct the sound mitigating solution (can it be
done with the equipment live, is there a need for rerouting of power and/or
control cables, etc.)
277
the most appropriate measures for producing the required noise reduction must be
selected.
The following represents the most widely used methods available for minimizing noise
levels created by transformers at existing substations. The newer methods are
described in greater detail.
a) Replacement of Existing Old Transformers with new units with low noise levels.
Manufacturers have made significant steps toward reduction of basic noise levels of
power transformers and reactors. Replacement of an old unit with a new, low noise
unit might prove to be the best solution if the replacement is dictated also by other
factors (end of life of transformer, history of failures of the unit, chronic oil leaks,
etc.). Levels up to 10 dB below the standard levels are practical and the costs range
up to 1 percent of the cost of a standard transformer per decibel depending on the
size. Higher reductions are not normally economically viable compared with other
methods of control.
b) Landscaping: Planting of tall trees on the outside of the fence line in the direction of
the desired noise reduction is one of the solutions that would provide moderate
noise reduction. If space is available around an existing substation, landscaped soil
berms covered with grass and bushes on the crown is another noise reducing
solution. This solution also provides a means of blending the substation into the
community.
c) Simple Open Roof Barriers: The level of noise reduction obtained with this solution
depends on the height of the barrier above the transformer and its relation to the
elevation of the neighbourhood that is targeted for noise reduction. Typically, 8 to 13
dB noise reduction could be achieved with such a barrier. The barrier may be
constructed from a variety of materials, such as steel plate, cement asbestos sheet
or masonry, etc.
d) Sound Enclosure: This enclosure is installed around all four sides of a transformer.
Depending on the level and directions of noise reduction needed, the enclosure can
be with or without a roof. The roof of such a sound enclosure has to be custom
designed for a particular transformer. Adequate space must be provided between
the tank of the transformer and the walls of the enclosure for maintenance staff to
pass. Also, sufficient space must be provided to enable the opening of the doors of
the control box of the transformer. Reductions of up to 20 dB are possible if proper
attention is given to the details of the construction. Coolers of the transformer are
installed outside the enclosure to ensure the design rating of the transformer is not
compromised.
278
board with additional weights that are necessary to reduce the vibration created by
the sound-insulation board.
f) Tight Fitting Enclosure: This solution comprises a total steel plate enclosure
(including a steel roof) around the transformer. This solution is commonly known as
the “tea cozy” solution. In this arrangement, the walls are installed close to the tank
with typically a 10 to 15 cm gap filled with acoustically absorbing material.
Strategically placed doors allow access to the control box of the transformer, the tap
changer, etc. Such enclosures could provide a noise reduction of up to 22 dB.
g) Active Sound Cancellation: This method uses a separate sound source to cancel
the transformer noise. This noise source is produced via an amplifier and speaker
system and is equal in amplitude and opposite in phase to the unwanted noise. ABB
has demonstrated that this method is feasible and especially efficient to reduce low
frequency tones. It may provide useful reductions in the range of 10 dB [144].
The probability of an oil spill occurring in a substation is very low. However, certain
substations, due to their proximity to ground water resources, open water or designated
wetlands, the quantity of oil on site, surrounding topography, soil characteristics, etc.,
have or will have a higher potential for discharging harmful quantities of oil into the
environment.
279
pentaerythritol and saturated carboxylic acids (examples: Midel® 7131) is fully
biodegradable, and has found application in traction and power transformers.
The new fluid has an obvious advantage over conventional transformer fluids for use in
locations where oil spills are of great concern. Currently, large oil spills, whether
mineral oil or vegetable oil, require clean-up. However, for smaller spills clean-up may
not be mandatory for vegetable oils. Since distribution transformers carry only limited
amounts of oil (up to a few hundred gallons), there will not be any large spills. The EPA
still needs to relax some of the restrictions imposed for vegetable oil spills and clean-up
before their widespread use become economical for utilities. Other regulatory agencies
at the state level also may need to change their rules for oil spills.
280
8 ECONOMICS OF TRANSFORMER ASSET MANAGEMENT
8.1 FAILURE STATISTICS FOR POWER TRANSFORMERS
In the sections that follow, typical failure rates and causes for large populations of
transformers are presented. It is important to note that a utility company may experience
failure rates that are vastly different from the numbers presented here. As mentioned
above, failure rates depend on many factors, some of which may be specific to a given
utility (maintenance practices, system design practices, geography, etc.). It is important
that each company keeps accurate records of failures and analyses of root causes of
failures. This will allow the development of effective corrective measures to prevent
similar future failures.
The failure rate, in percent per year, is calculated according to the following equation:
30
The data received from the USA was in summary form and was therefore not integrated into the CIGRE study.
281
ny
λ 100 u
Ny
where :
n y Total number of failed transformers in a given year
Ny Total component − years of transformers installed on the system during the year
In this particular study, the failure rates were calculated for different categories of
transformers: by voltage class (60-100 kV, 100-300 kV, and 300-700 kV); by type (GSU,
substation transformers, and auto transformers); by regulation (LTC or no LTC); and by
age (0-5, 5-10, and 10-20 years). Other than for the classification by age of unit, only
failures involving forced outages were considered. Figure 8-1 shows the summary of
failure rates by type and voltage class of the transformers in the study.
14
12
60 - <100 kV
100 - <300 kV
10
Failure Rate (% / year)
300 - <700 kV
All Voltages
8
0
GSU/ GSU/ Substation/ Substation/ Auto/ Auto/ ALL/ ALL/
LTC No LTC LTC No LTC LTC No LTC LTC No LTC
Transformer Type
The following comments were made by the working group concerning the results of the
survey:
x For GSU transformers with LTC, the failure rate is considerably affected by the
increase in the winding voltage. This also happens in the case of auto
282
transformers, while in the case of substation transformers, there appear to be no
significant variations.
x The lower failure rates shown for auto transformers with LTC are somewhat
surprising. Auto transformers without LTC show higher failure rates than the units
with LTC. A detailed analysis showed that a concentration of the reported failures
were from groups of units from specific networks. This inevitably skewed the
failure rates towards higher values that are not entirely representative of this
class and type of transformer.
x A general failure rate, irrespective of the voltage class or function, is of the order
of 2 %/year.
x When no distinction is made with regards to whether a unit has LTC or not, the
failure rates seem to increase with voltage (and therefore probably with rated
power).
The data was also classified by age of the units and by voltage class. The resulting
failure rates are shown in Figure 8-2. The data shows that, other than for the voltage
class, 300 - < 700 kV, there is no significant increase in failure rates with the age of
the units. For the lower voltage units, failure rates tend to decrease slowly with age.
5
Age of Unit (years)
0-5
4
Failure Rate (% / years)
>5 - 10
>10 - 20
3
0
60 - <100 100 - <300 300 - <700
Voltage Class (kV)
Figure 8-2: Failure Rate as a Function of Unit Age and Voltage Class
This section contains a summary of forced outage statistics reported by the Canadian
Electricity Association for all transformer failures in Canada and covering the period
283
January 1, 1998 to December 31, 2002. The data is presented for different voltage
classes and three phase bank (one three phase bank or three single phase bank)
configurations. The total number of component years for this period was 24,211 years
(roughly half of the number for the CIGRE study in the preceding section). The
distribution of component years by voltage class and type of three phase bank is shown
in Figure 8-3.
9000
6000
5000
4000
3000
2000
1000
0
109kV 110-149kV 150-199kV 200-299kV 300-389kV 500-599kV 600-799kV
Voltage Class
Figure 8-3: Distribution of Component Years by Voltage Class (CEA Forced Outage Report)
Figure 8-4 and Figure 8-5 show the average failure rates for each of the voltage
classifications and the mean duration it takes to return the bank to service after a forced
outage. From the reported data, the following comments can be made:
x If all the failures are considered without regard to voltage class, three phase units
on this system fail twice as often as single phase units in a bank.
x It takes approximately twice as much time to restore a three phase unit back to
service as it take to restore single phase units in a bank.
x The highest failure rates in one three phase bank and three single phase banks
occurred in the 150-199 kV voltage class. These units comprise only 2% of the
entire population of units reported.
x The failure rate for the entire set of reported data is on the order of 5.5%.
284
20%
Three Single Phase Units
18%
One Three Phase Unit
16%
All Tank Configurations
Failure Rate (per year)
14%
12%
10%
8%
6%
4%
2%
0%
109kV 110-149kV 150-199kV 200-299kV 300-389kV 500-599kV 600-799kV ALL
VOLTAGES
Voltage Class
Figure 8-4: Failure Rate by Voltage Class of Transformers on the Canadian Power Grid
4500
4000
Three Single Phase Units
3500 One Three Phase Unit
Mean Duration (Hrs)
2500
2000
1500
1000
500
0
109kV 110-149kV 150-199kV 200-299kV 300-389kV 500-599kV 600-799kV ALL
VOLTAGES
Voltage Class
Figure 8-5: Mean Duration of Failures by Voltage Class of Transformers on Canadian Power Grid
The failure data was reported according to the failed subcomponent. Figure 8-6 shows a
distribution of contributions to failures by subcomponents according to voltage class and
without regard to bank configuration. The subcomponent category classified as “other”
285
is the catch-all category for cases where the origin of the failure is not clearly evident. Of
the remaining categories, LTCs contribute to the most failures for most voltage classes.
60
Bushings (Including C.T.'s)
Windings
On-Load Tap Changer
50
Core
Leads
% Contribution to Failures
Cooling Equipment
40
Auxiliary Equipment
Other
30
20
10
0
109kV 110-149kV 150-199kV 200-299kV 300-389kV 500-599kV 600-799kV
Voltage Class
In a time of increasing competition and deregulation within the electrical power supply
industry, increasing attention has to be paid to cost cutting and economical issues.
Transformers are important elements of a power system. They are important not only to
power system performance and reliability of supply, but also to the financial
performance of companies. The technical complexities of transformers, as well as their
high capital costs and long lifetimes, are important elements in the power system asset
management process.
286
8.2.2 GENERAL CONCEPT FOR ECONOMICS OF TRANSFORMER MANAGEMENT
The financial aspects related to service activities should be integrated into a more
general concept where the following issues are considered:
x Risk management
x Specification and purchase
x Operation and maintenance
x Decision process: repair - refurbishment - replacement
CIGRE has issued a guide where all these steps have been considered, based on
practical experiences accumulated in multiple countries [148].
ABB has developed different simulation models to study transformer populations [149]
or specific units [150]. The economic analysis associated with the decision to maintain,
refurbish or replace can best be done on a life cycle cost (LCC) basis. A traditional
approach to LCC treats future costs as being fixed and their net present value (NPV) is
considered. The cost of refurbishment or replacement is set for particular times in each
case. In case of refurbishment, variables such as failure rate shall be adjusted to the
condition of the units and an improvement level shall be admitted in relation to the
maintenance action taken. The basic LCC equation is:
n
LCC C A + C E + C I + ∑ (CPM + CC M + COP + COo + C R ) + CD
0
x Safety
x Condition
x Age
x Operation condition
x Availability
x Maintainability
x Environmental aspects
x Legislation
x Risk
287
These criteria are not necessarily independent; some overlap will occur. For example, a
particular risk may be related to an environmental issue; obsolete equipment may still
be maintainable and so on. Risks associated with safety overlap economics, system
availability, maintainability, environmental and legislation criteria. Also, the owner may
choose to apply some or all of the criteria to individual transformers.
The transformers represent a large monetary value and this asset must be managed,
from both short and medium/long term perspectives. A significant part of typical
transformer populations is now 30-40 years old and is approaching an age where the
reliability becomes questionable. However, no reliable information is available regarding
the lifetime of transformers. Nevertheless, the future investment needs will in some way
be dependent on the age distribution. It is obvious that there will be limitations in
available capital for future investments. This leads to a need to lower the peak of the
investments and to distribute the investments over a longer period of time. There is
therefore a need to formulate and implement long term refurbishment and replacement
strategies. Such strategies must be based on sound financial considerations and should
be communicated and quantified in economical terms. The return on investment should
be maximized under given constraints, e.g. a specified level of availability. Along with
the trend towards penalties for unavailability, the risk costs have become increasingly
important and should be a part of the formulation of the types of strategies that are
discussed. Furthermore, the implementation of such strategies will require new tools
and methods to identify the highest risk units within the population [151,152].
The basic principle of the model is to minimize the total cost function for the entire
population with respect to the total investment need. It is hence the sum of all capital
expenditures over the studied time period that is minimized. The cost function is a sum
of capitalized cost components. Cash flow effects and availability of capital are not
considered.
- financial information, e.g. internal rate of return, depreciation time, current energy
price
- population data, e.g. number of units and total installed MVA per year
- general transformer data for the population, e.g. average load rate, losses, failure
frequency as function of time, repair time
- general financial transformer data for the population, e.g. average acquisition
value, maintenance costs, repair costs, consequential costs upon failure, cost
and effect of refurbishment
The main cost components of the model are cost of capital, operational and
maintenance costs, cost for life extending actions, cost of losses and risk costs
288
including costs for repair, loss of production/revenues, and other costs, e.g.
environmental.
Risk costs are treated as the failure rate times the consequential costs of the failure.
The difficulty in all such calculations is that the shape of the bathtub curve, i.e. the
failure frequency as function of time, is not known in detail. In this work, it is assumed
that the owner of a network, together with the equipment manufacturer, can make fair
estimates of best and worse case scenarios for the bathtub curve of that particular
population. Based on the use of these scenarios, we can build an estimate of the future
investment needs. The model is designed in such a way that the estimated bathtub
curve can be modelled and entered as input.
In the model, it is assumed that the technical lifetime of a transformer can be extended
by refurbishment actions [153]. In the basic version, the types of action are not specified
but it is up to the user to define the cost of such actions and to estimate the effects. In
the advanced version, the types of action and their costs can be specified as well as the
improvement in lifetime.
The cost of losses influences the evaluation in the sense that a new transformer has
lower losses than an old transformer. Performance of power transformers has gradually
improved over the years. However, a significant step was taken with the introduction of
grain oriented, cold rolled core steel in the mid 60’s.
According to the wishes of the utility, the three scenarios below were considered:
No maintenance: no preventive actions except the very basic and mandatory actions
such as fixing oil leakages or changing the air-drying compound.
Light maintenance: basic maintenance plus oil and gas analysis, oil filtering and
drying, periodic on-load tap changer overhaul.
For each of these three scenarios, the optimization process was run to define which
transformer should be maintained or replaced by a new one and when. The graphs
289
presented in Figure 8-7 to Figure 8-9 show the capital that should be spent per year to
maintain (blue bars) and replace old units (red bars) in order to operate the network
during the next 25 years with the requested reliability level.
Figure 8-8 : Scenario 2: Light maintenance. Net Present Value = 3.8 MEUR
Figure 8-9 : Scenario 3:Heavy maintenance. Net Present Value= 2.2 MEUR
The net present value of the costs to operate, maintain and renew the fleet over the 25
coming years varies between 2.2 and 4.5 millions Euros depending on the scenario. In
this specific case, refurbishing the transformers (scenario 3: heavy maintenance) after
15 to 30 years depending on their condition is considered to be the best scenario from a
financial point of view.
290
8.2.5 CONCLUSIONS
The tool described in this section is a very important element in the strategic planning
process. It is used to evaluate future investments and to support decisions for
maintenance and repair. Two important aspects of the analysis should be emphasized:
a) the risk of failure should be evaluated precisely based upon the existing diagnostic
tools. This risk has the largest impact on the replacement policy and is often not taken
into account in the decision making process; b) maintenance actions should be defined
not only in terms of costs but also in terms of the benefits, such as lifetime extension.
291
References
292
17. Mark Perkins, Lars Pettersson, Nicolai Fantana, TV Oommen Steven Jordan,
“Transformer Life Assessment Tools and Methods”, Proceedings of the 2000
International Conference of Doble Clients, Section 8-1
18. M. Perkins, L. Pettersson, N. Fantana, TV Oommen, S. Jordan “Transformer Life
Assessment Tools with Specific Application to Nuclear Station Generator
Transformers” Proceedings of the IEEE EIC/EMCW Conference, Cincinnati, Ohio,
October 26-26, 1999, pp. 685-690
19. Asim Fazlagic, Mark Perkins, “Transformer Life and Condition Assessment -
Overview of Tools and Methods”, 2000 EUCI Condition Assessment of Power
Transmission & Distribution Systems Conference, December 6-8, 2000, Denver –
Colorado
20. Excerpts from: Dielectric Diagnosis of Electrical Equipment for AC Applications
and its Effects on Insulation Coordination – State of the Art Report, Presented by
Working Group 33/15.08, CIGRE 1990 Session, August 26- September 1, pp. 1-
34.
21. E.J. Rogers, L.E. Humbard, D.A. Gillies: “Instrumentation techniques for low-
voltage impulse testing of power transformers”, IEEE Trans. on PAS, May/June
1972
22. E.P. Dick, C.C. Erven, "Transformer diagnostic testing by frequency response
analysis”, IEEE Trans. on PAS, Nov. /Dec. 1978.
23. G. Zafferani, "Contribution of diagnostic techniques on large power transformers to
the Improvement of service reliability", Proc. of AEI Annual Meeting. Trieste, 1980,
Paper II.1.22
24. E. Dornenburg, W.Strittmatter, “Monitoring oil-cooled transformers by gas
analysis", Brown Boveri Review No. 5, May 1974.
25. CIGRE W6 15.01, “Detection of and research for the characteristics of an incipient
fault from analysis of dissolved gases in the oil of an insulation", Electra No. 42,
Oct. 1975.
26. G. Belanger, M. Duval, "Monitor for hydrogen dissolved in transformer oil". IEEE
Trans. on EI, Oct. 1977.
27. P.J. Burton, J. Graham et al., “Recent developments by CEGB to improve the
prediction and monitoring of transformer performance. CIGRE General Session
1984, Report 12-09.
28. W. Lampe, L. Petterson, et al., “Hot-spot measurements in power transformers",
CIGRE General Session 1984, Report 12-02.
29. R. Wilputte, M. Randoux, "Lessons drawn from the routine testing of insulating oils
used in power transformers on the Belgian network", CIGRE General Session
1986, Report 12-07.
30. J.F. Morel, G. Wind, ''Detection et localization des decharges partiellee par ultra-
sons", RGE No. 1, Jan. 1970.
293
31. R.T. Harrold, "Acoustic waveguides for sensing and locating electrical discharges
within high voltage transformers and other apparatus", IEEE Trans. on PAS, Apr.
1983.
32. CIGRE WG 12.01, "Measurement of partial discharges in transformers", Electra
No. 19, Nov. 1971.
33. AIEE Std. 505-1955, "Test code for power-factor (dissipation factor) testing of
power transformers"
34. ANSI/IEEE Std. 21 – 1976, "General requirements and test procedures for outdoor
apparatus bushings”
35. EEMAC Standard GL1-3 -1979, "Power transformer and reactor bushings"
36. IEC Publ. 137 (1984), "Bushings for Alternating Voltages above 1000 V”
37. Doble Client Committee on Circuit-Breakers and Bushings, "Bushing Field-Test
Guide”, Document BG661
38. A. Bargigia, M. De Nigris, C. Masetti, “Most recent developments in surge arrester
testing", Proc. 56th Int. Conf. of Doble Clients. Boston, Apr. 1989.
39. S.Shirakawa et al., "Maintenance of surge arresters by a portable leakage current-
detector", IEEE Trans. on PWRD, July 1988
40. J. Lundquist, L. Stenstrom et al., "New method of the resistive leakage currents on
metal-oxide surge arresters in service", IEEE PES Summer Meeting. Long Beach.
CA, July 1989, Paper 89SM817-8 PWRD.
41. Y. Du, M. Zahn, B.C. Lesieutre, A. V. Mamishev and S. Lindgren, ”Moisture
Equilibrium in Transformer Paper-Oil Systems”, IEEE Electrical Insulation
Magazine, Vol. 15, No. 1, pp. 11-20, January/February 1999.
42. J. Fabre amd A. Pichon, “Deteriorating Processes and Products of Paper in Oil –
Application to Transformers”, 1960 CIGRE Conference, Paris, France, Paper 137,
1960
43. L. E. Lundgaard et. al., ”Ageing of oil-impregnated paper in power transformers”,
2002 IEEE Power Delivery Transactions – Derived from data presented in Table 2
44. H. P. Moser, Transformerboard, Special Print in Scientia Electrica, Translated by
EHV-Weidmann Limited, St. Johnsbury, Vermont, Section C, 1979
45. W. A. Fessler, et. al., ”Bubble Formation in Transformers”, EPRI Report EL-5384,
EPRI, Palo Alto, CA, August 1987
46. FIST 3-5 Maintenance of Liquid Insulation: Mineral Oils and Askarels, US Dept. of
Interior, Bureau of Reclamation, 1992
47. T. V. Oommen, “Moisture Equilibrium in Paper-Oil Systems”, Proceedings of the
Electrical/Electronics Insulation Conference, Chicago, IL, pp. 162-166, October 3-
6, 1983
48. Tables are taken from IEEE Std. C57.106-2002
294
49. C. M. Bruce, J.D. Christie and P. Griffin, 55th Annual Conference of Doble Clients,
1988 Ed., Section 10-9.1.
50. Table 13, Transformer Maintenance Manual, FIST 3-30, United States
Department of the Interior, Bureau of Reclamation, October 2000
51. H. Moore, “Factors Affecting the Health and Life of Transformers”, Proceedings of
TechCon 2000, page 11.
52. P.M. Balma, R. C. Degeneff, H. R. Moore, L. B. Wagenaar, “The Effect of Long
Term Operation and System Conditions on the Dielectric Capability and Insulation
Coordination of Large Power Transformers”, IEEE Transactions on Power
Delivery, Vol. 14, No. 3, July 1999.
53. T.V. Oommen, “Bubble Generation During Transformer Overload”, EPRI Report
EL-6761, March 1990
54. T.V. Oommen, “Further Experimentation on Bubble Generation During
Transformer Overload”, EPRI Report EL-7391, March 1992
55. T.V. Oommen, E.M. Petrie and S.R. Lindgren, “Bubble Generation in Transformer
Windings Under Overload Conditions”, Paper 8E, Doble Client Conference, March
1995
56. T.V. Oommen and S.R. Lindgren, “Bubble Evolution from Transformer Overload”,
IEEE Transmission and Distribution Conference, October, 2001
57. United States Department of the Interior (Bureau of Reclamation), Transformer
Maintenance Manual, Facilities Instructions, Standards and Techniques, Volume
3-30, October 2000
58. John C. Drotos, John W. Porter, Randy Stebbins, “Dissolved Gas Analysis of
Transformer Oil”, published by the S.D. Myers Co., 1996
59. Martin Heath Cote Associates, “Maintenance of High Voltage Transformers”,
London, England, 1989
60. B. Fallou, “Detection and Research for the Characteristics of an Incipient Fault
From Analysis of Dissolved Gases in the Oil of an Insulation”, Elecktra, No. 42, pp.
31-52, 1975
61. IEEE Standard C57.104-1991 – Guide for the Interpretation of Gases Generated
in Oil-Immersed Transformers.
62. United States Department of the Interior (Bureau of Reclamation), Transformer
Maintenance Manual, Facilities Instructions, Standards and Techniques, Volume
3-30, October 2000
63. R. R. Rogers, “IEEE and IEC Codes to Interpret Incipient Faults in Transformers
Using Gas in Oil Analysis”, CEGB Transmission Division, Guilford, England, 1995
64. International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC 60599 Edition 2), Mineral Oil-
Impregnated Electrical Equipment in Service Interpretation of Dissolved and Free
Gas Analysis, 1999
295
65. T. V. Oommen, “Adjustments to Gas-in-Oil Analysis Data Due to Gas Distribution
Possibilities in Power Transformers”, IEEE Transactions on Power Apparatus and
Systems, Vol. PAS-101, No. 6 June 1982, pp. 1716-1722
66. United States Department of the Interior (Bureau of Reclamation), Transformer
Diagnostics Manual, Facilities Instructions, Standards and Techniques, Volume 3-
31, June 2003
67. T.V. Oommen and E.M. Petrie, “Particle Contamination in Oil-Filled Large Power
Transformers”, IEEE PES Winter Meeting, New York, January 31-February 5,
1982
68. T.V. Oommen, “Particle Counting Of Transformer Oil: Impact Of the New Standard
Based On Medium Test Dust Calibration”, Doble Conference Proceedings, March
2004.
69. ISO 4406-1999, “Hydraulic fluid power – Fluids – Method for coding the level of
contamination by solid particles”
70. ISO 11171, “Hydraulic Fluid Power – Calibration of Automatic Particle Counters
for Liquids”, Available from American National Standards Institute, 11 West 42nd
Street, New York, NY 10036
71. CIGRE Brochure N° 157, – Effect of Particles on Transformer Dielectric Strength,
November 1999
72. P.J. Sinz, Der Einfluss von Feuchte und Partikeln auf die elektrische Festigkeit
von Isolierölen. Ph.D work Technical University, Graz, Austria, 1990.
73. C. Vincent, N.G. Trinh, R. Olivier, J. Aubin, “Behavior of an oil-paper interface in
presence of carbon particle contamination,” IEEE International Symposium on
Electrical Insulation, Pittsburgh, USA, June 1994.
74. NETA Maintenance Testing Specifications for Electric Power Distribution
Equipment and Systems, Page 193
75. H. Horning, J. Kelly, S. Myers, ”Transformer Maintenance Guide”, Second Edition,
2001.
76. A. L. Rickley and R. E. Clark, “Transformer Exciting Current Measured with Doble
Equipment (A Progress Report)”, Doble Client Conference Report, Sec. 6:1001 -
1008, 1971.
77. Paul Gill, “Electrical Power Equipment Maintenance and Testing”, Marcel Dekker,
Inc., 1998.
78. ”A Basic Guide to Thermography”, A LAND Instruments International document
(www.landinst.com), 2004.
79. Z. Azmat and D. Turner, “Infrared Thermography and its Role in Rural Utility
Environment”, Rural Electric Conference, 8-10 May 2005, pp. B2/1-B2/4.
80. IEEE C57.119-2001, “Recommended Practice for performing temperature rise
tests”, page 10.
296
81. Bob Turnbull and Steve McConnell, Southern California Edison, "How Infrared
Thermography helps Southern California Edison Improve Grid Reliability",
InfraMation 2000 Proceedings Volume 1. Available on the internet at
http://www.flirthermography.com/media/027turnbull.pdf.
82. Niancang Houm “The Infrared Thermography Diagnostic Technique of High-
Voltage Electrical Equipments with Internal Faults”, International Conference on
Power Systems Technology (POWERCON), Vol. 1, 18-21 August 1998, pp. 110-
115.
83. Excerpts from ABB Contact, March 1998, Special No. 1.
84. Tord Bengtsson, et. al., “Acoustic Diagnosis of Tap Changers”, CIGRE, Paper 12-
101, 1996
85. Rick Youngblood, et. al., “Application of DGA to Detection of Hot Spots in Load
Tap Changers”, Minutes of the Sixtieth Annual International Conference of Doble
Clients, 1993, Sec. 6-4
86. Rick Youngblood, et. al., “Application of DGA to Detection of Hot Spots in Load
Tap Changers”, Minutes of the Sixtieth Annual International Conference of Doble
Clients, 1993, Sec. 6-4
87. M. Duval, “A Review of Faults Detectable by Gas-In-Oil Analysis in Transformers”,
IEEE Electrical Insulation Magazine, May/June 2002, Vol. 18, No. 3. pp. 8-17
88. F. Jakob, K. Jacob, S. Jones, R. Youngblood, “A Nomograph for Interpretation of
LTC-DGA Data, NETA Conference, San Antonio, March 15, 2004
89. C. Sweeter and T. McGrail, “Sweep Frequency Response Analysis – A Technical
Paper from Doble Engineering”, Ver. 1.0, January 2003.
90. Various SFRA Case Studies given on Doble Engineering Website
(www.doble.com), used by permission of Doble Engineering.
91. Ryder, Simon. “Frequency Response Analysis for Diagnostic Testing of Power
Transformers”. Electricity Today Magazine Article, Issue 0601, 2006.
92. T. V. Oommen, “Electrical Insulation Materials and Applications”, ABB publication,
November 1989
93. A. M. Elmsley and G. C. Stevens, “ A Reassessment of the Low Temperature
Thermal Degradation of Cellulose”, 6th International Conference of Dielectric
Materials, Measurement Applications, UK, pp. 229-232, 1992
94. L. E. Lundgaard et. al., ”Ageing of oil-impregnated paper in power transformers”,
2002 IEEE Power Delivery Transactions.
95. T. K. Saha, “Review of Modern Diagnostic Techniques for Assessing Insulation
Condition in Aged Transformers”, IEEE Transactions on Dielectrics and Electrical
Insulation, Vol. 19, No. 5, October 2003
297
96 B. Pahlavanpour et al. , “Experimental Investigation into the Thermal-ageing of
Kraft Paper and Mineral Insulating Oil”, IEEE Int. Symp. On Electrical Insulation,
Boston, MA, pp. 341-345, 2002
97. D. J. T. Hill et. al., “A Study If Degradation Of Cellulosic Insulation In Power
Transformers – Part 2: Tensile Strength Of Paper”, IEE Proceedings On Scientific
Measurement Techniques, Volume 147, pp 285-290, 2000
98. H. P. Moser et. al., Transformerboard II, Rapperswill, Switzerland: H. Weidmann
AG, 1987
99. P. J. Burton et al. “Recent Developments by CEGB to Improve Prediction and
Monitoring of Transformer Performance, CIGRE paper number 12-09, 1984
100. Mineral Insulating Oils – Method for Determining 2-Furfural and Related
Compounds, IEC Document 61198, 1993.
101. T.V. Oommen, E. M. Petrie, R. B. van Breemen and C. A. Heney, “Analysis of
Furanic Compounds from Cellulose Aging by GC-MS and Attempts to Correlate
with Degree of Polymerization”, CIGRE Berlin Symposium, April 1993.
102. S. M. Ortel, “The Colorimetric Analysis of 2-Furfuraldehyde in Transformer Oil”,
Doble Conference Paper 10A-1, 1992.
103. B. Pahlavanpour and A. Wilson, “Analysis of Transformer Oil for Transformer
Condition Monitoring”, IEE Colloquim on An Engineering Review of Liquid
Insulation, Digest No. 1997/003, 1997
104. A. DePablo, “Furanic Compound Analysis: a Toll for Predictive Maintenance of
Oil-Filled Electrical Equipment”, CIGRE Task Force Report 15.01.03
105. X. Chendong et. al., “To Estimate the Ageing Status of Transformers by Furfural
Concentration in the Oil”, CIGRE Committee 33 Colloquium, Leningrad, Moscow,
1991.
106. A. DePablo, “Furfural and Ageing: How They Are Related”, IEE Power Division
Colloquium Insulating Liquids, National Grid Leatherhead, UK, 1999
107. B. Pahlavanpour, “Power Transformer Insulation Ageing”, CIGRE SC 15
Symposium, Sydney, Australia, 1995
108. A.B Shkolnik, K. M. Bigin and J.J. Kelly (SD Myers Inc.), “Creating a Preliminary
Model for Estimating Degree of Polymerization of Thermally Upgraded Paper
Based on Furan Concentrations in Transformer Oil”, Doble Conference Paper,
Boston, MA, April 1999
109. A. M. Emsley et. al., “Degradation of Cellulosic Insulation in Power Transformers.
Part 3: Effects of Oxygen and Water on Ageing in Oil”, IEE Proc. Sci.,
Measurement Techniques, Vol. 147, pp. 115-119, 2000
110. A. M. Emsley et. al., “Degradation of Cellulosic Insulation in Power Transformers.
Part 2: Formation of Furan Products in Insulating Oil”, IEE Proc. Sci.,
Measurement Techniques, Vol. 147, pp. 115-119, 2000
298
111. T.V. Oommen, “Cellulose Insulation in Power Transformers: How Long Shall We
Keep It?”, TechCon Conference Paper, San Diego, Jan, 2005
112. M. Perkins, G. Frimpong, A. Fazlagic, “Dielectric Frequency Response
Measurement as a Tool for Troubleshooting Insulation Power Factor Problems,
IEEE ISEI Conference Paper, Boston, MA, April 2002
113. U. Gafvert, G. Frimpong, J. Fuhr, “Modeling of Dielectric Measurements on Power
Transformers”, CIGRE 1998 Session Paper, 08/31/98
114. G. Frimpong, M. Perkins, A. Fazlagic, U. Gafvert, “Estimation of Moisture in
Cellulose and Oil Quality of Transformer Insulation Using Dielectric Response
Measurements”, Doble Client Conference, Paper 8M, Boston, MA, 2001
115. Derived from Chapter 9 of “Testing of Power Transformers – Routine Tests, Type
Tests and Special Tests”, ABB Publication, October 2003
116. IEC Standard 60270, Partial Discharge Measurements, 2000
117. IEEE Standard C57.113, IEEE Guide for Partial Discharge Measurements in
Liquid Filled Power Transformers and Shunt Reactors
118. From Power Diagnostix website - http://www.power-technology.com/ contractors/
pressure/power_diagnostix/power_diagnostix2.html
119. Lars Jonnson, “Advanced transformer control and monitoring with TEC”, ABB
Review, Volume 4, 2004.
120. D.Chu, A. Lux, “On-Line Monitoring of Power Transformers and Components: A
Review of Key Parameters”, Proceedings of Electrical Insulation Conference and
Electrical Manufacturing & Coil Winding Conference, 26-28 Oct 1999, pp.669-675.
121. Trevor Lord and Graham Hodge (Lord Consulting, AVO New Zealand), “On-Line
Monitoring as a Strategic Tool to Enhance Supply System Reliability”,
http://www.avo.co.nz/techpapers/on-line-monitor/strategictool.php.
122. Rahmat Shoureshi, Tim Norick, Ryan Swartzendruber, “Intelligent Transformer
Monitoring System Utilizing Neuro-Fuzzy Technique Approach”, PSerc Publication
04-26, July 2004.
123. Tony Pink, Peter Stewart, “Power Transformer Control System Developments”,
TechCon® 2004 North America.
124. Yong Liang, “Simulation of Top-Oil temperature for Transformers”, PSerc
Publication 01-21, Feb 2001.
125. P. Köstinger, T.M. Bruarøy: “Drying of power transformers in the field, applying the
LFH-Technology in combination with oil reclamation”, Cigre 2006.
126. V. Sokolov et al ,Moisture Equilibrium and Moisture Migration within Transformer
Insulation Systems, CIGRE WG 12.18, Dublin, 2001
127. B. Fallou R.G.E Tome 79 No8 Sept. 1970
128. H.P. Moser/ V. Dahinden Transformerboard II Weidmann 1987
299
129. V.W.Montsinger. Loading transformers by temperature“, Trans AIEE, April 1930,
pp 886-192
130. A.M.Emsley,, G.C.Stevens: “Review of chemical indicators of degradation of
cellulosic electrical paper insulation in oil-filled transformers”, IEE Proc. Sci. Meas.
Technol., Vol. 141, No. 5, September 1994, pp. 324-334.
131. J.Fabre, A.Pichon : “ Deteriorating processes and products of paper in oil.
Application to transformers”, CIGRÉ paper 137, (Paris), 1960.
132. H.P.Moser, V.Dahinden et al.: “Application of cellulosic and non cellulosic
materials in power transformers”, Cigre paper 12-12, Paris, 1986.
133. L.E.Lundgaard, W.Hansen, D.Linhjell: “Ageing of Kraft and thermally upgraded oil
impregnated paper “, Nord-IS 05, Trondheim, 2005
134. L.Lundgaard, W.Hansen, D.Linhjell and T.Painter, (2002) Ageing of Oil
Impregnated paper in power transformers”, IEEE Trans Pow.Del., Vol 19, No.1,
2004, pp 230-238.
135. L.E.Lundgaard, W.Hansen; S.Ingebrigtsen, D.Linhjell, M.Dahlund“ Aging of Kraft
paper by acid catalyzed hydrolysis“ ICDL, 2005, Coimbra
136. S.Ingebrigtsen , M.Dahlund; W.Hansen, D.Linhjell, L.E.Lundgaard: “Solubility of
carboxylic acids in Paper (Kraft)-Oil Systems”, CEIDP, Boulder, Colorado, 2004
137. P.Koestinger et al. Practical experience with the drying of power transformers in
the field, applying the LFH Technology, Cigre meeting Paris 2004
138. Ø. Berg et al., Experiences from on-site transformer oil reclaiming, Cigre meeting
Paris 2002
139. ABB Transformer Handbook, Rev 02, Sections 9.4-9.4.15, 2004.
140. IEEE C57.125 - IEEE Guide for Failure Investigation, Documentation, and
Analysis fro Power Transformers and Shunt Reactor.
141. ABB Transformer Handbook, Rev 02, Sect. 14, 2004
142. ABB Transformer Handbook, Rev 02, Sect. 3, 2004
143. CIGRE Brochure N° 221, “Improving The Impact of Existing Substations on the
Environment”, 2003
144. J. Vierengel et. al., “Use of Active Noise Control (ANC) Technology to Quiet Power
Transformers”, CIGRE Report N° 12-301, 1998
145. T. V. Oommen and C. C. Claiborne, “Biodegradable Insulating Fluid from High
Oleic Vegetable Oils”, CIGRE Report 15-302, 1998
146. An International Survey of Failures in Large Power Transformers in Service,
ELECTRA No. 88, pp. 21-48, 1983
147. Forced Outage Performance of Transmission Equipment, Canadian Electricity
Association Report for the Period January 1, 1998 to December 31, 2002,
pp. 80-95.
300
148. Brochure CIGRE N° 248-2004 – Guide on Economics of Transformer
Management.
149. C. Bengtsson, J-O. Persson, M. Svenson, Replacement- and refurbishment
strategies for transformer populations, CIGRE Colloquium SC 12, Dublin, 2001.
150. P. Boss, T. Horst, P. Lorin, K. Pfammatter, A. Fazlagic, M. Perkins, Life
Assessment of Power Transformers to Prepare a Rehabilitation based on a
Technical –Economical Analysis, Report 12-106, CIGRE SC 12, Session 2002.
151. L. Pettersson, N.L. Fantana and U. Sundermann, “Life Assessment: Ranking of
Power Transformers Using Condition Based Evaluation, A New Approach”,
CIGRE Paris Conference Paper 12-204, 1998 Session
152. L. Pettersson, J.O. Persson, N.L. Fantana and K. Walldén, “Condition Based
Evaluation of Net Transformers, - Experience from a New Ranking
Proceedure”, CIGRE Paris Conference Paper 12-108, 2002 Session
153. T. Grestad & K. Renström, "Experiences From Oil Reclaimed on Energized Power
Transformers", International Conference Power Transformers 6-7 April 2000, New
Delhi, India, Sect. III, p125-134
154. O. Berg, K. Herdlevar, M. Dahlund, K. Renström, A. Danielsen, U. Thiess,
“Experiences from on-site transformer oil reclaiming”, Paper 12-103, CIGRE Paris
Session 2002
155. P. Koestinger, E. Aronsen, P. Boss, “Practical experience with the drying of power
transformers in the field, applying the Low Frequency Heating Technology (LFH)“,
Paper A2-205, CIGRE Paris Session 2004
301
302
Index
Core 18, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 129,
A
133, 135, 136, 139, 153, 178, 204,
Accessories........................ 66, 141, 224 205, 206, 224, 226, 252
Accessory failures ........................ 59, 68 Core Ground ............................ 135, 205
Acetylene ...... 91, 94, 98, 102, 103, 173, Corona discharges ............. 71, 158, 275
174, 175 Corrosive Sulphur............................... 78
Acid Number ...................................... 77
Advanced DGA (ADGA) ................... 112 D
Advanced Diagnostics Brochure ...... 347 Degree of Polymerization (DP)......... 191
Ageing Dehalogenation
see Aging 71, 172, 192, 234, 235, 237 of oils ............................................ 274
Aging .......................... 90, 224, 225, 226 DETC ....................... 178, 184, 245, 252
Air Cleaner Fine Test Dust (ACFTD) DGA
.............................................. 113, 114 Oil Sampling Procedure.................. 92
Ambient temperature........................ 100 see Dissolved gas analysis 46, 59, 62,
ASEA........................................ 259, 261 63, 77, 91, 92, 97, 101, 102, 103,
Axial Collapse .................................. 186 105, 108, 109, 112, 121, 135, 148,
149, 171, 172, 174, 250
B
Dielectric Frequency Response
Bubble Evolution ................................ 87 Signature (DFRS) 203, 204, 205, 206,
Bushing 207, 208, 209
Condenser Bushing Construction ... 28 Dissipation factor.......................... 85, 86
Oil Sampling ................................. 146 Drying
Power Factor Measurement 150, 153, Insulation system drying ...... 238, 244,
156 267, 271
Type T .................................. 165, 166
Type U . 156, 157, 159, 160, 161, 162, E
164 Economics
Bushings .......................................... 232 Management of transformer fleets 286
Electromagnetic Fields (EMF) .. 274, 275
C
Ethane................ 91, 103, 173, 174, 175
Capacitance .. 21, 69, 71, 128, 129, 133, Ethylene ..... 91, 102, 103, 173, 174, 175
150, 151, 167, 168 Excitation current test....................... 137
Carbon dioxide ........................... 91, 173
Carbon monoxide ....................... 91, 173 F
Cellulose ............................ 80, 191, 194 Fans ................................................... 14
Charge relaxation ............................... 51 Fault localization .............................. 248
Coil Reblocking Brochure................. 359 Frequency response........... 69, 176, 224
Condenser bushings .................. 28, 152 Frequency response analysis.... 69, 176,
Conductivity...................................... 202 224
Coolers..................................... 246, 278
G
Cooling ............. 19, 20, 23, 26, 225, 228
Copper ............................................. 116 Gas chromatography.......................... 69
Gaskets .................... 246, 256, 260, 262
303
Ground Resistance................... 136, 206 Mechanism..................... 38, 42, 48, 256
Grounded specimen test (GST) ...... 127, Megger ............. 121, 123, 124, 135, 136
128, 129, 130, 131, 132, 133, 151, Methane ....... 91, 97, 103, 173, 174, 175
154, 155, 204 Moisture .. 69, 71, 72, 77, 78, 79, 81, 82,
Grounded specimen test with guard 83, 84, 144, 148, 169, 175, 201, 202,
(GST/g) 127, 128, 129, 130, 132, 133, 206, 228, 231, 234, 244, 254, 256,
151 271
Moloney............................................ 259
H
Monitoring 224, 225, 226, 228, 230, 231,
HIPOT .............................................. 256 232, 233
Hoop Buckling .................................. 187 MTD method of particle counting .... 113,
Hydrogen69, 91, 97, 102, 103, 172, 173, 114
174, 175, 224
Hydrolysis N
of Cellulose..................................... 75 Neutralization Number........................ 76
Nitrogen...................................... 91, 173
I
Noise
Inductively coupled plasma (ICP) ..... 115 Control methods ........................... 277
Infrared......... 69, 71, 141, 142, 143, 145
Inhibitor ........................................ 77, 86 O
Insulation.......................................... 228 Oil immersed transformers ............... 121
Insulation resistance................. 124, 125 Oil level indicator .............................. 250
Insuldur ............ 100, 192, 193, 194, 196 Oil Preservation.................................. 96
Interfacial Tension ........................ 75, 77 Oil Reclaiming .................................. 245
Iron ............................. 21, 113, 115, 116 OLTC................................................ 228
On-line monitoring
K
ABB TEC Monitor ......................... 228
Karl Fischer ........................................ 83 ABB T-Monitor .............................. 228
Kraft paper .... 67, 78, 80, 156, 157, 158, Doble bushing monitor.......... 232, 233
191, 192, 194, 196 GE Hydran monitor ....................... 229
L Load tap changer.......................... 233
Moisture meter.............................. 231
Leakage current ................................. 73 Oommen .................................... 82, 107
Lightning........................................... 268 Ostwald Coefficient ............................ 99
Load tap changer Oxidation .............................. 76, 86, 256
Repair/Retrofit Brochure ............... 353 Oxygen..... 77, 91, 94, 96, 173, 234, 251
Load tap changer ............................. 233
Load tap changer P
Engineering, Parts & Service Paper contamination ........................ 207
Brochure ................................... 355 Paper degradation............................ 235
LTC .................................................. 228 Partial discharge ... 41, 71, 95, 107, 111,
M 149, 210, 224, 226
Particle analysis
Maintenance.. 32, 61, 87, 234, 241, 242, Effect on dielectric strength .......... 117
243, 244, 245, 246, 253, 254, 255, Particle count ................................... 117
256, 257, 258, 259, 261, 262 Polarization index ............................. 127
Mechanical stress .............................. 72
304
PolyChlorinated Biphenyls (PCB)...... 78, Diverter switch .......................... 35, 43
161, 165, 273, 274 Drive mechanism .......................... 225
Porcelain .................................. 145, 153 GE Type LR300 ............................ 257
Power factor ....................... 77, 127, 254 GE Type LR400 ............................ 257
GE Type LR500 ............................ 257
R
Maintenance and Service ............. 259
Refurbishment.................................. 263 Motor drive.............................. 48, 246
Repair....... 100, 142, 244, 250, 263, 265 Reactance type................... 36, 37, 38
Risk Assessment................................ 55 Reinhausen .......................... 259, 261
Mature Transformer Management Resistance type ........................ 39, 40
Program Brochure..................... 343 Stenestam ratio (DGA) ................. 172
Risk of accessory failure................. 62 Tap selector.................................... 48
Risk of dielectric failure................... 62 Westinghouse Type UTH.............. 258
Rogers Ratio .................... 105, 106, 107 Westinghouse Type UTT .............. 258
S Westinghouse Type UVT.............. 258
Westinghouse Type UVW............. 258
Sampling ..... 92, 93, 104, 113, 146, 147, Temperature 14, 74, 83, 85, 97, 98, 100,
148, 172, 259, 261 126, 142, 167, 170, 207, 208, 234,
Saturation..................................... 84, 85 238
Short circuit 68, 111, 151, 180, 224, 226, Total dissolved combustible gases
248, 249 (TDCG) ........... 91, 102, 103, 104, 110
Shorted Turns .......................... 189, 190 Tracking ................................... 111, 258
Single phase transformer ................. 179 Transformer Relocation Brochure .... 363
Sludge ................................................ 81 Turns ratio test (TTR) ....... 122, 123, 124
Spring Mechanism.............................. 30
Standards..... 28, 29, 150, 184, 213, 268 U
Stenestam ratio ................................ 172 Ungrounded Specimen Test (UST) ... 32,
Streaming Electrification 127, 128, 129, 131, 132, 133, 138,
Electrostatic Charging Tendency 150, 151, 154, 155, 204
(ECT) .............................. 50, 51, 53
Substation ........................................ 277 V
Supersaturation .................................. 87 Vacuum drying ................................. 238
Surface protection ............................ 247
W
Surge arresters .................................. 71
Water. 74, 78, 79, 80, 81, 84, 85, 86, 87,
T 192, 224, 257
Tank ......................... 129, 133, 224, 256 Winding Resistance.......................... 121
Tap Changer . 35, 42, 43, 44, 47, 48, 74, Windings . 125, 181, 182, 186, 207, 252,
108, 172, 173, 174, 225, 246, 256, 256
261, 262 Coil Reblocking Brochure ............. 359
Arcing tap switch............................. 35
305
ABB Transformers Service
General brochure
306
Transformers Service.
Dedication to service for a secure future.
307
Competence makes all the difference
Worldwide network.
Responsivness. Engineering and consulting
With optimal equipment redesign, analysis and expertise, proposal and
implementation of action plans and
training, you can form the basis for a successful future.
The total experience of ABB’s team of worldwide transformer experts
is at your disposal when it comes to solving complex problems.
• Competences when you need them
308
Preventive Maintenance
Condition enhancement and on site
refurbishment, supply of original spare
parts, tap changer rework, logistics and
transportation, 24 hours a day service
in order to guarantee the maximum
availability of the installation.
We are also your partner in the planningphase.
Our professional management
of the processes and site activity support
you in finding the optimal solution.
• Reduce Life Cycle Costs
309
A complete Portfolio of Service Solutions
310
Condition / Risk Assessment
Solid knowledge of the equipment status based on history,
design review and advanced diagnosis, anticipated fault detection,
corrective action planning enables greater reliability and
optimization of network assets.
• Move toward Condition Based Maintenance
311
Perfect Transformers care
Safe & environmentally friendly Safe & environmentally friendly Reduce outage program
End-user‘s Asset at performance level Trouble-free operation Get more out of aged assets
needs On-time delivery Maximized asset availability Extend life expectancy
Smooth hand-over Low operating cost (LCC) Optimize capital expenditure
Proven Planned & optimized investment
312
ABB the professional service provider
– just call your local ABB Specialist
313
314
ABB Transformers Service
Product leaflets
315
Transformer Service
“Condition Assessment”
A dedicated solutions for managing an aging
transformer population
A large proportion of the worldwide population is nearing
the end of its lifetime, and means are urgently required to
optimize transformer fleet performance through higher
availability. This has to be achieved at the lowest possible
cost and with minimum environmental impact.
Probability of
The cost of failure failure for
different families
Power transformers are often situated at strategically critical
of transformers
locations in power supply systems, and as a result the
financial consequences of their failure can easily exceed
their actual asset value.
The real challenge lies in implementing the right action at
the right time. Here, a definite trend has emerged: Asset
managers are moving from Time-Based Maintenance (TBM)
to Condition-Based Maintenance (CBM) or even Reliability-
Centered Maintenance (RCM), where decisions are no longer
driven by an average timeframe defined by observations and
past experience, but instead take into account the actual
condition of the equipment and the level of reliability Output of a population
required to fulfill its function. screening: condition of
Given that the average age of power transformers and the assets versus their
industrial transformers in most countries is around 25–30 importance
and 15–20 years, respectively, and considering the increase
of the typical failure probability with the transformer age,
actions clearly needs to be taken to ensure their continued
reliability and functionality.
Ten years ago, ABB began to develop a methodology for Step 1: Population screening
evaluating, in the field, the status of single and also whole
fleets of transformers, using non-invasive methods wherever Large fleets (100 units or more) are evaluated using data that
possible the methodology integrates knowledge accumulated are readily available, such as types of application, time in
by ABB over the past fifty years and involves more than operation, gas in oil, power factor, maintenance history and
ten different brands. major events, or experience with sister units The aim here is
This methodology, called condition assessment , has a to obtain a general ranking for the population, based on
modular structure, allowing the level of investigation to be technical and economic criteria, and to identify clusters of
adapted to a customer’s specific needs and the respective units requiring further investigation (step 2) or some basic
budget. Evaluations can be carried out progressively, maintenance. This screening also provides key information
beginning with a population screening (step 1), then moving for the estimation of a rough budget for future maintenance
onto the condition assessment (step 2) and, finally, to the or unit replacement, and identifies the units that should be
highly selective advanced evaluation or expertise (step 3) given priority. Budgeted investments in maintenance can be
more effectively allocated and optimized as a result of this
evaluation.
316
Step 2: Condition assessment • Dielectric response
• Partial discharge
A smaller number of units are selected from the step 1 process Step 3 provides a solid understanding of each unit’s condition,
for this evaluation. Step 2 re-uses basic information from step 1 and yields reliable information which can be used for
and brings in further information (eg, design reviews, site decision-making, eg whether to retrofit a unit or use it in
inspection reports, diagnostics data, input from monitoring another application. Step 3 is also useful for performing
systems), if available. Step 2 is much more structured to allow engineering surveys (overload capability, etc) or as an
the key properties (general, mechanical, thermal, electrical and expertise after a unit has failed.
accessories’) to be assessed separately and provides important Advanced evaluations of this kind provide accurate, reliable
information about the condition and suitability of the units with information, even in complex cases, allowing decisions to
respect to each of these properties. The maintenance, repair or be made quickly and efficiently. For example, it allows
retrofit work necessary to ensure top reliability for the units in owners to decide already on site whether or not a unit is to
their respective operating modes can then be defined. be retrofitted, repaired or scrapped. Time and costs are
saved as a result.
The three-step evaluation described has proved to be
Step 3: Expertise costefficient
for determining the status of transformers based on
The number of units is reduced again for step 3. Based this
different levels of information. With its status defined, the
time on information from steps 1 and 2, it incorporates
characteristics of each unit can be reviewed in terms of
317
Transformer Service
318
Two cases illustrating the importance
of spare parts planning
• Failure of a high voltage bushing on a 60 MVA,
132 kVA transformer
The lead time for a new high voltage bushing could be
up to 20 weeks, not including the transit time from the
factory to the site. Costs of non-delivery of energy may
be significant.
• Tapchangers require maintenance after a specified
number of operations and contacts are often replaced.
The lead time for contacts is at least 6 weeks not including
transit time. With contacts in stock, an unplanned maintenance
outage can be avoid.
319
Transformer Service
320
Conclusion
Low moisture content in the insulation system ensures a
significant increase in the life expectancy of a transformer.
ABB proposes a modern drying solution allowing higher
efficiency:
• Low residual moisture
• Extended lifetime
• Delayed investment
• Short processing time
• Shorter downtime
• Reduced costs
• On site process
• No transport time and costs
• Method to measure initial and remaining moisture based
on Dielectric Response diagnosis tests
• Quality control
321
Transformer Service
322
Example showing long lasting ABB’s oil reclamation method:
effect of oil reclaiming The total oil volume of the transformer is circulated several
times (8-12) over the absorption columns that are filled with
An example is presented – see graph below – where
Fullers earth. During the process Fullers earth is automatically
acidity is shown as function of year. In this particular case,
reactivated several times. With the conventional technique,
both oil change and reclaiming has been performed on
Fullers would have to be changed and disposed. The
two identical transformer. As we can see, acidity increases
reactivation method makes it economical possible to use
rapidly after the oil change. After a few years the acidity
sufficient Fullers earth (500-700 kg/ton oil) to remove ageing
level is nearly the same as before the oil change. This
products from the oil and also from the insulation. When
increase is caused by contamination from the residual oil
less absorbent is used or the oil is shifted the long-term
left in the tank and in the insulation, which contaminates
effect is not satisfactory. See also graph about oil ageing
the new oil.
after different measures.
Considering the transformer from which the oil was
In general it is always less costly to change oil for small
reclaimed, six years later the acidity level is approximately
transformers, <2 MVA than to reclaim it.
at the same low level. According to ABB’s worldwide
For transformers larger than >10 MVA it will be approximately
experience the acidity and other aging parameters, have
30 % more expensive to change oil compared to
acceptable values many years after reclaiming when using
reclaiming the oil.
sufficient absorbent (500-700 kg/ton oil).
Printed in Germany (10.04-03-PPI) We reserve the right to make changes in the course of technical development.
Conclusion
Reclaiming oil with reactivated Fullers earth is the only
economical method to restore the properties of the transformer
oil close to the values of new oil for long time. Reclaiming
oil provides an environmental advantage - instead of
replacing a non-renewable resource, the oil is processed.
323
Transformer Service
Combining more than 700 years of transformer manufacturing Other advantages of repair:
experience, ABB offers the following services for all
kinds and brands of transformers. • Repair takes less time so the unit could be in some cases
• Installation and commissioning back in use before the new unit is even out of assembly.
• Fleet screening and Condition Assessment ABB also improves lead-time by repairing old units in
• Spare parts dedicated service workshops or directly at site
• Field service • Long lead time items ordered in advance because the
• Redesign to current standards design is already available
• Full factory repair or upgrade /retrofit and testing • Footprint and arrangement does not change
• Leak proof gasket system
• Corrosion protection system
• Certified non-PCB oil
Transformer Repairs: • Short circuit performance is improved
• Improved materials: hi-density pressboard, harder
The ABB repair facilities have access to original design files, copper, and high temperature conductor insulation
documentation and technologies used over the last half
century within the ABB family* as well as the current
common design, manufacturing and quality practices used
by ABB transformer factories throughout the world. Quality
When a transformer fails, one of your major assets has
stopped producing but is still accruing costs. ABB knows ABB factories are ISO 9001 and ISO 14001 certified. ABB
transformer owners need their valuable assets up and believes in quality systems especially where the environment
working as soon as possible. As the largest transformer is concerned. ABB’s factories use special instructions
manufacturer in the world, ABB also knows the challenges to ensure proper handling of old and/or hazardous materials.
end-users face and how to meet them. Speed is usually Same Quality Plan is used for both new and repaired
crucial. transformers. Quality documentation follows the unit from
Depending on the condition of the failed unit, ABB will shipping to disassembly and all the way through the process
replace the defective or aged parts such as winding blocks, back to shipping to the customer site.
insulation kit, cleats and leads structures, core or accessories
according to the original design or to a new redesign with
improved short circuit withstand, lower losses, less noise,
different voltage level or extra power.
Before proposing any advise whether the unit shoud be
repaired at site or in a workshop, retrofited or simply
replaced by a new one, ABB usually perform a deep
diagnosis to assess the condition of the unit. It also allows
to pre-order some material and better plan the repair work
in order to reduce the lead time.
ABB uses state of the art design tools, highly efficient
process and manufacturing tools and its knowledge of new
materials to repair the failed unit or even to upgrade it by
improving its original features.
Repairing a transformer, instead of replacing it, can in
certain cases lower capital and maintenance cost dramatically * Note: ABB family meaning:
and provides quicker turnaround than buying new. An ABB, ACEC, ASEA, Ansaldo, Breda, BBC, CGE, Challenger, Elektrisk Bureau, Elta,
economical evaluation should be done on a case by case GE (> 40 MVA), GTE, Gould, IEL, ITC, ITE, Indelve, Industrial Design, Italtrafo,
Lepper, MFO, Marelli, Moloney, National Industri, No-Tra-Mo, Ocren, OEL, OTE,
basis. Richard Pfeiffer, Sécheron, Strömberg, TIBB, Thrige, Westinghouse, Zinsco.
324
Field Service Examples of retrofit
Our customers can rely on ABB Field Service Engineers to An engineering study done by ABB showed hotspots in
train personnel, supervise installations, perform commissioning a 400 MVA generator transformer built in the 1970‘s
or do the complete installation. Some repairs can even for a utility. The transformer was repaired and upgraded.
be carried out directly at site by our well-equipped field What did the utility gain?
personnel so you avoid the significant expense of returning • A repaired unit that now provides 25 MVA more than
the transformer to the plant and save transportation time. before (from 400 to 425)
This way ABB can reduce the total through put time of the • Maintenance cost will be reduced over the coming years
repair and have your unit back in service earlier. • The end-user reported that cost recovery for repair would
be made within 3 years
An aluminum smelter wanted 20% more power to produce
Conclusion more product. A regulating transformer built in the late 70‘s
was returned to factory for retrofitting.
ABB works with our customers to develop a repair plan that
What did the smelter gain?
goes beyond replacing worn out parts.
• Elimination of circulating current due to new lead design
The ultimate result is a replacement that could be better
• A new design of the windings optimized for the new
than the original.
application allows 30 MVA extra power (from 150 to
180 MVA) to generate more aluminum for the smelter
325
Transformer Service
Here are some of the options ABB can offer using hybrid
insulation systems:
326
Some examples of how ABB can • For customer C, a hybrid upgrade could enable smaller
sized replacement windings to provide 100 % of the
redefine transformer retrofit solutions. original nameplate rating (higher average winding
temperature rise and losses) while improving reliability
Customer A: Growth has extended peak load beyond
and decreasing maintenance
original specification limits of the failing transformer. An
o Lower repair cost is possible with reduced active
upgrade, using cellulose insulation, is inadequate. A new
copper parts
transformer exceeds the existing space allowance
Customer B: A failing transformer is replaced with a
duplicate spare. Re-manufacturing the old unit with more
capacity would enable wider use as a universal spare
Conclusion
throughout the system.
Retrofit with NOMEX® Thermal Protective Technology offers
Customer C: The failed transformer was loaded light to
the following benefits:
moderate. A smaller capacity unit is technically justified but
• Possibility to delay investments for purchase of new
the number of system ratings was reduced. The next lower
equipment
capacity unit is insufficient.
• Added reliability for transformers operating in critical
conditions
• More operational system flexibility from increased
ABB Solution: > Re-engineer overload capacity
• Increased power for a given unit size or available space
Printed in Germany (10.04-05-PPI) We reserve the right to make changes in the course of technical development.
for more cost effective power
with hybrid insulation systems
• For customers A and B, hybrid upgrades could supply an
average of 50 % more peak or continuous load (historical
range is 30-100%)
o Typically 20-30 % first cost savings compared to a new
unit and shorter lead time
o Lower installed cost - minimal site disruption, same
space and pad, plug-in installation
327
Transformer Service
Active part of large single phase power transformer being re-tanked after repair on-site
328
Quality Examples of site repair:
When the subject of site repair is discussed, quality is often a ABB’s On-Site Repair credentials are impressive, with more
topic of concern. The question is, how can a full winding than 200 power transformers repaired on-site globally during
replacement be carried out in the field when factory repair or the last 13 years. The largest units have been up to 750 MVA,
new manufacture needs carefully controlled conditions and 800 kV ac and 600 kV dc. Here is a brief overview of two
extremely high quality control? examples:
The answer is that the same quality control and the require- An electrical utility experienced a failure in a 25 year old,
ments that apply in the factory are applied in the field: core type, generator step-up transformer 100 MVA 240/15 kV.
● Strict quality control of materials The utility had a real time challenge since this transformer
● Environmental control for critical processes needed to be back in service before the summer consumption
peak.
● Extremely high standards of workmanship
● Rigorous testing of applied and induced voltage with The repair work that included replacement of windings and
partial discharge measurement. core repair was executed by ABB at site within a record time
of 40 days. The repair was verified by performing applied
Conclusion and induced high voltage tests with partial discharge
measurement.
There can be no doubt that, in cases where transport of any
consequence is involved, On-Site Repair of a power transfor- What did the utility gain?
mer offers time and cost advantages that benefit the customer. ● The transformer back into operation before the
It also offers a solution for those difficult cases where infra- summer peak
structure no longer supports the transportation of large power ● Minimized loss of production
transformers.
A nuclear power station experienced a failure in a 400 MVA
ABB is the global leader in site repair and, with its globally single-phase shell-type generator step-up transformer.
coordinated and quality assured processes, the partner of The generating company decided upon an On-Site Repair
choice when customers opt for repairing a transformer on- program to replace the windings and upgrade the faulty unit.
site.
What did the nuclear power station gain?
● Repair time of 4 months per unit, greatly reducing
the risk of downtime at the plant
● Elimination of transport time, cost and risk
329
Transformer Service
330
Example: 40MVA gassing transformer
• 30 years old Generator Step-up Transformer (40 MVA /
242 kV) was gassing above 30 % of the nominal load
current because of an aged insulation system. The
transformer has been kept wet and overloaded during
many years.
• End-user need to keep the unit up running during a
6 months peak load season to supply electricity in the
vicinity.
• Installing a monitoring system on the transformer and
following the evolution of the unit remotely from an
ABB service centre allowed the transformer owner to
meet its challenge by supplying end-customers with
12 MVA during 6 months.
• Following benefits were notified by the transformer
owner:
o Satisfaction of the end-customers
o Avoid penalty for non delivery of energy
331
332
ABB TRES North America Service Brochures
333
334
Transformer Remanufacturing
335
Transformer Remanufacturing
Power Transformer
Remanufacturing Resources
at a Glance
Design Documentation and
Drawing Database
ABB maintains the most extensive OEM
database in the transformer industry with
design documents on file from Asea, BBC,
General Electric, Moloney, and
Westinghouse.
Resources include:
• Millions of design drawings for most
transformers installed in the US
• More than 80 design, materials, and
project engineers and technicians
dedicated to customer field support
• Engineering studies
• Core form and shell form capability
Shipping and Receiving
When moving power transformers, ABB
uses only highly qualified riggers and
haulers that meet ABB’s stringent ISO9001
criteria for heavy hauling. We track the
transformer during shipments and provide
risk of loss insurance to protect against any
damage during the transportation process.
A fleet of 14 rail cars including five
special Schnabel cars and six heavy-duty
depressed center cars, as well as off-road
modular platform trailers, 400-ton,
Schnabel trailers are available to meet
these stringent transportation requirements.
336
Major Plant Equipment
and Systems
ABB facilities in St. Louis, Missouri are
ISO 9001 registered to meet the repair
requirements for most large power
transformers.
Testing
The ABB state-of-the-art testing facilities
ensure accurate and repeatable test
results. At the St. Louis plant, ABB has
full dielectric and thermal testing
capability up to 345 kV, 1050 KV BIL,
and 300 MVA.
337
338
Field Services for Power Transformers
Servicing Power
Transformers On Site
Power transformers are valuable assets,
and companies —utility as well as indus-
trial—have every incentive to keep them
running reliably for as long as possible.
ABB has what it takes to service your
power transformers. ABB TRES
(Transformer Remanufacturing and
Engineering Solutions) is uniquely qualified
to test, analyze, and improve upon any
power transformer, regardless of original
manufacturer. For any requirement, from
a single OEM part, to a maintenance
program, to a long-term Asset Manage-
ment program, ABB’s TRES is the best
choice to keep your power transformers
online and operating efficiently, 24/7.
ABB has the most extensive OEM data-
base in the transformer industry with
design documents on file for Asea, BBC,
ABB, General Electric, Moloney, and
Westinghouse. ABB offers many upgrades
that exceed original operation specifica-
tions. We fabricate and maintain a huge
inventory of OEM parts as well.
339
Power Transformer Field Service
Resources at a Glance
Planning:
Planning is a critical step in a successful
transformer service job. Identifying poten-
tial obstacles, conducting route surveys to
determine transportation requirements,
and doing engineering assessments are
only a few of the many steps taken in the
planning phase. Utilizing the millions of
transformer drawings and years of exper-
tise, the 100+ professionals at ABB ensure
that your transformer arrives on schedule
in a safe and cost effective manner.
Transportation:
ABB provides logistical service and support
to transport, relocate, coordinate, and Installation:
install transformers. When moving your
ABB installs over 100 transformers annually. Our highly qualified
power transformer, ABB uses only our
technicians and top quality equipment provide safe, accurate,
network of highly qualified riggers and
rapid completion of the job. ABB’s fleet of mobile installation
haulers. We track the transformer during
and oil-processing trailers can be dispatched to any job site in
shipments and provide risk of loss insur-
North America.
ance to protect against any damage during
the transportation process. To support this
business, ABB maintains a fleet of 14 rail
cars including five special Schnabel cars
and six heavy-duty depressed center cars
as well as off-road modular platform
trailers and Schnabel trailers.
340
Maintenance and Retrofit:
ABB maintains 15 mobile work trailers with the finest
ABB TRES provides preventative and
installation equipment available, including:
corrective maintenance support for your
installed equipment. Determining the best • Semi-tractor with 15-ton hydraulic crane
maintenance program often begins with a • Motor-generator set
performance and capability study
conducted by an ABB design engineer. • Air compressor and air dryer
Recommendations are made in a formal • De-gassing equipment, 1800-4800 GPM
report to the operator. Many repairs and
• Liquid nitrogen cold traps
retrofits can be successfully performed
onsite, avoiding the cost associated with • Cutting and welding equipment
transformer movement. Retrofit and • OSHA required PPE and safety equipment
upgrade of transformer capabilities are
available in the areas of bushings, tap • Hand tools, rigging, and lifting fixtures
changers, thermal/cooling, controls, • Electrical test equipment
reblocking, and others.
• Oil test equipment
Repair:
ABB’s modern manufacturing and repair MTMProgram – ABB’s Mature Transformer
facilities in St. Louis, Missouri serve the Management Program:
industry when transformers must be
Many transformer fleets in North America are approaching the
removed from the substation for repairs.
end of their design lifetime, increasing the risk of unplanned
These facilities are ISO 9001 registered
outages. These outages can be catastrophic in cost, loss of revenue,
to meet the repair requirements for
and environmental and social impact. ABB TRES can identify and
large power transformers. ABB provides
quantify risk fleet wide. Condition and Life Assessments are used
full capabilities to service power
to extend unit lifetime and optimize transformer performance.
transformers, including dismantle,
With this structured and rigorous asset management program,
r-design, repair, rebuild, and
customers can prioritize maintenance and capital budgets to
comprehensive electrical testing. ABB’s
insure maximum economic benefits.
state-of-the-art testing facilities ensure
accurate and repeatable test results. ABB
has full dielectric and thermal testing
capability up to 765 kV, 2050 BIL, and 1000
MVA.
341
342
Mature Transformer
Management Program
MTMProgram™
343
The MTMProgram™ addresses the emerging issue As the largest OEM in the world with a unique
of power transformer aging. While this subject has history, ABB is often entrusted with diagnosing
been a topic of discussion for over two decades, and assessing the condition of various transformers.
the strength of our transmission infrastructure has ABB has detailed historical transformer design
allowed transformers to operate beyond their knowledge of nearly 75% of the installed base
design life. of large power transformers in North America,
including Westinghouse, GE, Asea, Brown Boveri,
Deregulation and economic controls have changed
and other predecessor technologies. The ABB
the demands of new systems. These transformers
assessment processes and technical tools devel-
that are operating beyond their design life will
oped are the natural result of our distinctive
soon begin to fail in significant numbers.
market position.
This issue can be addressed by identifying weak
units through an economical approach that deals ABB has developed a four-step process (Figure A):
with the dynamics of the aging process.
Transformer Fleet Screening
Transformer Design and Condition Assessment
Life Assessment/Profiling
Implementation of Engineering Solutions
Figure A
Steps of the ABB Mature Transformer Management Program
STEP ONE
Transformer Fleet Screening
STEP TWO
Transformer Design and Condition Assessment
Rigorous, unit-based design evaluation
Risk of Failure Screening and condition assessment.
STEP THREE
Life Assessment/Profiling
Detailed life assessment, including design
and engineering analysis for life extension
of each specific transformer.
STEP FOUR
Implementation of Engineering Solutions
344
ABB’s Four-Step Process
Figure B Figure C
Typical results of the transformer fleet Typical results of the short circuit strength
risk assessment analysis used in a life assessment study.
Relative Importance
Design #1 Design #3
Design #2 Design #4
Urgent Action Needed
Preventive Action Needed
Normal Maintenance Action Needed
A B B M A T U R E T R A N S F O R M E R M A N A G E M E N T P R O G R A M
345
ABB’s Four-Step Process (Continued)
Conclusion
Clearly, capital requirements for wholesale unit higher risk positions. As the health of your fleet
replacement are not economically feasible. However, continues to improve annually, ABB anticipates
neither is the revenue loss resulting from a doubling your operations, and maintenance budgets will
or tripling of system failures. Therefore, the logical begin to decrease, resulting in over-all savings for
approach is to continually identify the “weak system your company.
units” and replace, remanufacture, retrofit, or repo- ABB’s MTMProgram is distinctive in the trans-
sition these critical assets on the system before they former industry. Because we possess nearly 75%
remove themselves from service. of the detailed transformer design database in the
As this system is followed over multiple years, industry, only ABB can provide an analysis based
maintenance and operating budget dollars will not just on statistics, but based on this specific
be directed to the highest risk units. Remaining design knowledge. Consequently, our clients get
expenditures can then be directed to medium- the most accurate, detailed analysis possible. The
risk areas. The result is a dynamic that moves ABB MTMProgram provides a technical, economic,
high-risk units into lower risk areas and prevents optimized solution to improve the reliability and
the migration of low- or medium-risk units into availability of your transformer fleet.
346
ABB Advanced Diagnostic Testing Services
347
Advanced Diagnostic Testing Services
from the World’s Leading Manufacturer
of Power Transformers
The DFR test is a measurement of the dielectric properties abnormal power factor results were measured in the field.
(i.e. capacitance, loss, and Power Factor) of the transformer’s
insulation as a function of frequency. This offline test The DFR test has gained popularity in recent years as
utilizes the same type of connections as the standard 60 Hz a diagnostic tool for transformer insulation system testing.
insulation power factor test. However, it covers a frequency One important primary use of the test has been for deter-
range, typically from 1 mHz to 1,000 Hz while the standard mining the moisture content in the cellulose insulation
power factor (Doble) test is done only at 60 Hz. This test structure of power transformers. The analysis of moisture
yields more information with increased sensitivity to insula- in transformers is performed using the results of the DFR
tion issues by utilizing the dielectric response phenomenon. measurement and an analysis tool that models the actual
insulation geometry and the insulating material (oil, paper,
A further application is the Dielectric Frequency Response pressboard, etc.) of the transformer. ABB has used these
Signature method (DFRS), where the signature of the mea- tools for years in t he analysis of transformers, both in the
sured response is then compared with a modeled response factory and in the field. The experience gained has shown
of a transformer with a “normal” insulation structure the potential of the DFR test for identifying not only mois-
and a library of signatures of known defects. The method ture problems, but also other defects in the transformer
is demonstrated by utilization in cases where high or insulation structure.
348
Demonstrating the value of DFR: Case Study #1
Better information for client resulted in avoidance of unnecessary maintenance.
Our client provided ABB with a list of seven transformers. Xfrmr# Temp Type Construction Oil Cond Moisture by Oil Moisture by DR
(°C) (pS/m) Sat (%wt) (%wt)
In each case, moisture-in-oil test results indicated the need
1 23 GSU Core 0.381 2.5 0.9
for oil processing and drying. Working with the client,
2 28 GSU Core 0.492 1.8 0.9
ABB performed DFR testing and determined that only two 3 23 GSU Core 0.412 1.4 0.9
units actually required drying, instead of seven. ABB’s 4 23 GSU Core 1.34 2.8 0.7
recommendation to dry two transformers, while carefully 5 13 3-wdg Shell 1.5 * 1.2
monitoring the other five, afforded a significant amount of 6 27 Auto Core 3 3.5 2
O&M savings. This also avoided over-drying and loosening 7 27 Auto Shell 0.3 3.3 1
349
ABB’s Advanced Dissolved Gas Analysis Software —
Deeper analysis that comes from years of ABB experience.
ABB has developed an internal software package that
combines DGA raw data, ratios, trending, key indicators,
and ABB’s resident design expertise and transformer
construction knowledge to interpret the results. By
combining ABB’s design and manufacturing knowledge
with the analysis capabilities of the software, we offer
greater analytical depth than what is standard practice
in the industry.
350
Frequency Response Analysis —
An important tool for identifying potential winding geometry changes.
Frequency Response Analysis (FRA) is a low-voltage, ABB’s expert interpretation of FRA test results is an
offline measurement of the impedance of the transformer excellent method to check movement or displacement
winding as a function of frequency. The test is performed of windings or other internal winding circuit changes and
by applying a variable frequency AC voltage to each is much more effective than the low-voltage impedance
individual winding of the transformer and measuring test routinely performed on transformers. The value of
the current that flows out of the winding. The plot of the FRA test is to identify potential winding geometry
the current divided by the voltage vs. frequency is changes that may affect the ability of the transformer to
known as the Swept Frequency Response Analysis withstand through- faults, helping t o avoid catastrophic
(SFRA) of the winding. transformer failures.
351
352
Load Tap
Changer
Retrofits
Application
ABB load tap changer (LTC) replacements
or retrofits are designed to economically
solve operating problems inherent in existing
tap changers, such as:
LTC mechanisms that have reached the
end of their useful mechanical life
The rapid diminishing of parts availability Before Retrofit
and qualified service personnel on
vintage equipment
Forced reliance on expensive and
sometimes questionable quality parts due
to obsolete design or being built by
former manufacturers
Cost of unplanned outages has risen
dramatically
Features
All mechanical parts are designed and
tested for demanding service
Single source for all parts and services
Proven, reliable vacuum or resistive
technology
After LTC Retrofit
Up-to-date tap changer designs
Backed by over 80 years of transformer
engineering and design experience
All engineering, drafting, field
modification drawings, new controls,
wiring diagrams, parts, materials, and
even installation can be provided
Benefits
Increased transformer life up to 25
years in some cases
Reduced maintenance costs Troublesome LTC Removal Field Installation of Replacement LTC
Improved reliability of operation,
particularly under demanding conditions
Increased contact live available from
modern, proven tap changers
Field retrofit is an economical alternative
to shipping large power transformers
Same downtime as same-model, active
mechanism replacement
353
Load Tap Changer Retrofits
Because of the wide variety of flange sizes, lead
configurations and lengths, operating
mechanisms, and control differences, field
retrofitting has generally been considered to be
impractical. ABB has proven that it is both
possible and economical to retrofit an existing
transformer with a new production model load
tap changer. The transformer outage typically
required for a retrofit is only two weeks, and all
transformer work is completed at the site.
Many customers have found retrofits to be a technically sound as well as an economical alternative to the purchase
of a new transformer. Contact ABB or your local representative for more information.
354
Load Tap Changer (LTC)
Engineering, Parts, & Service
355
How ABB Can Help
Proper Load Tap Changer ABB offers a comprehensive and
systematic approach to effectively
(LTC) maintenance has maintain many manufacturers’
become increasingly LTCs, including ABB, Westinghouse,
Reinhausen, Moloney, GE, and
complex even for the
others. Our LTC program can
best utility and industrial supplement existing in-house
programs or work independently
managers. Factors resulting
to satisfy the total maintenance
from interconnections and need. ABB’s LTC team provides
power networks to aging support 24/7, and all field services
are furnished by the ABB qualified
equipment and the declining technicians and engineers.
pool of technical experts For services ranging from
add to the challenge. When documentation and design
engineering, to the latest in testing
you evaluate the liability and oil processing, to providing
of a single LTC failure at 100% OEM grade parts and life
extension kits, ABB is the best
today’s costs, establishing
resource for all LTC service
an effective maintenance requirements. Our LTC services
increase transformer life, reliability,
Documentation
strategy becomes a matter and Engineering
and lower overall maintenance
no one can ignore. and operations costs. The ABB design engineers and
technicians specialize in LTCs and
the LTC interface with control
circuits and power transformers.
With access to an original
OEM grade renewal engineering documentation and
parts for LTCs are procedures database containing
available from ABB more than seven million drawings
on an immediate for most current LTC designs, our
basis anywhere in dedicated service professionals are
North America. When ready to help.
necessary, obsolete
Services provided are:
parts can be made
Establishing proper test
by ABB because we
procedures
maintain over
Identifying parts
seven million
Setting proper operating
drawings to assure
parameters
that LTC services
Performing studies to engineer
conform to the
improvements
original design
Troubleshooting
specifications.
Failure analysis
356
Original Retrofit and Upgrade Kits
Replacement Parts ABB is continuously monitoring
Whenever feasible, ABB and searching for LTC retrofit and
upgrade opportunities where our
procurement specialists restore
an LTC to original specifications designs can be applied towards
Factory-trained
when replacement parts are newer technologies and materials.
engineers with years
needed. Our procurement In fact, a large percentage of
of LTC experience
specialists have the ability to the units ABB services involve
supervise every
immediately source and deliver modifications to incorporate
field project ABB
currently produced parts and/or
undertakes. Our goal OEM-grade parts to customers
anywhere in North America. upgrade units.
is always a quality
job, on time, on Retrofits and upgrades often involve:
ABB provides:
budget, with total Replacing obsolete LTCs with
Oil seats
customer satisfaction. current-production LTCs
Insulating panel boards
Assemblies (contact assemblies, Addition of a LTC to a non-LTC
brake assemblies, cam switch transformer
assemblies, and mechanism Conversion from a reactance-type
assemblies) LTC to a resistance-type LTC (or
Control cabinets the reverse procedure)
Kits (vacuum interrupter kits, Cam switch assembly and brake
Field Service assembly upgrading
remote indication kits, voltage
ABB performs field maintenance, regulating relay kits) Control modification
testing, troubleshooting, and failure Arc chutes Addition of paralleling equipment
analysis. We match our employees Rotary position switches and/or data acquisition
to the appropriate make and model Inspection door gaskets equipment
of LTC, equip them with accurate
diagnostic tools, and ensure that
they follow stringent procedures Project Management ABB’s LTC service capability
to minimize outage time and A project engineer manages includes all the necessary electrical,
maximize equipment integrity every LTC service project that mechanical, oil testing, and
and job site safety. ABB undertakes. The engineer processing equipment in a self-
assures that all engineering, contained trailer to perform onsite
Typical equipment includes: maintenance repairs or retrofits.
drafting, purchasing, field
Timing fixtures for many
resource requirements, terms of
LTC models
service contracts, and warranty
Testers (hi potential testers,
considerations always meet or
turns ratio testers, and insulation
exceed ABB’s corporate standards
power factor testers)
and customer expectations.
Filter presses
Vacuum pumps Each ABB service project includes:
Boroscope equipment Schedule coordination
Meggers 24-hour-per-day project support
Oil test sets Project review and
Custom tools documentation of changes
High-current test sets
357
ABB provides OEM-grade parts, maintenance, and modernization services for the following Load Tap Changers (LTCs).
358
Power Transformer
On-Site Coil Reblocking Service
Certain large power transformers are prone to coil
degradation due to various design, operating and
environmental factors. Particularly, large power
substation and generator step-up transformers
that were built by General Electric in Pittsfield,
Mass. prior to 1972. Because of aging, loading and
the use of low density pressboard in their original
construction, it’s probable that their coil blocking
is loose. Also, these units have experienced oil
box problems, with resultant cooling deficiencies.
As a result:
359
Internal inspection. The only certain way to Define the Scope of Work
evaluate tightness of blocking and loosening of the By evaluating the general condition of the
coils is to drain the oil from the transformer then transformer, including bushings, tap changers and
visually and physically inspect the Internals of the their drives, coolers, tank shielding, leads and lead
transformer. Some of the items inspected are: supports.
x Tightness of window wedges and wedge blocks Determine Where the Work Can be Completed
x Bearing of spacers on end rings Either in the field or in an ABB repair facility.
x Any crushing of end rings at Cornpleting work in the field is preferable if there
the bearing surface between is sufficient room to position jacks, replace channel
them and spacers fill if necessary, and in general maneuver inside the
x Clearance to the winding unit.
cylinders
x Alignment and tightness of
radial spacers and
associated channel till
x Oil box condition
x Areas that are inaccessible to
visual inspection by the
human eye, are viewed through
a portable
for a better evaluation boroscope
A typical General Electric Mark II power transformer with flanged ends and
layers tapered. These transformers are very likely to experience coil movement
problems which can be corrected by the ABB coil reblocking process.
360
In rare cases where on-site field reblocking is not Implement and Guarantee the Work
possible, the unit can be shipped to either the ABB will review design drawings for the
ABB transformer repair facility in St. Louis specific transformer. We will supply materials
that meet present day design requirements. All
Estimate the Costs and Benefits material will be properly vapotherm processed
Utilities cannot afford unreliable transmission and coordinated to arrive at the site immediately
systems. Power transformers must be capable of prior to the start of the workscope.
surviving in a real world environment where ABB will support the job by supplying
through faults can occur at any moment. supervision, labor, tools and material for
A unit with very little or no compression force reblocking only, or can also provide complete
on the windings has virtually no short circuit turnkey operation including all oil handling and
integrity. The result of this could be a failed testing as well. We will guarantee all materials and
transformer, which would need to be rebuilt or workmanship in accordance with our standard
replaced by a new unit. The new equipment costs terms and conditions.
can be minor compared to the unexpected Each ABB service project, regardless of size or
service interruption. workscope, includes complete:
361
362
Railcar Rental Program for
Power Transformer Relocation
Moving large power transformers can be a Railcar Capacities and Daily
challenge. Their large dimensions and Rates/Fees
extreme weight pose unique requirements to
ensure safe and efficient transportation. The ABB Railcar Rental Program
ABB’s Railcar Rental Program helps includes the type and class of railcars
customers meet those unique requirements listed below.
with a fleet of specialty rail cars.
Car # Type Load Daily Fees
(lbs.) Rate
Railcar Types and Uses PTDX7060* Dep Center 512,000 $2,000 $5,000
PTDX7061* Dep Center 620,000 $3,000 $10,000
ABB owns, operates and rents a fleet of
PTDX-201 Schnabel 750,000 $3,500 $2,000
railcars designed specifically for the PTDX-202** Schnabel 1,000,000 $4,500 $2,500
transportation of large, heavy loads. Three PTDX-203 Schnabel 750,000 $3,500 $2,000
different types of cars are utilized based on PTDX-204 Schnabel 750,000 $3,500 $2,000
the specific load requirements: depressed PTDX-205* Side Rail 733,000 $2,000 $2,000
center, Schnabel and side rail. ABB’s rail * One time loading fee – no daily charge
specialists are available to assist you in ** A special train is required to move this car under load.
determining the best choice. Special train rates are charged on a per-mile basis
In addition to normal freight charges.
363
364